Chevrolet Automobile 2010 Cobalt Coupe User Manual

2010 Chevrolet Cobalt Owner Manual M  
In Brief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Seats and Restraint System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53  
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52  
Features and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3  
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8  
Driving Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Your Driving, the Road, and the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Canadian Owners  
Propriétaires Canadiens  
A French language copy of this manual can be obtained  
from your dealer/retailer or from:  
On peut obtenir un exemplaire de ce guide en français  
auprès du concessionnaire ou à l'adresse suivante:  
GENERAL MOTORS, GM, the GM Emblem,  
CHEVROLET, the CHEVROLET Emblem, and  
the name COBALT are registered trademarks of  
General Motors.  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
1-800-551-4123  
This manual describes features that may or may  
not be on your specific vehicle either because they  
are options that you did not purchase or due to changes  
subsequent to the printing of this owner manual.  
Please refer to the purchase documentation relating  
to your specific vehicle to confirm each of the features  
found on your vehicle. For vehicles first sold in Canada,  
substitute the name General Motors of Canada  
Limitedfor Chevrolet Motor Division wherever it  
appears in this manual.  
Numéro de poste 6438 de langue française  
www.helminc.com  
Index  
To quickly locate information about the vehicle, use the  
index in the back of the manual. It is an alphabetical list  
of what is in the manual and the page number where it  
can be found.  
Keep this manual in the vehicle for quick reference.  
Litho in U.S.A.  
Part No. 25895310 C Third Printing  
©2010 General Motors. All Rights Reserved.  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A circle with a slash  
through it is a safety  
symbol which means  
Do Not,” “Do not do this,”  
or Do not let this  
happen.”  
Safety Warnings and Symbols  
Warning messages found on vehicle labels and in this  
manual describe hazards and what to do to avoid or  
reduce them.  
Danger indicates a hazard with a high level of risk  
which will result in serious injury or death.  
Warning or Caution indicates a hazard that could result  
in injury or death.  
Vehicle Symbols  
The vehicle has components and labels that use  
symbols instead of text. Symbols are shown along with  
the text describing the operation or information relating  
to a specific component, control, message, gauge,  
or indicator.  
WARNING:  
{
These mean there is something that could hurt  
you or other people.  
M : This symbol is shown when you need to see your  
owner manual for additional instructions or information.  
Notice: This means there is something that could  
result in property or vehicle damage. This would not  
be covered by the vehicle's warranty.  
* : This symbol is shown when you need to see a  
service manual for additional instructions or information.  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Symbol Chart  
. : Fuel Gauge  
Here are some additional symbols that may be found on  
the vehicle and what they mean. For more information  
on the symbol, refer to the index.  
+ : Fuses  
i : Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
j : LATCH System Child Restraints  
* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
: : Oil Pressure  
9 : Airbag Readiness Light  
# : Air Conditioning  
! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
g : Audio Steering Wheel Controls or OnStar®  
$ : Brake System Warning Light  
" : Charging System  
I : Cruise Control  
B : Engine Coolant Temperature  
O : Exterior Lamps  
} : Power  
/ : Remote Vehicle Start  
> : Safety Belt Reminders  
7 : Tire Pressure Monitor  
F : Traction Control  
M : Windshield Washer Fluid  
# : Fog Lamps  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1 In Brief  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Portable Audio Devices (Auxiliary Input or  
USB Port) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16  
Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17  
Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Trunk Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Head Restraint Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8  
Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Sensing System for Passenger Airbag . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Mirror Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10  
Steering Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11  
Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11  
Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12  
Windshield Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13  
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Tire Pressure Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20  
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
1-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
1-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Outlet Adjustment on page 416.  
K. Instrument Panel Brightness on page 411.  
L. Horn on page 43.  
B. Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever on page 44.  
C. Cruise Control on page 46 (If Equipped).  
Driver Information Center (DIC) on page 438.  
M. Traction Control System (TCS) on page 59  
(If Equipped). Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on  
page 56 (If Equipped).  
D. Instrument Panel Cluster on page 419.  
N. Cigarette Lighter (If Equipped). See Ashtray(s) and  
Cigarette Lighter on page 413.  
E. Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 484  
(If Equipped).  
O. Shift Lever (Manual Shown). See Manual  
Transmission Operation on page 328 and  
Automatic Transmission Operation on page 326.  
F. Hazard Warning Flashers on page 43.  
G. Windshield Wipers on page 45 and Windshield  
Washer on page 46.  
P. Climate Control System on page 414.  
Q. Heated Seats on page 24 (If Equipped).  
R. Glove Box on page 339.  
H. Audio System(s) on page 452.  
I. Fog Lamps on page 410 (If Equipped).  
J. Trunk Release. See Trunk on page 312.  
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initial Drive Information  
Press Q to lock all doors.  
This section provides a brief overview about some of  
the important features that may or may not be on your  
specific vehicle.  
Lock and unlock feedback can be personalized.  
Press and hold V for approximately one second to  
open the trunk.  
For more detailed information, refer to each of the  
features which can be found later in this owner manual.  
Press L and release to locate the vehicle.  
Press L and hold for more than two seconds to sound  
the panic alarm.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
The RKE transmitter is used to remotely lock and  
unlock the doors from up to 60 m (195 feet) away  
from the vehicle.  
Press L again to cancel the panic alarm.  
See Keys on page 33 and Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) System Operation on page 34.  
Press K to unlock the  
driver door. Press again  
within five seconds to  
unlock all remaining  
doors.  
Remote Vehicle Start  
With this feature the engine can be started from outside  
of the vehicle.  
Starting the Vehicle  
1. Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle.  
2. Press Q.  
3. Immediately after completing Step 2, press and  
hold / until the turn signal lamps flash.  
1-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the vehicle starts, the parking lamps will turn  
on and remain on as long as the engine is running.  
The doors will be locked and the climate control system  
may come on.  
Power Door Locks  
This vehicle may have  
power door locks.  
The controls are located  
on the driver and front  
passenger door armrests.  
The engine will continue to run for 10 minutes. Repeat  
the steps for a 10-minute time extension. Remote start  
can be extended only once.  
Canceling a Remote Start  
To cancel a remote start:  
.
Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle and press  
and hold / until the parking lamps turn off.  
.
Turn on the hazard warning flashers.  
K : Press to unlock the doors.  
Q : Press to lock the doors.  
For more information see:  
.
Turn the ignition on and then back off.  
See Remote Vehicle Start on page 36.  
.
Door Locks on page 38.  
Door Locks  
To lock the driver door from outside the vehicle, turn the  
key clockwise. Turn it counterclockwise to unlock.  
.
Power Door Locks on page 39.  
.
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation  
on page 34  
.
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter can also  
be used to lock or unlock the doors.  
From the inside, use the manual lock knobs on each  
door or use the power door locks.  
1-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trunk Release  
Press the front of the switch to open the window and  
pull the switch up to close it.  
In addition to the trunk release button on the Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, the trunk can be  
opened from inside the vehicle by pressing the remote  
trunk release button. This button is located inside the  
driver storage compartment, on the left side of the  
instrument panel.  
See Power Windows on page 315.  
Seat Adjustment  
Manual Seats  
See Trunk on page 312.  
1. Lift the bar to unlock  
the seat.  
Windows  
2. Slide the seat to the  
desired position and  
release the bar.  
Power Windows  
For vehicles with power  
windows, the switches  
on the driver door armrest  
control each window.  
The switch on each  
passenger door controls  
only that doors window.  
Try to move the seat to be sure it is locked in place.  
See Manual Seats on page 22.  
Sedan Shown, Coupe  
Similar  
1-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Height Adjuster  
Reclining Seatbacks  
To raise or lower the driver seat, move the lever upward  
or downward repeatedly until the seat is at the desired  
height.  
To recline the seatback, do the following:  
1. Lift the recline lever.  
2. Move the seatback to the desired position, then  
release the lever to lock the seatback in place.  
See Seat Height Adjuster on page 23.  
3. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is  
locked.  
See Reclining Seatbacks on page 24.  
1-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manual Lumbar  
Heated Seats  
If equipped, the lumbar  
knob is located on  
This vehicle may have  
heated front seats.  
The switches are located  
on the instrument panel  
above the climate control  
system.  
the front of the driver  
seat lower cushion.  
Turn it clockwise or  
counterclockwise to  
increase or decrease  
the lumbar support.  
Driver's Switch shown  
See Manual Lumbar on page 23.  
Press the side of the switch with the double indicator  
lights to turn the seat to the highest setting.  
Press the side of the switch with the single indicator  
light to turn the seat to the lowest setting.  
Return the switch to the center to turn off the  
heated seat.  
See Heated Seats on page 24.  
Head Restraint Adjustment  
Do not drive until the head restraints for all occupants  
are installed and adjusted properly.  
See Head Restraints on page 27.  
1-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Belt  
Sensing System for Passenger  
Airbag  
The passenger sensing system, if equipped, will turn off  
the right front passenger frontal airbag under certain  
conditions. The driver airbags and roofrail airbags are  
not affected by this.  
If the vehicle has a passenger sensing system, the  
passenger airbag status indicator will be visible on the  
instrument panel when the vehicle is started.  
Refer to the following sections for important information  
on how to use safety belts properly.  
United States  
Canada  
.
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone on page 210.  
.
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly on page 215.  
See Passenger Sensing System (Without Turbo Engine)  
on page 262 or Passenger Sensing System (With  
Turbo Engine) on page 267 for important information.  
.
Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 224.  
.
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)  
on page 241  
.
1-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keep the selector switch in the center position when not  
adjusting either outside mirror.  
Mirror Adjustment  
Exterior Mirrors  
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage  
when going through an automatic car wash. To fold, pull  
the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror outward,  
to return it to the original position.  
Controls for the outside  
power mirrors are located  
on the driver door  
armrest.  
Interior Mirror  
Hold the inside rearview mirror in the center to move it  
for a clearer view of behind the vehicle. Adjust the  
mirror to reduce the glare of headlamps from behind.  
Push the tab forward for daytime use and pull it for  
nighttime use. See Manual Rearview Mirror on  
page 337  
.
1. Use the selector switch located below the four-way  
control pad to choose either the left or right outside  
mirror.  
2. Press one of the four arrows located on the control  
pad to move the mirror to the desired direction.  
3. Adjust each outside mirror so that a little of the  
vehicle and the area behind it can be seen.  
1-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Steering Wheel Adjustment  
Interior Lighting  
Dome Lamp  
The vehicle may have a dome lamp.  
Move the lever near the dome lamp to the following  
positions:  
9: Turns the lamp off, even when a door is opened.  
1: Turns the lamp on whenever a door is opened.  
+: Turns the dome lamp on.  
Mirror Reading Lamp  
The vehicle may have reading lamps on the rearview  
mirror. Press the button near each lamp to turn the  
reading lamps on and off.  
For more information on interior lighting, see:  
The tilt wheel lever is located on the left side of the  
steering column.  
.
Entry/Exit Lighting on page 411.  
.
Instrument Panel Brightness on page 411.  
To adjust the steering wheel:  
1. Pull the lever down.  
2. Move the steering wheel up or down into a  
comfortable position.  
3. Pull the lever up to lock the steering wheel in  
place.  
See Tilt Wheel on page 43.  
1-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
P: When operating in AUTO, a momentary turn of the  
switch to Off/On will turn the Automatic Headlamp  
System off or back on. For vehicles first sold in Canada,  
the automatic transmission must be in P (Park) or the  
manual transmission must have the park brake set,  
before the Automatic Headlamp System can be  
turned off.  
Exterior Lighting  
For more information, see:  
.
Headlamps on page 49.  
.
Fog Lamps on page 410.  
.
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) on page 410.  
.
Headlamps on Reminder on page 410.  
.
The lever is on the left side of the steering column.  
Wiper Activated Headlamps on page 410.  
2: Turns on the headlamps, parking lamps, and  
taillamps.  
;: Turns on the parking lamps and taillamps only.  
AUTO: Automatically turns on the Daytime Running  
Lamps (DRL) during daytime, and the headlamps,  
parking lamps, and taillamps at night.  
1-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windshield Washer: Press the button at the end of the  
lever until the washers begin.  
Windshield Wiper/Washer  
See Windshield Wipers on page 45 and Windshield  
Washer on page 46.  
Climate Controls  
The vehicle's heating, cooling, and ventilation can be  
controlled with this system.  
The windshield wiper lever is located on the right side of  
the steering column.  
9: Turns the wipers off.  
&: Turn this band for intermittent or speed sensitive  
operation. As vehicle speed increases or decreases, the  
wiper interval also increases or decreases.  
Vehicles with Air Conditioning shown, without Air  
Conditioning similar  
x: Delays wiping cycle. Turn the band up for more  
frequent wipes.  
A. Air Delivery Mode  
Control  
D. Air Conditioning  
E. Rear Window Defogger  
F. Recirculation  
6: Slow wipes.  
1: Fast wipes.  
B. Fan Control  
8: Use for a single wiping cycle.  
C. Temperature Control  
See Climate Control System on page 414.  
1-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 : Press 4 to display additional text information related  
to the current FM-RDS or XM station; or CD, MP3,  
WMA song. Song title information will be displayed on  
the top line of the display while the artist information  
will be displayed on the bottom line, it the information  
is available during XM, CD, MP3, or WMA playback.  
When information is not available, No Infodisplays.  
Vehicle Features  
Radio(s)  
For more information about these and other radio  
features, see Radio(s) on page 455.  
Storing a Favorite Station  
Depending on which radio the vehicle has, radio  
stations are stored as either favorites or presets.  
For radios with a FAV button, a maximum of 36 stations  
can be stored as favorites using the six softkeys located  
below the radio station frequency tabs and by using  
the radio FAV button. Press FAV to go through up to  
six pages of favorites, each having six favorite stations  
available per page. Each page of favorites can contain  
any combination of AM, FM, or XM stations.  
Radio with CD (MP3) and USB Port shown  
O : Press to turn the system on and off. Turn to  
increase or decrease the volume.  
For radios without a FAV button, up to 18 stations  
(six FM1, six FM2, and six AM), can be programmed  
on the six numbered buttons.  
BAND: Press to choose between FM, AM, or XM,  
if equipped.  
f : Select radio stations.  
For more information, see Radio(s) on page 455.  
© ¨ : Seek or scan stations.  
1-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting the Clock  
Satellite Radio  
To set the time and date for the Radio with CD (MP3)  
and USB port or the Radio with CD (MP3) player:  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM satellite radio has a wide variety  
of programming and commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound.  
1. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or  
ON/RUN.  
2. Press O to turn the radio on.  
A fee is required to receive the XM service.  
For more information, refer to:  
3. Press H and the HR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY  
(hour, minute, month, day, and year) displays.  
.
www.xmradio.com or call 1-800-929-2100 (U.S.)  
4. Press the softkey located below any one of the  
tabs that you want to change.  
.
www.xmradio.ca or call 1-877-438-9677 (Canada)  
See XM Satellite Radio Serviceunder Radio(s) on  
5. Increase or decrease the time or date by  
page 455  
.
turning f clockwise or counterclockwise.  
For detailed instructions on setting the clock for your  
specific audio system, see Setting the Clock on  
page 453  
.
1-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Portable Audio Devices  
Steering Wheel Controls  
(Auxiliary Input or USB Port)  
If equipped, some audio  
controls can be adjusted  
using the controls on the  
right side of the steering  
wheel.  
This vehicle may have an auxiliary input jack and  
a USB port, located on the audio faceplate. External  
devices such as iPods®, laptop computers, MP3  
players, CD changers, USB storage devices, etc. can  
be connected to the auxiliary input jack using a 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) cable or the USB port depending on the audio  
system.  
Press the CD/AUX button to play audio from the  
portable player.  
See Using the Auxiliary Input Jackand Using the  
USB Portunder Radio(s) on page 455.  
e + / e : Increases or decreases volume.  
w / x : Press to change radio stations, select tracks  
on a CD, or to select tracks and navigate folders on an  
iPod® or USB device.  
b g : Press to silence the vehicle speakers only. Press  
again to turn the sound on. Press and hold longer than  
two seconds to interact with the OnStar® or Bluetooth  
systems.  
c : Press to reject an incoming call, or to end a call.  
For more information, see Audio Steering Wheel  
Controls on page 484.  
1-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bluetooth®  
Cruise Control  
For vehicles with an in-vehicle Bluetooth system, it  
allows users with a Bluetooth enabled cell phone to  
make and receive hands-free calls using the vehicles  
audio system and controls.  
The cruise control buttons  
are located on the left  
side of the steering wheel.  
The Bluetooth enabled cell phone must be paired with  
the in-vehicle Bluetooth system before it can be used  
in the vehicle. Not all phones will support all functions.  
For more information visit www.gm.com/bluetooth.  
For more information, see Bluetooth® on page 473.  
J: On/Off.  
RES+: Press to resume or accelerate speed.  
SET: Press to set or decrease speed.  
For more information, see Cruise Control on page 46.  
1-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Outlets  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)  
Accessory power outlets can be used to connect  
electrical equipment, such as a cellular phone.  
The Electronic Stability Control system assists with  
directional control of the vehicle in difficult driving  
conditions. The system turns on automatically every  
time the vehicle is started.  
The accessory power outlet is located in the center  
console, rearward of the shift lever.  
.
To turn off both traction control and Electronic  
To use the accessory power outlet, remove the cover.  
Stability Control, press and hold d until  
See Accessory Power Outlet(s) on page 412 and  
Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter on page 413  
(If Equipped).  
F illuminates and the appropriate DIC message  
displays. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 440  
.
.
Press and release the button again to turn on both  
systems.  
Performance and Maintenance  
For more information, see Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC) on page 56.  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
The traction control system limits wheel spin.  
The system turns on automatically every time the  
vehicle is started.  
.
To turn off traction control, press and release d on  
the instrument panel. F illuminates and the  
appropriate DIC message displays. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 440.  
.
Press and release the button again to turn on  
traction control.  
For more information, see Traction Control System  
(TCS) on page 59.  
1-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
You may notice during cooler conditions that the low tire  
pressure warning light will appear when the vehicle is  
first started and then turn off as you drive. This may be  
an early indicator that your tire pressures are getting  
low and the tires need to be inflated to the proper  
pressure.  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor  
System (TPMS).  
The Tire Pressure  
Monitor alerts you when  
a significant reduction in  
pressure occurs in one or  
more of the vehicles tires  
by illuminating the low tire  
pressure warning light on  
the instrument cluster.  
The Tire Pressure Monitor can alert you about low tire  
pressure, but it does not replace normal monthly tire  
maintenance. It is the drivers responsibility to maintain  
correct tire pressures.  
See Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 667 and  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 668.  
If the warning light comes on, stop as soon as possible  
and inflate the tires to the recommended pressure  
shown on the tire loading information label located on  
the driver side center pillar (B pillar). See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 525. The warning light will remain on  
until the tire pressure is corrected.  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
This vehicle may come with a jack and spare tire or a  
tire sealant and compressor kit. The kit can be used to  
seal small punctures in the tread area of the tire.  
See Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit on page 684 for  
complete operating information.  
1-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Oil Life System  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy  
The engine oil life system calculates engine oil life  
based on vehicle use and displays a DIC message  
when it is necessary to change the engine oil and filter.  
The oil life system should be reset to 100% only  
following an oil change.  
Driving habits can affect fuel mileage. Here are some  
driving tips to get the best fuel economy possible.  
.
Avoid fast starts and accelerate smoothly.  
.
Brake gradually and avoid abrupt stops.  
.
Avoid idling the engine for long periods of time.  
Resetting the Oil Life System  
1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN, with the engine off.  
.
When road and weather conditions are  
appropriate, use cruise control, if equipped.  
2. Press the DIC information and reset buttons at the  
same time to enter the personalization menu.  
.
Always follow posted speed limits or drive more  
slowly when conditions require.  
3. Press the information button until the DIC display  
shows OIL-LIFE RESET.  
.
Keep vehicle tires properly inflated.  
.
Combine several trips into a single trip.  
4. Press and hold the reset button until the DIC  
display shows ACKNOWLEDGED.  
.
Replace the vehicle's tires with the same TPC  
Spec number molded into the tire's sidewall near  
the size.  
5. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF.  
See Engine Oil Life System on page 621.  
.
Follow recommended scheduled maintenance.  
1-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Assistance Program  
U.S.: 1-800-CHEV-USA (1-800-243-8872)  
TTY Users: 1-888-889-2438  
OnStar®  
Canada: 1-800-268-6800  
As the owner of a new Chevrolet, you are automatically  
enrolled in the Roadside Assistance program.  
This program provides technically trained advisors  
who are available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year,  
minor repair information or towing arrangements.  
OnStar® uses several innovative technologies and live  
advisors to provide a wide range of safety, security,  
navigation, diagnostics, and calling services.  
Roadside Assistance and OnStar  
If you have a current OnStar subscription, press the  
OnStar button and the current GPS location will be sent  
to an OnStar Advisor who will assess your problem,  
contact Roadside Assistance, and relay exact location  
to get you the help you need.  
Automatic Crash Response  
In a crash, built in sensors can automatically alert an  
OnStar advisor who is immediately connected to the  
vehicle to see if you need help.  
Online Owner Center  
The Online Owner Center is a complimentary service  
that includes online service reminders, vehicle  
maintenance tips, online owner manual, special  
privileges and more.  
Sign up today at: www.gmownercenter.com/chevrolet  
(U.S.) or www.gm.ca (Canada).  
1-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For a full description of OnStar services and system  
limitations, see the OnStar Owner's Guide in the  
glove box.  
How OnStar Service Works  
Q : This blue button connects you to a specially  
trained OnStar advisor to verify your account  
information and to answer questions.  
OnStar service is subject to the OnStar terms and  
conditions included in the OnStar Subscriber  
Information.  
] : Push this red emergency button to get priority help  
from specially trained OnStar emergency advisors.  
OnStar service cannot work unless the vehicle is in a  
place where OnStar has an agreement with a wireless  
service provider for service in that area. OnStar service  
also cannot work unless the vehicle is in a place where  
the wireless service provider OnStar has hired for that  
area has coverage, network capacity and reception  
when the service is needed, and technology that is  
compatible with the OnStar service. Not all services  
are available everywhere, particularly in remote or  
enclosed areas, or at all times.  
X : Push this button for handsfree, voiceactivated  
calling and to give voice commands for turnbyturn  
navigation.  
Crisis Assist, Stolen Vehicle Assistance, Vehicle  
Diagnostics, Remote Door Unlock, Roadside  
Assistance, TurnbyTurn Navigation and HandsFree  
Calling are available on most vehicles. Not all OnStar  
services are available on all vehicles. For more  
information see the OnStar Owner's Guide or visit  
www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada),  
contact OnStar at 1-888-4-ONSTAR (18884667827)  
or TTY 18772482080, or press Q to speak with an  
OnStar advisor 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.  
1-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The OnStar system can record and transmit vehicle  
information. This information is automatically sent to an  
OnStar Steering Wheel Controls  
This vehicle may have a Talk/Mute button that can  
be used to interact with OnStar hands-free calling.  
See Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 484  
for more information.  
OnStar call center when Q is pressed, ] is pressed,  
or if the airbags or ACR system deploy. This information  
usually includes the vehicle's GPS location and, in the  
event of a crash, additional information regarding the  
crash that the vehicle was involved in (e.g. the direction  
from which the vehicle was hit). When the virtual  
advisor feature of OnStar hands-free calling is used, the  
vehicle also sends OnStar the vehicle's GPS location  
so they can provide services where it is located.  
On some vehicles, the mute button can be used to  
dial numbers into voice mail systems, or to dial phone  
extensions. See the OnStar Owner's Guide for more  
information.  
Your Responsibility  
Increase the volume of the radio if the OnStar advisor  
cannot be heard.  
Location information about the vehicle is only available  
if the GPS satellite signals are unobstructed and  
available.  
If the light next to the OnStar buttons is red, the system  
The vehicle must have a working electrical system,  
including adequate battery power, for the OnStar  
equipment to operate. There are other problems OnStar  
cannot control that may prevent OnStar from providing  
OnStar service at any particular time or place. Some  
examples are damage to important parts of the vehicle  
in a crash, hills, tall buildings, tunnels, weather or  
wireless phone network congestion.  
may not be functioning properly. Press Q and request a  
vehicle diagnostic. If the light appears clear (no light is  
appearing), your OnStar subscription has expired and  
all services have been deactivated. Press Q to confirm  
that the OnStar equipment is active.  
1-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
1-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2 Seats and Restraint System  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children  
Manual Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Seat Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Manual Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7  
Easy Entry Seat (Coupe) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
(LATCH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Seat  
Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47  
Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front  
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56  
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-58  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59  
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59  
What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates? . . . 2-60  
Passenger Sensing System (Without Turbo  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Split Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24  
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30  
Safety Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30  
Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62  
Passenger Sensing System (With Turbo  
Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-67  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . 2-72  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37  
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73  
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74  
Checking the Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74  
Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-75  
2-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has a manual seat, it can be moved  
forward or rearward.  
Front Seats  
1. Lift the bar to unlock  
the seat.  
Manual Seats  
2. Slide the seat to the  
desired position and  
release the bar.  
WARNING:  
{
You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to  
adjust a manual driver's seat while the vehicle is  
moving. The sudden movement could startle and  
confuse you, or make you push a pedal when you  
do not want to. Adjust the driver's seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
Try to move the seat with your body to be sure the seat  
is locked in place.  
2-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Height Adjuster  
Manual Lumbar  
On vehicles with this  
feature, the knob is  
located on the front of the  
driver seat lower cushion  
on the inboard side.  
Turn the knob clockwise or counterclockwise to  
increase or decrease the lumbar support.  
The driver's seat height adjuster is located on the  
outboard side of the seat.  
To raise the seat, move the lever upward repeatedly  
until the seat is at the desired height. To lower the seat,  
move the lever downward repeatedly until the seat is at  
the desired height.  
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Heated Seats  
Your vehicle may have heated front seats. The switches  
are located on the instrument panel above the climate  
control system.  
Reclining Seatbacks  
WARNING:  
{
Press the side of the  
switch with the double  
indicator lights to turn on  
the heated seat at the  
highest setting.  
You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to  
adjust a manual driver's seat while the vehicle is  
moving. The sudden movement could startle and  
confuse you, or make you push a pedal when you  
do not want to. Adjust the driver's seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
WARNING:  
{
Driver's Switch Shown,  
Passenger's Switch  
Similar  
If either seatback is not locked, it could move  
forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could  
cause injury to the person sitting there. Always  
push and pull on the seatbacks to be sure they  
are locked.  
Both indicator lights will be lit to indicate that the setting  
is on high. Press the side of the switch with the single  
indicator light to go to the low setting. The indicator light  
will be lit to indicate that the setting is on low. Return  
the switch to the center to turn off the heated seat.  
Your seats have manual reclining seatbacks. The lever  
used to operate them is located on the outboard side of  
the seats.  
If your vehicle has been turned off, the last heated  
seat setting will be retained when the vehicle is  
started again.  
2-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To return the seatback to an upright position, do the  
following:  
1. Lift the lever fully without applying pressure to the  
seatback and the seatback will return to the upright  
position.  
2. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is  
locked.  
To recline the seatback, do the following:  
1. Lift the recline lever.  
2. Move the seatback to the desired position, then  
release the lever to lock the seatback in place.  
3. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is  
locked.  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Sitting in a reclined position when the vehicle is in  
motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up,  
the safety belts cannot do their job when reclined  
like this.  
The shoulder belt cannot do its job because it will  
not be against your body. Instead, it will be in front  
of you. In a crash, you could go into it, receiving  
neck or other injuries.  
The lap belt cannot do its job either. In a crash,  
the belt could go up over your abdomen. The belt  
forces would be there, not at your pelvic bones.  
This could cause serious internal injuries.  
For proper protection when the vehicle is in  
motion, have the seatback upright. Then sit well  
back in the seat and wear the safety belt properly.  
Do not have a seatback reclined if your vehicle is  
moving.  
2-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pull the head restraint up  
to raise it. To lower the  
head restraint, press the  
button, located on the top  
of the seatback, and push  
the restraint down.  
Head Restraints  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top of the restraint  
is at the same height as the top of the occupant's head.  
This position reduces the chance of a neck injury in a  
crash.  
2-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To use the easy entry seat, do the following:  
Easy Entry Seat (Coupe)  
WARNING:  
{
If the easy entry right front seat is not locked, it  
can move. In a sudden stop or crash, the person  
sitting there could be injured. After you have used  
it, be sure to push rearward on an easy entry seat  
to be sure it is locked.  
WARNING:  
{
If either seatback is not locked, it could move  
forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could  
cause injury to the person sitting there. Always  
push and pull on the seatbacks to be sure they  
are locked.  
1. Push down the easy entry seat handle located on  
the rear of the seatback on the outboard side to  
release the seatback.  
2. Tilt the seatback forward completely while pushing  
the seat forward.  
The front passenger seat can be used to easily get in  
and out of the rear seat.  
2-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Move the seat rearward until it locks into place  
after someone gets into the rear seat area.  
To lower the rear seatback, follow these steps:  
4. Move the seatback to its original position and  
make sure the seatback is locked.  
Rear Seats  
Split Folding Rear Seat  
You can fold either side of the rear seatback down for  
more cargo space.  
1. Open the trunk and pull one or both of the small  
handles located in the center of the trunk.  
Notice: Folding a rear seat with the safety belts  
still fastened may cause damage to the seat or the  
safety belts. Always unbuckle the safety belts and  
return them to their normal stowed position before  
folding a rear seat.  
2. Push the seatback open through the trunk, or pull it  
down from inside the vehicle.  
2-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To raise the rear seatback, lift it up and push rearward  
until you hear a click. Push and pull on the seatback to  
be sure it is locked into place.  
Safety Belts  
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone  
This section of the manual describes how to use safety  
belts properly. It also describes some things not to do  
with safety belts.  
WARNING:  
{
If the seatback is not locked, it could move  
forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could  
cause injury to the person sitting there. Always  
pull forward on the top of the seatback at the area  
of the latch to be sure it is locked.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not let anyone ride where a safety belt  
cannot be worn properly. In a crash, if you or  
your passenger(s) are not wearing safety belts,  
the injuries can be much worse. You can hit things  
inside the vehicle harder or be ejected from  
the vehicle. You and your passenger(s) can be  
seriously injured or killed. In the same crash, you  
might not be, if you are buckled up. Always fasten  
your safety belt, and check that your passenger(s)  
are restrained properly too.  
WARNING:  
{
A safety belt that is improperly routed, not  
properly attached, or twisted will not provide the  
protection needed in a crash. The person wearing  
the belt could be seriously injured. After raising  
the rear seatback, always check to be sure that  
the safety belts are properly routed and attached,  
and are not twisted.  
2-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In most states and in all Canadian provinces, the law  
requires wearing safety belts. Here is why:  
WARNING:  
{
You never know if you will be in a crash. If you do have  
a crash, you do not know if it will be a serious one.  
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,  
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision,  
people riding in these areas are more likely to  
be seriously injured or killed. Do not allow people  
to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not  
equipped with seats and safety belts. Be sure  
everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a  
safety belt properly.  
A few crashes are mild, and some crashes can be so  
serious that even buckled up, a person would not  
survive. But most crashes are in between. In many of  
them, people who buckle up can survive and sometimes  
walk away. Without safety belts, they could have been  
badly hurt or killed.  
After more than 40 years of safety belts in vehicles,  
the facts are clear. In most crashes buckling up does  
matter ... a lot!  
This vehicle has indicators as a reminder to buckle the  
safety belts. See Safety Belt Reminders on page 420  
for additional information.  
2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Why Safety Belts Work  
When you ride in or on anything, you go as fast as  
it goes.  
Put someone on it.  
Take the simplest vehicle. Suppose it is just a seat on  
wheels.  
2-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Get it up to speed. Then stop the vehicle. The rider  
does not stop.  
The person keeps going until stopped by something.  
In a real vehicle, it could be the windshield...  
2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
or the instrument panel...  
or the safety belts!  
With safety belts, you slow down as the vehicle does.  
You get more time to stop. You stop over more distance,  
and your strongest bones take the forces. That is why  
safety belts make such good sense.  
2-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: If I am a good driver, and I never drive far from  
home, why should I wear safety belts?  
Questions and Answers About Safety  
Belts  
A: You may be an excellent driver, but if you are in a  
crash even one that is not your fault you and  
your passenger(s) can be hurt. Being a good driver  
does not protect you from things beyond your  
control, such as bad drivers.  
Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicle after a crash if I  
am wearing a safety belt?  
A: You could be whether you are wearing a safety  
belt or not. But your chance of being conscious  
during and after an accident, so you can unbuckle  
and get out, is much greater if you are belted. And  
you can unbuckle a safety belt, even if you are  
upside down.  
Most accidents occur within 25 miles (40 km) of  
home. And the greatest number of serious injuries  
and deaths occur at speeds of less than 40 mph  
(65 km/h).  
Safety belts are for everyone.  
Q: If my vehicle has airbags, why should I have to  
wear safety belts?  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly  
A: Airbags are supplemental systems only; so they  
work with safety belts not instead of them.  
Whether or not an airbag is provided, all occupants  
still have to buckle up to get the most protection.  
That is true not only in frontal collisions, but  
especially in side and other collisions.  
This section is only for people of adult size.  
Be aware that there are special things to know about  
safety belts and children. And there are different rules  
for smaller children and infants. If a child will be riding in  
the vehicle, see Older Children on page 231 or Infants  
and Young Children on page 234. Follow those rules  
for everyone's protection.  
It is very important for all occupants to buckle up.  
Statistics show that unbelted people are hurt more often  
in crashes than those who are wearing safety belts.  
2-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupants who are not buckled up can be thrown out of  
the vehicle in a crash. And they can strike others in the  
vehicle who are wearing safety belts.  
In a crash, this applies force to the strong pelvic bones  
and you would be less likely to slide under the lap belt.  
If you slid under it, the belt would apply force on your  
abdomen. This could cause serious or even fatal  
injuries. The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder  
and across the chest. These parts of the body are best  
able to take belt restraining forces.  
First, before you or your passenger(s) wear a safety  
belt, there is important information you should know.  
The shoulder belt locks if there is a sudden stop or  
crash.  
Sit up straight and always keep your feet on the floor in  
front of you. The lap part of the belt should be worn low  
and snug on the hips, just touching the thighs.  
2-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt is  
too loose. In a crash, you would move forward too  
much, which could increase injury. The shoulder  
belt should fit snugly against your body.  
A: The shoulder belt is too loose. It will not give as  
much protection this way.  
2-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your lap belt is too  
loose. In a crash, you could slide under the lap  
belt and apply force on your abdomen. This could  
cause serious or even fatal injuries. The lap belt  
should be worn low and snug on the hips, just  
touching the thighs.  
A: The lap belt is too loose. It will not give nearly as  
much protection this way.  
2-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if your belt is buckled  
in the wrong place like this. In a crash, the belt  
would go up over your abdomen. The belt forces  
would be there, not on the pelvic bones. This  
could cause serious internal injuries. Always  
buckle your belt into the buckle nearest you.  
A: The belt is buckled in the wrong buckle.  
2-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if your belt goes over  
an armrest like this. The belt would be much too  
high. In a crash, you can slide under the belt.  
The belt force would then be applied on the  
abdomen, not on the pelvic bones, and that  
could cause serious or fatal injuries. Be sure  
the belt goes under the armrests.  
A: The belt is over an armrest.  
2-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if you wear the  
shoulder belt under your arm. In a crash, your  
body would move too far forward, which would  
increase the chance of head and neck injury.  
Also, the belt would apply too much force to the  
ribs, which are not as strong as shoulder bones.  
You could also severely injure internal organs like  
your liver or spleen. The shoulder belt should go  
over the shoulder and across the chest.  
A: The shoulder belt is worn under the arm. It should  
be worn over the shoulder at all times.  
2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured by not wearing the  
lap-shoulder belt properly. In a crash, you would  
not be restrained by the shoulder belt. Your body  
could move too far forward increasing the chance  
of head and neck injury. You might also slide  
under the lap belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen. That could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across the chest.  
A: The belt is behind the body.  
2-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured by a twisted belt. In a  
crash, you would not have the full width of the belt  
to spread impact forces. If a belt is twisted, make  
it straight so it can work properly, or ask your  
dealer/retailer to fix it.  
A: The belt is twisted across the body.  
2-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Adjust the seat, if the seat is adjustable, so you  
can sit up straight. To see how, see Seatsin the  
Index.  
Lap-Shoulder Belt  
All seating positions in the vehicle have a  
lap-shoulder belt.  
3. Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you.  
Do not let it get twisted.  
The following instructions explain how to wear a  
lapshoulder belt properly.  
The lap-shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt  
across you very quickly. If this happens, let the belt  
go back slightly to unlock it. Then pull the belt  
across you more slowly.  
Engaging the child restraint locking feature may  
affect the passenger sensing system, if equipped.  
See Passenger Sensing System (Without Turbo  
Engine) on page 262 or Passenger Sensing  
System (With Turbo Engine) on page 267 for  
more information.  
1. If the seat has a safety belt guide, and the safety  
belt is not routed through the guide, slide the edge  
of the belt webbing through the opening on the  
guide. Be sure the belt is not twisted.  
2-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
6. To make the lap part tight, pull up on the  
shoulder belt.  
Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure.  
If the belt is not long enough, see Safety Belt  
It may be necessary to pull stitching on the safety  
belt through the latch plate to fully tighten the lap  
belt on smaller occupants.  
Extender on page 230  
.
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly if necessary.  
5. If equipped with a shoulder belt height adjuster,  
move it to the height that is right for you. See  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjustmentlater in this  
section for instructions on use and important safety  
information.  
2-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster  
(Sedan Only)  
The vehicle has a shoulder belt height adjuster for the  
driver and right front passenger position.  
Adjust the height so that the shoulder portion of the belt  
is centered on the shoulder. The belt should be away  
from the face and neck, but not falling off the shoulder.  
Improper shoulder belt height adjustment could reduce  
the effectiveness of the safety belt in a crash.  
Press the release  
button (A) and move  
the height adjuster to  
the desired position.  
The adjuster can be  
moved up by pushing  
up on the shoulder belt  
guide.  
To unlatch the belt, push the button on the buckle.  
The belt should return to its stowed position.  
Before a door is closed, be sure the safety belt is out  
of the way. If a door is slammed against a safety belt,  
damage can occur to both the belt and the vehicle.  
After the height adjuster is set to the desired position,  
try to move it down without pressing the release button  
to make sure it has locked into position.  
2-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here is how to install a comfort guide to the safety belt:  
Safety Belt Pretensioners  
This vehicle has safety belt pretensioners for front  
outboard occupants. Although the safety belt  
pretensioners cannot be seen, they are part of the  
safety belt assembly. They can help tighten the safety  
belts during the early stages of a moderate to severe  
frontal or near frontal crash if the threshold conditions  
for pretensioner activation are met. And, if the vehicle  
has side impact airbags, safety belt pretensioners can  
help tighten the safety belts in a side crash.  
Pretensioners work only once. If the pretensioners  
activate in a crash, they will need to be replaced, and  
probably other new parts for the vehicle's safety belt  
system. See Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Crash on page 275.  
Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides  
1. Pull the elastic cord out from between the edge of  
the seatback and the interior body to remove the  
guide from its storage clip.  
This vehicle may have rear shoulder belt comfort  
guides. If not, they are available through your dealer/  
retailer. The guides may provide added safety belt  
comfort for older children who have outgrown booster  
seats and for some adults. When installed and properly  
adjusted, the comfort guide positions the belt away from  
the neck and head.  
2-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Place the guide over the belt and insert the two  
edges of the belt into the slots of the guide.  
3. Be sure that the belt is not twisted and it lies flat.  
The elastic cord must be under the belt and the  
guide on top.  
2-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
A safety belt that is not properly worn may not  
provide the protection needed in a crash. The  
person wearing the belt could be seriously injured.  
The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder and  
across the chest. These parts of the body are best  
able to take belt restraining forces.  
4. Buckle, position, and release the safety belt as  
described previously in this section. Make sure that  
the shoulder belt crosses the shoulder.  
To remove and store the comfort guide, squeeze the  
belt edges together so the safety belt can be removed  
from the guide. Pull the guide upward to expose its  
storage clip, and then slide the guide onto the clip. Turn  
the guide and clip inward and slide them in between the  
seatback and the interior body, leaving only the loop of  
the elastic cord exposed.  
2-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the  
mother. When a safety belt is worn properly, it is  
more likely that the fetus will not be hurt in a crash.  
For pregnant women, as for anyone, the key to making  
safety belts effective is wearing them properly.  
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy  
Safety belts work for everyone, including pregnant  
women. Like all occupants, they are more likely to be  
seriously injured if they do not wear safety belts.  
Safety Belt Extender  
If the vehicle's safety belt will fasten around you, you  
should use it.  
But if a safety belt is not long enough, your dealer/  
retailer will order you an extender. When you go in to  
order it, take the heaviest coat you will wear, so the  
extender will be long enough for you. To help avoid  
personal injury, do not let someone else use it, and use  
it only for the seat it is made to fit. The extender has  
been designed for adults. Never use it for securing  
child seats. To wear it, attach it to the regular safety  
belt. For more information, see the instruction sheet  
that comes with the extender.  
A pregnant woman should wear a lap-shoulder belt,  
and the lap portion should be worn as low as possible,  
below the rounding, throughout the pregnancy.  
2-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The manufacturer's instructions that come with the  
booster seat state the weight and height limitations for  
that booster. Use a booster seat with a lap-shoulder belt  
until the child passes the below fit test:  
Child Restraints  
Older Children  
.
Sit all the way back on the seat. Do the knees  
bend at the seat edge? If yes, continue. If no,  
return to the booster seat.  
.
Buckle the lap-shoulder belt. Does the shoulder  
belt rest on the shoulder? If yes, continue. If no, try  
using the rear safety belt comfort guide. See Rear  
Safety Belt Comfort Guidesunder Lap-Shoulder  
Belt on page 224 for more information. If the  
shoulder belt still does not rest on the shoulder,  
then return to the booster seat.  
.
Does the lap belt fit low and snug on the hips,  
touching the thighs? If yes, continue. If no, return  
to the booster seat.  
.
Can proper safety belt fit be maintained for the  
length of the trip? If yes, continue. If no, return to  
the booster seat.  
Older children who have outgrown booster seats should  
wear the vehicle's safety belts.  
.
If you have the choice, a child should sit in a  
position with a lap-shoulder belt and get the  
additional restraint a shoulder belt can provide.  
2-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is the proper way to wear safety belts?  
WARNING:  
A: An older child should wear a lap-shoulder belt  
and get the additional restraint a shoulder belt  
can provide. The shoulder belt should not cross  
the face or neck. The lap belt should fit snugly  
below the hips, just touching the top of the thighs.  
This applies belt force to the child's pelvic bones in  
a crash. It should never be worn over the abdomen,  
which could cause severe or even fatal internal  
injuries in a crash.  
{
Never do this.  
Never allow two children to wear the same safety  
belt. The safety belt can not properly spread the  
impact forces. In a crash, the two children can be  
crushed together and seriously injured. A safety  
belt must be used by only one person at a time.  
Also see Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guidesunder  
Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 224.  
According to accident statistics, children and infants  
are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint  
system or infant restraint system secured in a rear  
seating position.  
In a crash, children who are not buckled up can strike  
other people who are buckled up, or can be thrown out  
of the vehicle. Older children need to use safety belts  
properly.  
2-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Never allow a child to wear the safety belt with the  
shoulder belt behind their back. A child can be  
seriously injured by not wearing the lap-shoulder  
belt properly. In a crash, the child would not be  
restrained by the shoulder belt. The child could  
move too far forward increasing the chance of  
head and neck injury. The child might also slide  
under the lap belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen. That could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across the chest.  
2-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Children who are not restrained properly can strike  
other people, or can be thrown out of the vehicle.  
Infants and Young Children  
Everyone in a vehicle needs protection! This includes  
infants and all other children. Neither the distance  
traveled nor the age and size of the traveler changes  
the need, for everyone, to use safety restraints. In fact,  
the law in every state in the United States and in every  
Canadian province says children up to some age must  
be restrained while in a vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Never hold an infant or a child while riding in a  
vehicle. Due to crash forces, an infant or a child  
will become so heavy it is not possible to hold it  
during a crash. For example, in a crash at only  
40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb) infant will  
suddenly become a 110 kg (240 lb) force on a  
person's arms. An infant should be secured in  
an appropriate restraint.  
WARNING:  
{
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a  
shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to tighten. Never leave  
children unattended in a vehicle and never allow  
children to play with the safety belts.  
Airbags plus lapshoulder belts offer protection for  
adults and older children, but not for young children and  
infants. Neither the vehicle's safety belt system nor its  
airbag system is designed for them. Every time infants  
and young children ride in vehicles, they should have  
the protection provided by appropriate child restraints.  
2-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
in a rear seat. It is also better to secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in a rear seat. If you  
must secure a forward-facing child restraint in the  
right front seat, always move the front passenger  
seat as far back as it will go.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Children who are up against, or very close to, any  
airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or  
killed. Never put a rear-facing child restraint in the  
right front seat. Secure a rear-facing child restraint  
(Continued)  
2-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What are the different types of add-on child  
restraints?  
WARNING:  
{
A: Add-on child restraints, which are purchased by the  
vehicle's owner, are available in four basic types.  
Selection of a particular restraint should take into  
consideration not only the child's weight, height, and  
age but also whether or not the restraint will be  
compatible with the motor vehicle in which it will  
be used.  
To reduce the risk of neck and head injury during  
a crash, infants need complete support. This is  
because an infant's neck is not fully developed  
and its head weighs so much compared with  
the rest of its body. In a crash, an infant in a  
rear-facing child restraint settles into the restraint,  
so the crash forces can be distributed across the  
strongest part of an infant's body, the back and  
shoulders. Infants should always be secured in  
rear-facing child restraints.  
For most basic types of child restraints, there are  
many different models available. When purchasing a  
child restraint, be sure it is designed to be used in a  
motor vehicle. If it is, the restraint will have a label  
saying that it meets federal motor vehicle safety  
standards.  
The restraint manufacturer's instructions that come  
with the restraint state the weight and height  
limitations for a particular child restraint. In addition,  
there are many kinds of restraints available for  
children with special needs.  
2-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Restraint Systems  
WARNING:  
{
A rear-facing infant  
seat (A) provides restraint  
with the seating surface  
against the back of the  
infant.  
A young child's hip bones are still so small that  
the vehicle's regular safety belt may not remain  
low on the hip bones, as it should. Instead, it may  
settle up around the child's abdomen. In a crash,  
the belt would apply force on a body area that is  
unprotected by any bony structure. This alone  
could cause serious or fatal injuries. To reduce  
the risk of serious or fatal injuries during a crash,  
young children should always be secured in  
appropriate child restraints.  
The harness system holds the infant in place and, in a  
crash, acts to keep the infant positioned in the restraint.  
A forward-facing child  
seat (B) provides restraint  
for the child's body with  
the harness.  
2-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing an Add-On Child Restraint  
in the Vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash  
if the child restraint is not properly secured in the  
vehicle. Secure the child restraint properly in the  
vehicle using the vehicle's safety belt or LATCH  
system, following the instructions that came with  
that child restraint and the instructions in this  
manual.  
A booster seat (C-D) is a child restraint designed to  
improve the fit of the vehicle's safety belt system.  
A booster seat can also help a child to see out the  
window.  
To help reduce the chance of injury, the child restraint  
must be secured in the vehicle. Child restraint systems  
must be secured in vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap  
belt portion of a lap-shoulder belt, or by the LATCH  
system. See Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children  
(LATCH) on page 241 for more information. A child  
can be endangered in a crash if the child restraint is not  
properly secured in the vehicle.  
2-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When securing an add-on child restraint, refer to the  
instructions that come with the restraint which may be  
on the restraint itself or in a booklet, or both, and to this  
manual. The child restraint instructions are important,  
so if they are not available, obtain a replacement copy  
from the manufacturer.  
Where to Put the Restraint  
According to accident statistics, children and infants  
are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint  
system or infant restraint system secured in a rear  
seating position.  
We recommend that children and child restraints be  
secured in a rear seat, including: an infant or a child  
riding in a rear-facing child restraint; a child riding in  
a forward-facing child seat; an older child riding in a  
booster seat; and children, who are large enough,  
using safety belts.  
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can  
move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any  
child restraint in the vehicle even when no child  
is in it.  
Securing the Child Within the Child  
Restraint  
WARNING:  
{
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash  
if the child is not properly secured in the child  
restraint. Secure the child properly following the  
instructions that came with that child restraint.  
2-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child restraint in the front.This is because the risk to  
the rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
See Passenger Sensing System (Without Turbo  
Engine) on page 262 or Passenger Sensing  
System (With Turbo Engine) on page 267 for  
additional information.  
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating  
position, study the instructions that came with the child  
restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle.  
The vehicle may have a passenger sensing  
system which is designed to turn off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions.  
Wherever a child restraint is installed, be sure to secure  
the child restraint properly.  
Even if the passenger sensing system,  
if equipped, has turned off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag, no system is fail-safe.  
No one can guarantee that an airbag will not  
deploy under some unusual circumstance, even  
though it is turned off.  
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can  
move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any  
child restraint in the vehicle even when no child  
is in it.  
(Continued)  
2-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lower Anchors  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for  
Children (LATCH)  
The LATCH system holds a child restraint during  
driving or in a crash. This system is designed to make  
installation of a child restraint easier. The LATCH  
system uses anchors in the vehicle and attachments on  
the child restraint that are made for use with the LATCH  
system.  
Make sure that a LATCH-compatible child restraint is  
properly installed using the anchors, or use the vehicle's  
safety belts to secure the restraint, following the  
instructions that came with that restraint, and also the  
instructions in this manual. When installing a child  
restraint with a top tether, you must also use either the  
lower anchors or the safety belts to properly secure the  
child restraint. A child restraint must never be installed  
using only the top tether and anchor.  
Lower anchors (A) are metal bars built into the vehicle.  
There are two lower anchors for each LATCH seating  
position that will accommodate a child restraint with  
lower attachments (B).  
In order to use the LATCH system in your vehicle, you  
need a child restraint that has LATCH attachments.  
The child restraint manufacturer will provide you with  
instructions on how to use the child restraint and its  
attachments. The following explains how to attach a  
child restraint with these attachments in your vehicle.  
Not all vehicle seating positions or child restraints have  
lower anchors and attachments or top tether anchors  
and attachments.  
2-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Some child restraints that have a top tether are  
designed for use with or without the top tether  
being attached. Others require the top tether always  
to be attached. In Canada, the law requires that  
forward-facing child restraints have a top tether, and  
that the tether be attached. Be sure to read and  
follow the instructions for your child restraint.  
Top Tether Anchor  
Lower Anchor and Top Tether Anchor  
Locations  
i (Top Tether Anchor):  
Seating positions with top  
tether anchors.  
j (Lower Anchor):  
Seating positions with two  
lower anchors.  
A top tether (A, C) anchors the top of the child restraint  
to the vehicle. A top tether anchor is built into the  
vehicle. The top tether attachment (B) on the child  
restraint connects to the top tether anchor in the vehicle  
in order to reduce the forward movement and rotation of  
the child restraint during driving or in a crash.  
Rear Seat  
Each rear seating position has two exposed metal lower  
anchors in the crease between the seatback and the  
seat cushion.  
Your child restraint may have a single tether (A) or a  
dual tether (C). Either will have a single attachment (B)  
to secure the top tether to the anchor.  
2-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To assist you in locating  
the top tether anchors, the  
top tether anchor symbol  
is located on the cover.  
The top tether anchors are located under the covers on  
the rear seatback filler panel. Open the cover to access  
the anchor. Be sure to use an anchor located on the  
same side of the vehicle as the seating position where  
the child restraint will be placed.  
Do not secure a child restraint in a position without a  
top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that  
the top tether be attached, or if the instructions that  
come with the child restraint say that the top tether  
must be attached.  
According to accident statistics, children and infants  
are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint  
system or infant restraint system secured in a rear  
seating position. See Where to Put the Restraint on  
page 239 for additional information.  
2-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing a Child Restraint Designed  
for the LATCH System  
WARNING:  
{
Do not attach more than one child restraint to a  
single anchor. Attaching more than one child  
restraint to a single anchor could cause the  
anchor or attachment to come loose or even  
break during a crash. A child or others could be  
injured. To reduce the risk of serious or fatal  
injuries during a crash, attach only one child  
restraint per anchor.  
WARNING:  
{
If a LATCH-type child restraint is not attached to  
anchors, the child restraint will not be able to  
protect the child correctly. In a crash, the child  
could be seriously injured or killed. Install a  
LATCH-type child restraint properly using the  
anchors, or use the vehicle's safety belts to  
secure the restraint, following the instructions that  
came with the child restraint and the instructions  
in this manual.  
WARNING:  
{
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a  
shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to tighten. Buckle any  
unused safety belts behind the child restraint so  
children cannot reach them. Pull the shoulder belt  
all the way out of the retractor to set the lock,  
if your vehicle has one, after the child restraint  
has been installed.  
2-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Do not let the LATCH attachments rub  
against the vehicles safety belts. This may damage  
these parts. If necessary, move buckled safety belts  
to avoid rubbing the LATCH attachments.  
2. If the child restraint manufacturer recommends that  
the top tether be attached, attach and tighten the  
top tether to the top tether anchor, if equipped.  
Refer to the child restraint instructions and the  
following steps:  
Do not fold the empty rear seat with a safety belt  
buckled. This could damage the safety belt or the  
seat. Unbuckle and return the safety belt to its  
stowed position, before folding the seat.  
2.1. Find the top tether anchor.  
2.2. Open the top tether anchor cover to expose  
the anchor.  
1. Attach and tighten the lower attachments to the  
lower anchors. If the child restraint does not have  
lower attachments or the desired seating position  
does not have lower anchors, secure the child  
restraint with the top tether and the safety belts.  
Refer to your child restraint manufacturer  
2.3. If you have an adjustable headrest or head  
restraint, raise the headrest or head restraint.  
2.4. Route, attach, and tighten the top tether  
according to your child restraint instructions  
and the following instructions:  
instructions and the instructions in this manual.  
If the position you are  
using does not have a  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a  
single tether, route the  
tether over the seatback.  
1.1. Find the lower anchors for the desired  
seating position.  
1.2. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
1.3. Attach and tighten the lower attachments on  
the child restraint to the lower anchors.  
2-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the position you are  
using does not have a  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a dual  
tether, route the tether  
over the seatback.  
If the position you are  
using has a fixed or  
adjustable headrest or  
head restraint and you are  
using a dual tether, route  
the tether around the  
headrest or head  
restraint.  
3. Push and pull the child restraint in different  
directions to be sure it is secure.  
If the position you are  
using has an adjustable  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a  
single tether, raise the  
headrest or head restraint  
and route the tether under  
the headrest or head  
restraint and in between  
the headrest or head  
restraint posts.  
2-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child  
restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear  
Seat Position  
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating  
position, study the instructions that came with your child  
restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle.  
If your child restraint does not have the LATCH  
system, you will be using the safety belt to secure  
the child restraint in this position. Be sure to follow the  
instructions that came with the child restraint. Secure  
the child in the child restraint when and as the  
instructions say.  
If your child restraint has the LATCH system, see  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on  
page 241 for how to install your child restraint using  
LATCH. If you secure a child restraint using a safety  
belt and it uses a top tether, see Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 241 for top  
tether anchor locations.  
If you need to install more than one child restraint in the  
rear seat, be sure to read Where to Put the Restraint on  
page 239  
.
1. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
Do not secure a child restraint in a position without a  
top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that  
the top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that  
come with the child restraint say that the top strap must  
be anchored.  
2. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and  
shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt  
through or around the restraint. The child restraint  
instructions will show you how.  
2-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
4. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt all the way out of  
the retractor to set the lock.  
Make sure the release button is positioned so you  
would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if  
necessary.  
2-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. If your child restraint has a top tether, follow the  
child restraint manufacturer's instructions regarding  
the use of the top tether. See Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 241 for  
more information.  
7. Push and pull the child restraint in different  
directions to be sure it is secure.  
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicles  
safety belt and let it go back all the way. If the top tether  
is attached to a top tether anchor, disconnect it.  
If your seat has a safety belt guide, return the safety  
belt into the guide on the seatback by sliding the  
webbing through the opening on the guide.  
5. To tighten the belt, push down on the child  
restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt, and feed the  
shoulder belt back into the retractor. If you are  
using a forward-facing child restraint, you may find  
it helpful to use your knee to push down on the  
child restraint as you tighten the belt.  
2-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing a Child Restraint in the  
Right Front Seat Position  
WARNING: (Continued)  
The vehicle has airbags. A rear seat is a safer place to  
secure a forward-facing child restraint. See Where to  
Put the Restraint .  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
In addition, the vehicle may have a passenger sensing  
system which is designed to turn off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions.  
See Passenger Sensing System and Passenger Airbag  
Status Indicator for more information on this, including  
important safety information.  
The vehicle may have a passenger sensing  
system which is designed to turn off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions.  
Even if the passenger sensing system,  
if equipped, has turned off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag, no system is fail-safe.  
No one can guarantee that an airbag will not  
deploy under some unusual circumstance, even  
though it is turned off.  
A label on your sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
See Passenger Sensing System (Without Turbo  
Engine) on page 262 or Passenger Sensing  
System (With Turbo Engine) on page 267 for  
additional information.  
(Continued)  
2-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the child restraint has the LATCH system, see Lower  
Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) for how and  
where to install the child restraint using LATCH. If a  
child restraint is secured using a safety belt and it  
uses a top tether, see Lower Anchors and Tethers  
for Children (LATCH) for top tether anchor locations.  
4. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and  
shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt  
through or around the restraint. The child restraint  
instructions will show you how.  
Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top  
tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the  
top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come  
with the child restraint say that the top strap must be  
anchored.  
In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child  
restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
You will be using the lap-shoulder belt to secure the  
child restraint in this position. Follow the instructions  
that came with the child restraint.  
1. Move the seat as far back as it will go before  
securing the forward-facing child restraint.  
5. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
2. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
3. If the seat has a safety belt guide, remove the  
safety belt from the guide on the head restraint by  
sliding the webbing through the opening on the  
guide. Do not secure the child restraint with the  
safety belt routed through the guide.  
2-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt all the way out of  
the retractor to set the lock.  
7. To tighten the belt, push down on the child  
restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt and feed the  
shoulder belt back into the retractor. If you are  
using a forward-facing child restraint, you may find  
it helpful to use your knee to push down on the  
child restraint as you tighten the belt.  
8. Push and pull the child restraint in different  
directions to be sure it is secure.  
2-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle is equipped with a passenger sensing  
system, and the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag, the off  
indicator on the passenger airbag status indicator  
should light and stay lit when the vehicle is started.  
Airbag System  
The vehicle has the following airbags:  
.
A frontal airbag for the driver.  
.
A frontal airbag for the right front passenger  
If a child restraint has been installed and the on  
indicator is lit, see If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child  
Restraintunder Passenger Sensing System (Without  
Turbo Engine) on page 262 or Passenger Sensing  
System (With Turbo Engine) on page 267 for more  
information.  
Your vehicle may also have the following airbags:  
.
A roof-rail airbag for the driver and the passenger  
seated directly behind the driver.  
.
A roof-rail airbag for the right front passenger and  
the passenger seated directly behind the right front  
passenger.  
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle  
safety belt and let it return to the stowed position.  
All of the airbags in the vehicle will have the word  
AIRBAG embossed in the trim or on an attached label  
near the deployment opening.  
If the seat has a safety belt guide, insert the safety belt  
into the guide on the head restraint by sliding the  
webbing through the opening on the guide.  
For frontal airbags, the word AIRBAG will appear on the  
middle part of the steering wheel for the driver and on  
the instrument panel for the right front passenger.  
With roof-rail airbags, the word AIRBAG will appear  
along the headliner or trim.  
2-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airbags are designed to supplement the protection  
provided by safety belts. Even though today's airbags  
are also designed to help reduce the risk of injury from  
the force of an inflating bag, all airbags must inflate very  
quickly to do their job.  
WARNING:  
{
Airbags inflate with great force, faster than the  
blink of an eye. Anyone who is up against, or  
very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be  
seriously injured or killed. Do not sit unnecessarily  
close to the airbag, as you would be if you were  
sitting on the edge of your seat or leaning forward.  
Safety belts help keep you in position before and  
during a crash. Always wear your safety belt,  
even with airbags. The driver should sit as far  
back as possible while still maintaining control of  
the vehicle.  
Here are the most important things to know about the  
airbag system:  
WARNING:  
{
You can be severely injured or killed in a crash  
if you are not wearing your safety belt even if  
you have airbags. Airbags are designed to work  
with safety belts, but do not replace them. Also,  
airbags are not designed to deploy in every crash.  
In some crashes safety belts are your only  
Occupants should not lean on or sleep against the  
door or side windows in seating positions with  
roof-rail airbags.  
restraint. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? on  
page 258  
.
Wearing your safety belt during a crash helps  
reduce your chance of hitting things inside the  
vehicle or being ejected from it. Airbags are  
supplemental restraintsto the safety belts.  
Everyone in your vehicle should wear a safety  
belt properly whether or not there is an airbag  
for that person.  
2-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
There is an airbag  
readiness light on the  
instrument panel, which  
shows the airbag symbol.  
WARNING:  
{
Children who are up against, or very close to, any  
airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured  
or killed. Airbags plus lap-shoulder belts offer  
protection for adults and older children, but not for  
young children and infants. Neither the vehicle's  
safety belt system nor its airbag system is  
designed for them. Young children and infants  
need the protection that a child restraint system  
can provide. Always secure children properly in  
your vehicle. To read how, see Older Children on  
page 231 or Infants and Young Children on  
The system checks the airbag electrical system for  
malfunctions. The light tells you if there is an electrical  
problem. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 421 for  
more information.  
page 234  
.
2-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Where Are the Airbags?  
The right front passenger's airbag is in the instrument  
panel on the passenger's side.  
The driver's frontal airbag is in the middle of the  
steering wheel.  
2-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
If something is between an occupant and an  
airbag, the airbag might not inflate properly or it  
might force the object into that person causing  
severe injury or even death. The path of an  
inflating airbag must be kept clear. Do not put  
anything between an occupant and an airbag,  
and do not attach or put anything on the steering  
wheel hub or on or near any other airbag  
covering.  
Never secure anything to the roof of a vehicle with  
roof-rail airbags by routing a rope or tie down  
through any door or window opening. If you do,  
the path of an inflating roof-rail airbag will be  
blocked.  
Driver Side shown, Passenger Side similar  
If your vehicle has roof-rail airbags for the driver, right  
front passenger, and second row outboard passengers,  
they are in the ceiling above the side windows.  
2-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
If the vehicle hits a narrow object (like a pole), the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits a wide object (like a wall).  
When Should an Airbag Inflate?  
Frontal airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to  
severe frontal or near-frontal crashes to help reduce the  
potential for severe injuries mainly to the driver's or right  
front passenger's head and chest. However, they are  
only designed to inflate if the impact exceeds a  
predetermined deployment threshold. Deployment  
thresholds are used to predict how severe a crash is  
likely to be in time for the airbags to inflate and help  
restrain the occupants.  
If the vehicle goes into an object at an angle, the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle goes straight into the object.  
Thresholds can also vary with specific vehicle design.  
Frontal airbags are not intended to inflate during vehicle  
rollovers, rear impacts, or in many side impacts.  
In addition, your vehicle has dual-stage frontal airbags.  
Dual-stage airbags adjust the restraint according to  
crash severity. Your vehicle has an electronic frontal  
sensor, which helps the sensing system distinguish  
between a moderate frontal impact and a more severe  
frontal impact. For moderate frontal impacts, dual-stage  
airbags inflate at a level less than full deployment.  
For more severe frontal impacts, full deployment  
occurs.  
Whether your frontal airbags will or should deploy is not  
based on how fast your vehicle is traveling. It depends  
largely on what you hit, the direction of the impact, and  
how quickly your vehicle slows down.  
Frontal airbags may inflate at different crash speeds.  
For example:  
.
If the vehicle hits a stationary object, the airbags  
could inflate at a different crash speed than if the  
vehicle hits a moving object.  
Your vehicle may have roof-rail airbags. See Airbag  
System on page 253. Roof-rail airbags are intended  
to inflate in moderate to severe side crashes. Roof-rail  
airbags will inflate if the crash severity is above the  
system's designed threshold level. The threshold level  
can vary with specific vehicle design.  
.
If the vehicle hits an object that deforms, the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits an object that does not  
deform.  
2-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roof-rail airbags are not intended to inflate in frontal  
impacts, near-frontal impacts, rollovers, or rear impacts.  
A roof-rail airbag is intended to deploy on the side of the  
vehicle that is struck.  
How Does an Airbag Restrain?  
In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions,  
even belted occupants can contact the steering wheel  
or the instrument panel. In moderate to severe side  
collisions, even belted occupants can contact the inside  
of the vehicle.  
In any particular crash, no one can say whether an  
airbag should have inflated simply because of the  
damage to a vehicle or because of what the repair  
costs were. For frontal airbags, inflation is determined  
by what the vehicle hits, the angle of the impact, and  
how quickly the vehicle slows down. For roof-rail  
airbags, deployment is determined by the location  
and severity of the side impact.  
Airbags supplement the protection provided by safety  
belts. Frontal airbags distribute the force of the impact  
more evenly over the occupant's upper body, stopping  
the occupant more gradually. Roof-rail airbags distribute  
the force of the impact more evenly over the occupant's  
upper body.  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate?  
But airbags would not help in many types of collisions,  
primarily because the occupant's motion is not toward  
those airbags. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? on  
page 258 for more information.  
In a deployment event, the sensing system sends an  
electrical signal triggering a release of gas from the  
inflator. Gas from the inflator fills the airbag causing the  
bag to break out of the cover and deploy. The inflator,  
the airbag, and related hardware are all part of the  
airbag module.  
Airbags should never be regarded as anything more  
than a supplement to safety belts.  
Frontal airbag modules are located inside the steering  
wheel and instrument panel. For vehicles with roof-rail  
airbags, there are airbag modules in the ceiling of the  
vehicle, near the side windows that have occupant  
seating positions.  
2-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
What Will You See After an Airbag  
Inflates?  
WARNING:  
{
After the frontal airbags inflate, they quickly deflate,  
so quickly that some people may not even realize an  
airbag inflated. Roof-rail airbags may still be at least  
partially inflated for some time after they deploy.  
Some components of the airbag module may be hot  
for several minutes. For location of the airbag modules,  
see What Makes an Airbag Inflate? on page 259.  
When an airbag inflates, there may be dust in the  
air. This dust could cause breathing problems for  
people with a history of asthma or other breathing  
trouble. To avoid this, everyone in the vehicle  
should get out as soon as it is safe to do so.  
If you have breathing problems but cannot get out  
of the vehicle after an airbag inflates, then get  
fresh air by opening a window or a door. If you  
experience breathing problems following an airbag  
deployment, you should seek medical attention.  
The parts of the airbag that come into contact with you  
may be warm, but not too hot to touch. There may be  
some smoke and dust coming from the vents in the  
deflated airbags. Airbag inflation does not prevent the  
driver from seeing out of the windshield or being able  
to steer the vehicle, nor does it prevent people from  
leaving the vehicle.  
The vehicle has a feature that may automatically unlock  
the doors, turn on the interior lamps and hazard warning  
flashers, and shut off the fuel system after the airbags  
inflate. You can lock the doors, turn off the interior  
lamps and hazard warning flashers by using the  
controls for those features.  
2-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In many crashes severe enough to inflate the airbag,  
windshields are broken by vehicle deformation.  
Additional windshield breakage may also occur from  
the right front passenger airbag.  
WARNING:  
{
A crash severe enough to inflate the airbags may  
have also damaged important functions in the  
vehicle, such as the fuel system, brake and  
steering systems, etc. Even if the vehicle appears  
to be drivable after a moderate crash, there may  
be concealed damage that could make it difficult  
to safely operate the vehicle.  
.
Airbags are designed to inflate only once. After an  
airbag inflates, you will need some new parts for  
the airbag system. If you do not get them, the  
airbag system will not be there to help protect you  
in another crash. A new system will include airbag  
modules and possibly other parts. The service  
manual for the vehicle covers the need to replace  
other parts.  
Use caution if you should attempt to restart the  
engine after a crash has occurred.  
.
The vehicle has a crash sensing and diagnostic  
module which records information after a crash.  
See Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy on  
page 818 and Event Data Recorders on  
page 818  
.
.
Let only qualified technicians work on the airbag  
systems. Improper service can mean that an  
airbag system will not work properly. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
2-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the system check is complete, either the word  
ON or the word OFF, or the symbol for on or off, will  
be visible. See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on  
Passenger Sensing System  
(Without Turbo Engine)  
If the vehicle has one of the passenger airbag status  
indicators pictured in the following illustrations, then the  
vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the right  
front passenger position. If equipped, the passenger  
airbag status indicator is visible on the instrument  
panel when the vehicle is started.  
page 422  
.
The passenger sensing system will turn off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions.  
The driver airbag and roofrail airbags are not affected  
by the passenger sensing system.  
The passenger sensing system works with sensors  
that are part of the right front passenger seat. The  
sensors are designed to detect the presence of a  
properly-seated occupant and determine if the right  
front passenger frontal airbag should be enabled  
(may inflate) or not.  
In addition, if the vehicle has a passenger sensing  
system for the right front passenger position, the label  
on the vehicle's sun visors refer to ADVANCED  
AIRBAGS.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer when  
properly secured in a rear seat in the correct child  
restraint for their weight and size.  
We recommend that children be secured in a rear seat,  
including: an infant or a child riding in a rear-facing child  
restraint; a child riding in a forward-facing child seat; an  
older child riding in a booster seat; and children, who  
are large enough, using safety belts.  
United States  
Canada  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
The words ON and OFF, or the symbol for on and off,  
will be visible during the system check. If you are using  
remote start to start the vehicle from a distance,  
if equipped, you may not see the system check.  
2-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off  
the right front passenger frontal airbag if:  
WARNING:  
{
.
The right front passenger seat is unoccupied.  
.
The system determines that an infant is present in  
a child restraint.  
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
.
A right front passenger takes his/her weight off of  
the seat for a period of time.  
.
Or, if there is a critical problem with the airbag  
system or the passenger sensing system.  
When the passenger sensing system has turned off the  
right front passenger frontal airbag, the off indicator will  
light and stay lit to remind you that the airbag is off.  
See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 422.  
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that  
an airbag will not deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though the airbag is  
turned off.  
The passenger sensing system is designed turn on  
(may inflate) the right front passenger frontal airbag  
anytime the system senses that a person of adult size is  
sitting properly in the right front passenger seat. When  
the passenger sensing system has allowed the airbag  
to be enabled, the on indicator will light and stay lit to  
remind you that the airbag is active.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
2-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For some children, including children in child restraints,  
and for very small adults, the passenger sensing  
system may or may not turn off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag, depending upon the person's seating  
posture and body build. Everyone in the vehicle who  
has outgrown child restraints should wear a safety belt  
properly whether or not there is an airbag for that  
person.  
3. Remove any additional items from the seat such as  
blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat heaters,  
or seat massagers.  
4. Reinstall the child restraint following the directions  
provided by the child restraint manufacturer and  
refer to Securing a Child Restraint in the Right  
Front Seat Position on page 250.  
5. If, after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting  
the vehicle, the on indicator is still lit, turn the  
vehicle off. Then slightly recline the vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
seatback and adjust the seat cushion, if adjustable,  
to make sure that the vehicle seatback is not  
pushing the child restraint into the seat cushion.  
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and  
stays on, it means that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to  
yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 421  
for more information, including important safety  
information.  
Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped  
under the vehicle head restraint. If this happens,  
adjust the head restraint. See Head Restraints on  
page 27  
.
6. Restart the vehicle.  
The passenger sensing system may or may not  
turn off the airbag for a child in a child restraint  
depending upon the child's seating posture and  
body build. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child  
Restraint  
If a child restraint has been installed and the on  
indicator is lit:  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
2. Remove the child restraint from the vehicle.  
2-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If this happens, use the following steps to allow the  
system to detect that person and enable the right front  
passenger frontal airbag:  
If the Off Indicator is Lit for an  
Adult-Size Occupant  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
2. Remove any additional material from the seat,  
such as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat  
heaters, or seat massagers.  
3. Place the seatback in the fully upright position.  
4. Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered  
on the seat cushion, with legs comfortably  
extended.  
5. Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in  
this position for two to three minutes after the on  
indicator is lit.  
If a person of adult-size is sitting in the right front  
passenger seat, but the off indicator is lit, it could be  
because that person is not sitting properly in the seat.  
2-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A wet seat can affect the performance of the passenger  
sensing system. Here is how:  
Additional Factors Affecting System  
Operation  
Safety belts help keep the passenger in position on the  
seat during vehicle maneuvers and braking, which helps  
the passenger sensing system maintain the passenger  
airbag status. See Safety Beltsand Child Restraints”  
in the Index for additional information about the  
importance of proper restraint use.  
.
The passenger sensing system may turn off the  
passenger airbag when liquid is soaked into the  
seat. If this happens, the off indicator will be lit,  
and the airbag readiness light on the instrument  
panel will also be lit.  
.
Liquid pooled on the seat that has not soaked  
in may make it more likely that the passenger  
sensing system will enable (turn on) the passenger  
airbag while a child restraint or child occupant is on  
the seat. If the passenger airbag is turned on, the  
on indicator will be lit.  
A thick layer of additional material, such as a blanket  
or cushion, or aftermarket equipment such as seat  
covers, seat heaters, and seat massagers can affect  
how well the passenger sensing system operates.  
We recommend that you not use seat covers or other  
aftermarket equipment except when approved by GM  
for your specific vehicle. See Adding Equipment to  
Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 273 for more  
information about modifications that can affect how the  
system operates.  
If the passenger seat gets wet, dry the seat  
immediately. If the airbag readiness light is lit, do  
not install a child restraint or allow anyone to occupy  
the seat. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 421  
for important safety information.  
2-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The on indicator may be lit if an object, such as a  
briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop or other  
electronic device, is put on an unoccupied seat.  
If this is not desired, remove the object from the seat.  
In addition, if the vehicle has a passenger sensing  
system for the right front passenger position, the label  
on the vehicle's sun visors refer to ADVANCED  
AIRBAGS.  
WARNING:  
{
Stowing of articles under the passenger seat  
or between the passenger seat cushion and  
seatback may interfere with the proper operation  
of the passenger sensing system.  
United States  
Canada  
Passenger Sensing System  
(With Turbo Engine)  
If the vehicle has one of the passenger airbag status  
indicators pictured in the following illustrations, then the  
vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the right  
front passenger position. If equipped, the passenger  
airbag status indicator is visible on the instrument panel  
when the vehicle is started.  
The words ON and OFF, or the symbol for on and off,  
will be visible during the system check. If you are  
using remote start to start the vehicle from a distance,  
if equipped, you may not see the system check. When  
the system check is complete, either the word ON or  
the word OFF, or the symbol for on or off, will be visible.  
See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 422.  
The passenger sensing system will turn off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions.  
The driver airbag and roofrail airbags are not affected  
by the passenger sensing system.  
2-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The passenger sensing system works with sensors  
that are part of the right front passenger seat. The  
sensors are designed to detect the presence of a  
properly-seated occupant and determine if the right  
front passenger frontal airbag should be enabled  
(may inflate) or not.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer when  
properly secured in a rear seat in the correct child  
restraint for their weight and size.  
We recommend that children be secured in a rear seat,  
including: an infant or a child riding in a rear-facing child  
restraint; a child riding in a forward-facing child seat; an  
older child riding in a booster seat; and children, who  
are large enough, using safety belts.  
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that  
an airbag will not deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though the airbag is  
turned off.  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
2-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off  
the right front passenger frontal airbag if:  
When the passenger sensing system has allowed the  
airbag to be enabled, the on indicator will light and stay  
lit to remind you that the airbag is active.  
.
The right front passenger seat is unoccupied.  
For some children who have outgrown child restraints  
and for very small adults, the passenger sensing  
system may or may not turn off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag, depending upon the person's seating  
posture and body build. Everyone in the vehicle who  
has outgrown child restraints should wear a safety belt  
properly whether or not there is an airbag for that  
person.  
.
The system determines that an infant is present in  
a rear-facing infant seat.  
.
The system determines that a small child is  
present in a child restraint.  
.
The system determines that a small child is  
present in a booster seat.  
.
A right front passenger takes his/her weight off of  
the seat for a period of time.  
.
The right front passenger seat is occupied by a  
smaller person, such as a child who has outgrown  
WARNING:  
{
child restraints.  
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and  
stays on, it means that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to  
yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 421  
for more information, including important safety  
information.  
.
Or, if there is a critical problem with the airbag  
system or the passenger sensing system.  
When the passenger sensing system has turned off the  
right front passenger frontal airbag, the off indicator will  
light and stay lit to remind you that the airbag is off.  
See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 422.  
The passenger sensing system is designed to turn on  
(may inflate) the right front passenger frontal airbag  
anytime the system senses that a person of adult size  
is sitting properly in the right front passenger's seat.  
2-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. If, after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting  
the vehicle, the on indicator is still lit, turn the  
vehicle off. Then slightly recline the vehicle  
If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child  
Restraint  
seatback and adjust the seat cushion, if adjustable,  
to make sure that the vehicle seatback is not  
pushing the child restraint into the seat cushion.  
If a child restraint has been installed and the on  
indicator is lit:  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped  
under the vehicle head restraint. If this happens,  
adjust the head restraint. See Head Restraints on  
2. Remove the child restraint from the vehicle.  
3. Remove any additional items from the seat such as  
blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat heaters,  
or seat massagers.  
page 27  
.
6. Restart the vehicle.  
4. Reinstall the child restraint following the directions  
provided by the child restraint manufacturer and  
refer to Securing a Child Restraint in the Right  
Front Seat Position on page 250.  
If the on indicator is still lit, secure the child  
restraint in a rear seat position in the vehicle,  
and check with your dealer/retailer.  
2-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If this happens, use the following steps to allow the  
system to detect that person and enable the right front  
passenger frontal airbag:  
If the Off Indicator is Lit for an  
Adult-Size Occupant  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
2. Remove any additional material from the seat,  
such as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat  
heaters, or seat massagers.  
3. Place the seatback in the fully upright position.  
4. Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered  
on the seat cushion, with legs comfortably  
extended.  
5. Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in  
this position for two to three minutes after the on  
indicator is lit.  
If a person of adult-size is sitting in the right front  
passenger seat, but the off indicator is lit, it could be  
because that person is not sitting properly in the seat.  
2-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional Factors Affecting System  
Operation  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle  
Safety belts help keep the passenger in position on the  
seat during vehicle maneuvers and braking, which helps  
the passenger sensing system maintain the passenger  
airbag status. See Safety Beltsand Child Restraints”  
in the Index for additional information about the  
importance of proper restraint use.  
Airbags affect how the vehicle should be serviced.  
There are parts of the airbag system in several places  
around the vehicle. Your dealer/retailer and the service  
manual have information about servicing the vehicle  
and the airbag system. To purchase a service manual,  
see Service Publications Ordering Information on  
page 816  
.
A thick layer of additional material, such as a blanket  
or cushion, or aftermarket equipment such as seat  
covers, seat heaters, and seat massagers can affect  
how well the passenger sensing system operates.  
We recommend that you not use seat covers or other  
aftermarket equipment except when approved by GM  
for your specific vehicle. See Adding Equipment to Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 273 for more  
information about modifications that can affect how  
the system operates.  
WARNING:  
{
For up to 10 seconds after the ignition is turned off  
and the battery is disconnected, an airbag can still  
inflate during improper service. You can be injured  
if you are close to an airbag when it inflates. Avoid  
yellow connectors. They are probably part of the  
airbag system. Be sure to follow proper service  
procedures, and make sure the person performing  
work for you is qualified to do so.  
WARNING:  
{
Stowing of articles under the passenger seat  
or between the passenger seat cushion and  
seatback may interfere with the proper operation  
of the passenger sensing system.  
2-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
sensing system. This could either prevent proper  
deployment of the passenger airbag(s) or prevent  
the passenger sensing system from properly turning  
off the passenger airbag(s). See Passenger Sensing  
System (Without Turbo Engine) on page 262 or  
Passenger Sensing System (With Turbo Engine) on  
Adding Equipment to Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle  
Q: Is there anything I might add to or change about  
the vehicle that could keep the airbags from  
working properly?  
page 267  
.
If you have any questions, call Customer  
A: Yes. If you add things that change the vehicle's  
frame, bumper system, height, front end or side  
sheet metal, they may keep the airbag system from  
working properly. Changing or moving any parts of  
the front seats, safety belts, the airbag sensing and  
diagnostic module, steering wheel, instrument panel,  
roof-rail airbag modules, ceiling headliner or pillar  
garnish trim, front sensors, or airbag wiring can  
affect the operation of the airbag system.  
Assistance. The phone numbers and addresses  
for Customer Assistance are in Step Two of the  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure in this manual.  
See Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 82.  
Q: Because I have a disability, I have to get my  
vehicle modified. How can I find out whether this  
will affect my airbag system?  
In addition, the vehicle may have a passenger  
sensing system for the right front passenger  
A: If you have questions, call Customer Assistance.  
The phone numbers and addresses for Customer  
Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer  
Satisfaction Procedure in this manual. See  
position, which includes sensors that are part of the  
passenger's seat. The passenger sensing system  
may not operate properly if the original seat trim is  
replaced with non-GM covers, upholstery or trim,  
or with GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a  
different vehicle. Any object, such as an aftermarket  
seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device,  
installed under or on top of the seat fabric, could  
also interfere with the operation of the passenger  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 82.  
In addition, your dealer/retailer and the service manual  
have information about the location of the airbag  
sensors, sensing and diagnostic module and airbag  
wiring.  
2-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airbags  
Restraint System Check  
The airbag system does not need regularly scheduled  
maintenance or replacement. Make sure the airbag  
readiness light is working. See Airbag Readiness Light  
on page 421 for more information.  
Checking the Restraint Systems  
Safety Belts  
Notice: If an airbag covering is damaged, opened,  
or broken, the airbag may not work properly. Do not  
open or break the airbag coverings. If there are any  
opened or broken airbag covers, have the airbag  
covering and/or airbag module replaced. For the  
location of the airbag modules, see What Makes an  
Airbag Inflate? on page 259. See your dealer/  
retailer for service.  
Now and then, check that the safety belt reminder  
light, safety belts, buckles, latch plates, retractors,  
and anchorages are all working properly.  
Look for any other loose or damaged safety belt system  
parts that might keep a safety belt system from doing its  
job. See your dealer/retailer to have it repaired. Torn or  
frayed safety belts may not protect you in a crash. They  
can rip apart under impact forces. If a belt is torn or  
frayed, get a new one right away.  
Make sure the safety belt reminder light is working.  
See Safety Belt Reminders on page 420 for more  
information.  
Keep safety belts clean and dry. See Care of Safety  
Belts on page 6118  
.
2-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has the LATCH system and it was being  
used during a crash, you may need new LATCH system  
parts.  
Replacing Restraint System Parts  
After a Crash  
New parts and repairs may be necessary even if the  
safety belt or LATCH system (if equipped), was not  
being used at the time of the crash.  
WARNING:  
{
If an airbag inflates, you will need to replace airbag  
system parts. See the part on the airbag system earlier  
in this section.  
A crash can damage the restraint systems in your  
vehicle. A damaged restraint system may not  
properly protect the person using it, resulting in  
serious injury or even death in a crash. To help  
make sure your restraint systems are working  
properly after a crash, have them inspected and  
any necessary replacements made as soon as  
possible.  
Have the safety belt pretensioners checked if the  
vehicle has been in a crash, if the airbag readiness light  
stays on after the vehicle is started, or while you are  
driving. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 421  
.
If the vehicle has been in a crash, do you need new  
safety belts or LATCH system (if equipped) parts?  
After a very minor crash, nothing may be necessary.  
But the safety belt assemblies that were used during  
any crash may have been stressed or damaged. See  
your dealer/retailer to have the safety belt assemblies  
inspected or replaced.  
2-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
2-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3 Features and Controls  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8  
Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Automatic Door Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Programmable Automatic Door Unlock . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Rear Door Security Locks (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Engine Coolant Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Automatic Transmission Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26  
Manual Transmission Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
Shifting Into Park (Automatic Transmission) . . . 3-32  
Shifting Out of Park (Automatic  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Manual Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
Transmission) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Parking the Vehicle (Manual Transmission) . . . . 3-34  
Parking Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3 Features and Controls  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Center Console Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Driver Storage Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Manual Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Outside Manual Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Outside Remote Control Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Outside Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Outside Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40  
3-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with the ignition key  
is dangerous for many reasons, children or others  
could be badly injured or even killed. They could  
operate the power windows or other controls or  
even make the vehicle move. The windows will  
function with the keys in the ignition and children  
could be seriously injured or killed if caught in the  
path of a closing window. Do not leave the keys in  
a vehicle with children.  
The key can be used for the ignition and all locks.  
The key has a bar-coded key tag that the dealer/retailer  
or qualified locksmith can use to make new keys. Store  
this information in a safe place, not in your vehicle.  
Notice: If you ever lock your keys in the vehicle,  
you may have to damage the vehicle to get in.  
Be sure you have spare keys.  
If you are locked out of your vehicle, contact Roadside  
Assistance. See Roadside Assistance Program on  
page 87  
.
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation  
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter functions  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 820  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
work up to 195 feet (60 m) away from the vehicle.  
There are other conditions which can affect the  
performance of the transmitter. See Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System on page 34.  
Changes or modifications to this system by other than  
an authorized service facility could void authorization to  
use this equipment.  
If there is a decrease in the RKE operating range,  
try this:  
.
Check the distance. The transmitter may be too  
far from the vehicle. Stand closer during rainy or  
snowy weather.  
.
Check the location. Other vehicles or objects may  
be blocking the signal. Take a few steps to the left  
or right, hold the transmitter higher, and try again.  
.
Check the transmitter's battery. See Battery  
Replacementlater in this section.  
.
If the transmitter is still not working correctly, see  
your dealer/retailer or a qualified technician for  
With Remote Start Shown,  
service.  
Without Remote Start  
Similar  
/ (Remote Vehicle Start): For vehicles with this  
feature, press to start the engine from outside the  
vehicle. See Remote Vehicle Start on page 36.  
3-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q (Lock): Press to lock all the doors. The interior  
lamps turn off after all of the doors are closed.  
V (Remote Trunk Release): Press and hold for  
approximately one second to open the trunk. The trunk  
will open using the transmitter when the vehicle speed  
is less than 2 mph (3 km/h) if the vehicle has a manual  
transmission, when the ignition is off, or when the  
vehicle shift lever is in P (Park) if the vehicle has an  
automatic transmission.  
If enabled through the Driver Information Center (DIC),  
the remote lock feedback can be programmed to have  
the horn chirp and/or the turn signals flash to confirm  
locking. See LOCK HORNand LIGHT FLASHunder  
DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 446.  
Pressing Q may also arm the content theft-deterrent  
system. See Content Theft-Deterrent on page 316.  
L (Vehicle Locator/Panic Alarm): Press to locate  
the vehicle. The horn sounds three times and the  
headlamps and turn signals flash three times.  
K (Unlock): Press to unlock the driver door. If K is  
pressed again within five seconds, all remaining doors  
unlock. The interior lamps turn on and stay on for  
20 seconds or until the ignition is turned on. If enabled  
through the DIC, the remote unlock feedback can be  
programmed to have the horn chirp and/or the turn  
signals flash to confirm unlocking. See UNLOCK  
HORNand LIGHT FLASHunder DIC Vehicle  
Personalization on page 446.  
Press and hold L for more that two seconds to sound  
the panic alarm. The horn sounds and the headlamps  
and turn signals flash for 30 seconds. Press L again to  
cancel the panic alarm.  
Programming Transmitters to the  
Vehicle  
Only RKE transmitters programmed to the vehicle will  
work. If a transmitter is lost or stolen, a replacement  
can be purchased and programmed through your  
dealer/retailer. When the replacement transmitter is  
programmed to the vehicle, all remaining transmitters  
must also be programmed. Any lost or stolen  
transmitters no longer work once the new transmitter  
is programmed. Each vehicle can have up to four  
transmitters programmed to it.  
The highbeam headlamps and parking lamps may turn  
on when K is pressed. See EXT (Exterior) LIGHTS”  
under DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 446.  
Pressing K on the RKE transmitter disarms the content  
theftdeterrent system. See Content Theft-Deterrent on  
page 316  
.
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Insert the new battery, positive side facing up.  
Replace with a CR2032 or equivalent battery.  
Battery Replacement  
Replace the battery if the KEY FOB BATT LOW  
message displays in the DIC. See KEY FOB BATT  
LOWunder DIC Warnings and Messages on  
4. Snap the transmitter back together.  
Remote Vehicle Start  
page 440  
.
Your vehicle may have a remote start feature.  
This feature allows you to start the engine from  
outside the vehicle. It may also start the vehicle's  
heating or air conditioning systems. When you start  
your vehicle using the remote start feature, the climate  
control system will come on and adjust the interior to  
the temperature settings that you left it set to when  
you turned the vehicle off.  
Notice: When replacing the battery, do not touch  
any of the circuitry on the transmitter. Static from  
your body could damage the transmitter.  
Laws in some communities may restrict the use of  
remote starters. For example, some laws may require  
a person using remote start to have the vehicle in  
view when doing so. Check local regulations for any  
requirements on remote starting of vehicles.  
Do not use the remote start feature if your vehicle is low  
on fuel. Your vehicle may run out of fuel.  
The remote start feature provides two separate starts  
per ignition cycle, each with 10 minutes of engine  
running time.  
To replace the battery:  
1. Separate the transmitter with a flat, thin object  
inserted into the notch on the side.  
2. Remove the old battery. Do not use a metal object.  
3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
After your vehicle's engine has been started two times  
using the remote vehicle start button, the vehicle's  
ignition switch must be turned to ON/RUN and then  
back to LOCK/OFF using the key before the remote  
start procedure can be used again. See Ignition  
Positions on page 321 for information regarding  
the ignition positions on your vehicle.  
3. If it is the first remote start since the vehicle has  
been driven, repeat these steps, while the engine  
is running, to extend the time by 10 minutes for the  
engine to continue to run.  
After entering the vehicle after a remote start, insert and  
turn the key to ON/RUN to drive the vehicle.  
The engine will shut off automatically after 10 minutes,  
unless a time extension has been done or the vehicle's  
key is inserted into the ignition switch and turned to  
ON/RUN.  
If your vehicle has the remote start feature, the RKE  
transmitter functions will have an increased range of  
operation. However, the range may be less while the  
vehicle is running.  
To manually shut off a remote start, do any of the  
following. The parking lamps will turn off to indicate the  
engine is off.  
There are other conditions which can affect the  
performance of the transmitter, see Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System on page 34 for additional  
information.  
.
Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle and press  
and release the remote start button.  
/ (Remote Start): This button will be on the RKE  
transmitter if you have remote start.  
.
Turn on the hazard warning flashers.  
.
Turn the ignition switch to ON/RUN and then  
To start the vehicle using the remote start feature, do  
the following:  
LOCK/OFF.  
Your vehicle's engine can be started two times, per  
ignition cycle, using the transmitter's remote start  
feature.  
1. Aim the transmitter at the vehicle.  
2. Press and release Q , then immediately press and  
hold / until the vehicle's turn signal lamps flash.  
If the remote start procedure is used again before  
the first 10 minute time frame has ended, the first  
10 minutes will immediately expire and the second  
10 minute time frame will start.  
When the vehicle starts, the parking lamps will  
turn on and remain on while the engine is running.  
The vehicle's doors will be locked.  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The remote vehicle start feature will not operate if any  
of the follow occur:  
Doors and Locks  
.
The remote start system is disabled through  
Door Locks  
the DIC.  
.
The vehicle's key is in the ignition.  
WARNING:  
.
{
The vehicle's hood is open.  
.
The hazard warning flashers are on.  
Unlocked doors can be dangerous.  
.
The check engine light is on. See Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp on page 427.  
.
Passengers, especially children, can easily  
open the doors and fall out of a moving  
vehicle. When a door is locked, the handle will  
not open it. The chance of being thrown out of  
the vehicle in a crash is increased if the doors  
are not locked. So, all passengers should  
wear safety belts properly and the doors  
should be locked whenever the vehicle  
is driven.  
.
The engine coolant temperature is too high.  
.
The oil pressure is low.  
.
Two remote vehicle starts have already been  
provided for that ignition cycle.  
Vehicles that have the remote vehicle start feature are  
shipped from the factory with the remote start system  
enabled. The system may be enabled or disabled  
through the DIC. See REMOTE STARTunder DIC  
Vehicle Personalization on page 446 for additional  
information.  
.
Young children who get into unlocked vehicles  
may be unable to get out. A child can be  
overcome by extreme heat and can suffer  
permanent injuries or even death from heat  
stroke. Always lock the vehicle whenever  
leaving it.  
(Continued)  
3-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Door Locks  
WARNING: (Continued)  
This vehicle may have  
power door locks.  
The controls are located  
on the driver and front  
passenger door armrest.  
.
Outsiders can easily enter through an  
unlocked door when you slow down or stop  
your vehicle. Locking your doors can help  
prevent this from happening.  
There are several ways to lock and unlock your vehicle.  
To lock the driver's door from the outside, turn  
the key clockwise. To unlock the door, turn the key  
counterclockwise.  
Driver Switch shown  
You can also use the remote keyless entry transmitter,  
if equipped, to lock and unlock the doors.  
Press K to unlock the doors.  
Press Q to lock the doors.  
From the inside, use the manual lock knobs on each  
door or the power door lock switch to lock and unlock  
all doors.  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Delayed Locking  
Automatic Door Lock  
If your vehicle has power locks, it will have the  
delayed locking feature.  
On vehicles with power door locks, the doors  
automatically lock when the shift lever is moved out  
of (P) Park for a vehicle with an automatic transmission.  
For a vehicle with a manual transmission, the speed  
must be greater than 5 mph (8 km/h).  
This feature will delay the actual locking of the doors  
for up to five seconds when the power door lock switch  
or remote keyless entry transmitter is used to lock  
the vehicle.  
The automatic door locking feature cannot be disabled.  
If any door is open when locking the vehicle, three  
chimes will sound signaling that the delayed locking  
feature is active. Five seconds after the last door is  
closed, all of the doors will lock and the turn signal  
lamps will flash. To cancel the delay and lock the doors  
immediately, press the lock button a second time.  
Programmable Automatic Door  
Unlock  
If your vehicle has power locks, it has a programmable  
automatic door unlock feature.  
The doors can be programmed through the Driver  
Information Center (DIC) to automatically unlock several  
ways. See DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 446  
for more information.  
This feature will not lock the doors if the key is in  
the ignition.  
You can disable this function through the Driver  
Information Center (DIC). See DIC Vehicle  
Personalization on page 446.  
3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When you want to open a rear door when the security  
lock is on, do the following:  
Rear Door Security Locks (Sedan)  
Your vehicle has rear door security locks. These  
prevent passengers from opening the rear doors from  
the inside.  
1. Unlock the door using the remote keyless entry  
transmitter, if the vehicle has one, the power door  
lock switch, or by lifting the rear door manual lock.  
The rear door security  
locks are located on the  
inside edge of each rear  
door. You must open the  
rear doors to access  
them. The label showing  
lock and unlock positions  
is located near the lock.  
2. Open the door from the outside.  
To cancel the rear door security lock, do the following:  
1. Unlock the door and open it from the outside.  
2. Insert the key into the security lock slot and turn it  
so the slot is in the vertical position.  
Lockout Protection  
If your vehicle has power door locks, it will have this  
feature. If you press the power door lock switch when  
the key is in the ignition and any door is open, all  
the doors will lock and the driver's door will unlock.  
Be sure to remove the key from the ignition when  
locking your vehicle.  
Security Lock Label shown  
To set the locks, do the following:  
The lockout protection can be overridden by pressing  
and holding the power door lock in the lock position for  
three seconds.  
1. Insert the key into the security lock slot and turn it  
so the slot is in the horizontal position.  
2. Close the door.  
3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trunk  
WARNING: (Continued)  
To release the trunk lid from the outside, use the key or  
the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter,  
if equipped.  
If the vehicle must be driven with the liftgate,  
or trunk/hatch open:  
.
Close all of the windows.  
WARNING:  
{
.
Fully open the air outlets on or under the  
instrument panel.  
Exhaust gases can enter the vehicle if it is driven  
with the liftgate, trunk/hatch open, or with any  
objects that pass through the seal between the  
body and the trunk/hatch or liftgate. Engine  
exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO) which  
cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
.
Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting  
that brings in only outside air and set the fan  
speed to the highest setting. See Climate  
Control System in the Index.  
.
If the vehicle is equipped with a power liftgate,  
disable the power liftgate function.  
(Continued)  
For more information about carbon monoxide, see  
Engine Exhaust on page 335.  
3-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Trunk Release  
Emergency Trunk Release Handle  
To open the trunk from  
inside the vehicle, press  
the remote trunk release  
button. It is located inside  
the driver storage  
compartment on the  
lower left side of the  
instrument panel.  
On a manual transmission equipped vehicle, the  
remote trunk release works when the ignition is either  
off or in ACC/ACCESSORY, or the vehicle speed is  
less than 2 mph (3 km/h).  
Notice: Do not use the emergency trunk release  
handle as a tie-down or anchor point when securing  
items in the trunk as it could damage the handle.  
The emergency trunk release handle is only  
On an automatic transmission equipped vehicle,  
the remote trunk release works when the shifter is  
in P (Park).  
intended to aid a person trapped in a latched trunk,  
enabling them to open the trunk from the inside.  
There is a glow-in-the-dark emergency trunk release  
handle located on the inside of the trunk lid of the  
vehicle. This handle will glow following exposure to  
light. Pull the release handle and push the trunk lid  
open from the inside to open the trunk.  
3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children, helpless adults, or pets in a  
vehicle with the windows closed is dangerous.  
They can be overcome by the extreme heat and  
suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat  
stroke. Never leave a child, a helpless adult, or a  
pet alone in a vehicle, especially with the windows  
closed in warm or hot weather.  
3-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If your vehicle has power  
windows, the switches on  
the driver's door armrest  
control each of the  
Manual Windows  
If your vehicle has manual windows, use the window  
crank to open and close each window.  
windows.  
Power Windows  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with the keys is  
dangerous for many reasons, children or others  
could be badly injured or even killed. They could  
operate the power windows or other controls or  
even make the vehicle move. The windows will  
function and they could be seriously injured or  
killed if caught in the path of a closing window.  
Do not leave keys in a vehicle with children.  
Sedan Shown, Coupe  
Similar  
In addition, each passenger's door has a window switch  
that controls that door's window. Press the front of the  
switch to open the window. Pull the front of the switch  
up to close it.  
Express-Down Window  
When there are children in the rear seat use the  
window lockout button to prevent unintentional  
operation of the windows.  
The driver's window switch has an express-down  
feature which allows the window to be lowered fully  
without continuously pressing the switch. This switch is  
labeled AUTO. Press the front of the switch to the first  
position, and the driver's window will open a small  
amount. Press the switch down fully and release.  
The window goes all the way down.  
To stop the window while it is lowering, pull the front of  
the switch up.  
3-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Window Lockout (Sedan)  
Theft-Deterrent Systems  
o (Window Lockout): The driver's window controls  
also include a lockout switch. Press the right side of  
the switch to prevent the rear passengers from using  
their window switches. The driver can still control all the  
windows with the lockout on. Press the switch to the left  
to return to normal window operation. A red bar on the  
right side of the switch indicates that the lockout feature  
is off.  
Vehicle theft is big business, especially in some cities.  
This vehicle has theft-deterrent features, however, they  
do not make it impossible to steal.  
Content Theft-Deterrent  
Your vehicle may have a  
content theft-deterrent  
alarm system.  
Sun Visors  
To block out glare, swing down the visor(s). The visors  
can also be detached from the center mount and swung  
to the side to cover the windows.  
Visor Vanity Mirror  
Arming the System  
With the ignition off, you can arm the system by  
pressing the remote keyless entry transmitter  
lock button.  
Your vehicle may have a driver's side vanity mirror.  
Swing down the sun visor and lift the cover to  
expose the mirror.  
The system will arm after either of these things occur:  
.
Thirty seconds after all the doors are closed.  
.
Sixty seconds with any door open.  
3-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you press the lock button on the transmitter a second  
time while all the doors are closed, the system will arm  
immediately. The system will still arm in 60 seconds if a  
door is open. When the open door is closed, it will also  
become armed.  
If the system is armed and the trunk is opened using  
the trunk release button on the transmitter, the system  
will temporarily disarm itself and rearm when the trunk  
has been closed. This allows you to exit the vehicle,  
lock the doors using the transmitter, and open the  
trunk using the transmitter without having to disarm  
and rearm the system.  
The security light, located on the instrument panel  
cluster, will turn on to indicate that arming has been  
initiated. Once the system is armed, the security light  
will flash once every three seconds.  
Once the system is disarmed, the security light will  
stop flashing.  
If the security light is flashing twice per second, this  
means that a door is open.  
How the System Alarm is Activated  
If the system is armed, it can be activated by either:  
If you do not want to arm the system, you may lock the  
car with the manual lock knobs, or the power door lock  
switch, if equipped, on the doors.  
.
Opening the driver's door or trunk. This will  
cause a ten second pre-alarm chirp followed by  
a thirty second full alarm of horn and lights.  
Disarming the System  
.
Opening any other door. This will immediately  
cause a full alarm of horn and lights for  
thirty seconds.  
You can disarm the system by doing any one of  
the following:  
.
When an alarm event has finished, the system will  
re-arm itself automatically.  
Press the remote keyless entry transmitter  
unlock button.  
.
Turn the ignition on.  
3-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Immobilizer Operation  
How to Turn Off the System Alarm  
To turn off the system alarm, do one of the following:  
Your vehicle has PASS-Key® III+ (Personalized  
Automotive Security System) theft-deterrent system.  
PASS-Key® III+ is a passive theft-deterrent system.  
.
Press the lock button on the remote keyless entry  
transmitter. The system will then re-arm itself.  
.
Press the unlock button on the remote keyless  
entry transmitter. This will also disarm the system.  
The system is automatically armed when the key is  
removed from the ignition.  
.
Insert the key in the ignition and turn it on.  
This will also disarm the system.  
You do not have to manually arm or disarm the system.  
The security light will come on if there is a problem with  
arming or disarming the theft-deterrent system.  
How to Detect a Tamper Condition  
If you hear three chirps when you press the unlock,  
lock, or trunk release buttons on the remote keyless  
transmitter, it means that the content theft security  
system alarm was previously activated.  
When the PASS-Key® III+ system senses that someone  
is using the wrong key, it prevents the vehicle from  
starting. Anyone using a trial-and-error method to start  
the vehicle will be discouraged because of the high  
number of electrical key codes.  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Immobilizer  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 820  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
When trying to start the vehicle if the engine does not  
start and the security light comes on, there may be a  
problem with your theft-deterrent system. Turn the  
ignition off and try again.  
3-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the engine still does not start, and the key appears to  
be undamaged, try another ignition key. At this time,  
you may also want to check the fuse, see Fuses and  
Circuit Breakers on page 6125. If the engine still  
does not start with the other key, your vehicle needs  
service. If your vehicle does start, the first key may  
be faulty. See your dealer/retailer who can service  
the PASS-Key® III+ to have a new key made. In an  
emergency, contact Roadside Assistance. See  
Roadside Assistance Program on page 87, for  
more information.  
It may be possible for the PASS-Key® III+ decoder to  
learnthe transponder value of a new or replacement  
key. Up to 10 keys may be programmed for the vehicle.  
The following procedure is for programming additional  
keys only. If all the currently programmed keys are lost  
or do not operate, you must see your dealer/retailer or a  
locksmith who can service PASS-Key® III+ to have keys  
made and programmed to the system.  
To program the new key:  
1. Verify that the new key has a 1 stamped on it.  
2. Insert the already programmed key in the ignition  
and start the engine. If the engine will not start,  
see your dealer/retailer for service.  
3. After the engine has started, turn the key to  
LOCK/OFF, and remove the key.  
4. Insert the key to be programmed and turn it to the  
ON/RUN position within five seconds of the original  
key being turned to the LOCK/OFF position.  
The security light will turn off once the key has  
been programmed.  
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 if additional keys are to  
be programmed.  
If you are ever driving and the security light comes on  
and stays on, you may be able to restart your engine if  
you turn it off. Your PASS-Key® III+ system, however,  
is not working properly and must be serviced by your  
dealer/retailer. Your vehicle is not protected by the  
PASS-Key® III+ system at this time.  
See your dealer/retailer or a locksmith who can service  
PASS-Key® III+ to get a new key blank that is cut  
exactly as the ignition key that operates the system.  
If you lose or damage your PASS-Key® III+ key, see  
your dealer/retailer or a locksmith who can service  
PASS-Key® III+ to have a new key made.  
Do not leave the key or device that disarms or  
deactivates the theft deterrent system in the vehicle.  
3-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Avoid making hard stops for the first  
200 miles (322 km) or so. During this time  
the new brake linings are not yet broken in.  
Hard stops with new linings can mean  
premature wear and earlier replacement.  
Follow this breaking-in guideline every time  
you get new brake linings.  
Starting and Operating Your  
Vehicle  
New Vehicle Break-In  
Notice: The vehicle does not need an elaborate  
break-in. But it will perform better in the long run if  
you follow these guidelines:  
.
Do not tow a trailer during break-in. See  
Towing a Trailer (Automatic Transmission)  
on page 533 or Towing a Trailer (Manual  
Transmission) on page 539 for the trailer  
towing capabilities of your vehicle and more  
information.  
.
Do not drive at any one constant speed,  
fast or slow, for the first 500 miles (805 km).  
Do not make full-throttle starts. Do not  
exceed 5,000 engine rpm. Avoid  
downshifting to brake or slow the vehicle.  
Following breakin, engine speed and load can be  
gradually increased.  
3-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On vehicles with an automatic transmission, the shift  
lever must be in P (Park) to turn the ignition switch  
to LOCK/OFF.  
Ignition Positions  
On vehicles with a manual transmission, the ignition  
switch can be turned to LOCK/OFF in any shift lever  
position.  
The steering can bind with the wheel turned off center.  
If this happens, move it from right to left while turning  
the key to ACC/ACCESSORY. If this does not work,  
then the vehicle needs service.  
WARNING:  
{
If you have a manual transmission removing the  
key from the ignition switch will lock the steering  
column and result in a loss of ability to steer the  
vehicle. This could cause a collision. If you need  
to turn the engine off while the vehicle is moving,  
turn the key to ACC/ACCESSORY.  
The ignition switch has four different positions.  
In order to shift out of P (Park), the ignition must be in  
ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY and the brake pedal  
must be applied.  
Notice: Using a tool to force the key to turn in the  
ignition could cause damage to the switch or break  
the key. Use the correct key, make sure it is all the  
way in, and turn it only with your hand. If the key  
cannot be turned by hand, see your dealer/retailer.  
ACC (ACC/ACCESSORY): This position operates  
some of the electrical accessories. It unlocks the  
steering wheel and ignition.  
9 (LOCK/OFF): This position locks the steering column  
when the key is removed. The key can only be removed  
in LOCK/OFF.  
3-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
R (ON/RUN): This is the position in which you can  
operate the electrical accessories and to display some  
instrument panel cluster warning and indicator lights.  
The switch stays in this position when the engine is  
running.  
Column Lock Release  
For vehicles with an automatic transmission, the  
following procedure allows the ignition to be turned to  
LOCK/OFF and ignition key to be removed in case of a  
dead battery or low voltage battery.  
If you leave the key in the ACC/ACCESSORY or  
ON/RUN position with the engine off, the battery  
could be drained. You may not be able to start the  
vehicle if the battery is allowed to drain for an  
extended period of time.  
1. Make sure the shift lever is in P (Park).  
/ (START): This position starts the engine. When the  
engine starts, release the key. The ignition switch will  
return to ON/RUN for driving.  
A warning tone will sound when the driver door is  
opened, the ignition is in LOCK/OFF or ACC/  
ACCESSORY and the key is in the ignition.  
2. Remove the cover from the bottom of the steering  
column.  
3-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
These vehicle accessories may be used for up to  
10 minutes after the engine is turned off.  
.
Audio System  
.
Power Windows, if equipped  
.
Sunroof, if equipped  
The power windows and sunroof will continue to  
work for up to 10 minutes or until any door is opened.  
The radio will work when the key is in ON/RUN or  
ACC/ACCESSORY. Once the key is turned from  
ON/RUN to OFF/LOCK, the radio will continue to work  
for 10 minutes or until the driver's door is opened.  
Starting the Engine  
Place the transmission in the proper gear.  
3. Locate the plunger.  
4. Press and hold the plunger while turning the  
ignition key to LOCK/OFF. Remove the key.  
Automatic Transmission  
Have the vehicle serviced at your dealer/retailer as  
soon as possible.  
Move the shift lever to P (Park) or N (Neutral).  
The engine will not start in any other position.  
To restart the vehicle when it is already moving,  
use N (Neutral) only.  
Notice: Do not try to shift to P (Park) if the vehicle  
is moving. If you do, you could damage the  
transmission. Shift to P (Park) only when the  
vehicle is stopped.  
3-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Cranking the engine for long periods of  
time, by returning the key to the START position  
immediately after cranking has ended, can overheat  
and damage the cranking motor, and drain the  
battery. Wait at least 15 seconds between each try,  
to let the cranking motor cool down.  
Manual Transmission  
The shift lever should be in N (Neutral) and the parking  
brake engaged. Hold the clutch pedal down to the floor  
and start the engine. The vehicle will not start if the  
clutch pedal is not all the way down.  
Starting Procedure  
2. If the engine does not start after 510 seconds,  
especially in very cold weather (below 0°F or  
18°C), it could be flooded with too much gasoline.  
Push the accelerator pedal all the way to the  
floor and holding it there as you hold the key in  
START for a maximum of 15 seconds. Wait at least  
15 seconds between each try, to allow the cranking  
motor to cool. When the engine starts, let go of the  
key and accelerator. If the vehicle starts briefly but  
then stops again, repeat the procedure. This clears  
the extra gasoline from the engine. Do not race the  
engine immediately after starting it. Operate the  
engine and transmission gently until the oil warms  
up and lubricates all moving parts.  
1. With your foot off the accelerator pedal, turn the  
ignition key to START. When the engine starts,  
let go of the key. The idle speed will go down  
as the engine warms. Do not race the engine  
immediately after starting it. Operate the engine  
and transmission gently to allow the oil to warm  
up and lubricate all moving parts.  
The vehicle has a Computer-Controlled Cranking  
System. This feature assists in starting the engine  
and protects components. If the ignition key is  
turned to the START position, and then released  
when the engine begins cranking, the engine will  
continue cranking for a few seconds or until the  
vehicle starts. If the engine does not start and the  
key is held in START for many seconds, cranking  
will be stopped after 15 seconds to prevent  
cranking motor damage. To prevent gear damage,  
this system also prevents cranking if the engine is  
already running. Engine cranking can be stopped  
by turning the ignition switch to ACC/ACCESSORY  
or LOCK/OFF.  
Notice: The engine is designed to work with the  
electronics in the vehicle. If you add electrical  
parts or accessories, you could change the way  
the engine operates. Before adding electrical  
equipment, check with your dealer/retailer.  
If you do not, the engine might not perform properly.  
Any resulting damage would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
3-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Coolant Heater  
WARNING:  
{
The engine coolant heater can provide easier starting  
and better fuel economy during engine warmup in cold  
weather condition at or below 0°F (18°C). Vehicles  
with am engine coolant heater should be plugged in at  
least four hours before starting. An internal thermostat  
in the plug-end of the cord may exist which will prevent  
engine coolant heater operation at temperatures  
above 0°F (18°C).  
Plugging the cord into an ungrounded outlet could  
cause an electrical shock. Also, the wrong kind of  
extension cord could overheat and cause a fire.  
You could be seriously injured. Plug the cord into  
a properly grounded three-prong 110-volt AC  
outlet. If the cord will not reach, use a heavy-duty  
three-prong extension cord rated for at least  
15 amps.  
To Use the Engine Coolant Heater  
1. Turn off the engine.  
2. Open the hood and unwrap the electrical cord.  
The electrical cord is located on the passenger  
side of the vehicle between the strut and the air  
cleaner/filter.  
4. Before starting the engine, be sure to unplug and  
store the cord as it was before to keep it away from  
moving engine parts, and prevent damaged.  
The length of time the heater should remain plugged in  
depends on several factors. Ask a dealer/retailer in the  
area where you will be parking the vehicle for the best  
advice on this.  
3. Plug it into a normal, grounded 110-volt AC outlet.  
3-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Transmission Operation  
If the vehicle has an automatic transmission, the shift  
lever is located on the console between the seats.  
WARNING:  
{
It is dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the shift  
lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake  
firmly set. The vehicle can roll.  
There are several  
different positions for the  
automatic transmission.  
Do not leave the vehicle when the engine is  
running unless you have to. If you have left the  
engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly.  
You or others could be injured. To be sure the  
vehicle will not move, even when you are on fairly  
level ground, always set the parking brake and  
move the shift lever to P (Park). See Shifting Into  
Park (Automatic Transmission) on page 332  
.
If you are pulling a trailer, see Towing a Trailer  
(Automatic Transmission) on page 533 or  
Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) on  
P (Park): This position locks the front wheels. It is the  
best position to use when starting the engine because  
the vehicle cannot move easily.  
page 539  
.
Make sure the shift lever is fully in P (Park) before  
starting the engine. The vehicle has an automatic  
transmission shift lock control system. You have to fully  
apply the regular brakes first and then press the shift  
lever button before the vehicle can shift from P (Park)  
when the ignition key is in ON/RUN. If the vehicle  
3-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
cannot shift out of P (Park), ease pressure on the shift  
lever and push the shift lever all the way into P (Park)  
as you maintain brake application. Then press the shift  
lever button and then move the shift lever into another  
gear. See Shifting Out of Park (Automatic Transmission)  
WARNING:  
{
Shifting into a drive gear while the engine is  
running at high speed is dangerous. Unless your  
foot is firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could  
move very rapidly. You could lose control and hit  
people or objects. Do not shift into a drive gear  
while the engine is running at high speed.  
on page 333  
.
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is  
moving forward could damage the transmission.  
The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only after the vehicle  
is stopped.  
Notice: Shifting out of P (Park) or N (Neutral) with  
the engine running at high speed may damage the  
transmission. The repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Be sure the engine is not  
running at high speed when shifting the vehicle.  
R (Reverse): Use this gear to back up.  
To rock the vehicle back and forth to get out of snow,  
ice, or sand without damaging the transmission, see If  
Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow on  
page 524  
.
D (Drive): This position is for normal driving with  
the automatic transmission. It provides the best fuel  
economy. If you need more power for passing and  
you are:  
N (Neutral): In this position, the engine does not  
connect with the wheels. To restart the engine when the  
vehicle is already moving, use N (Neutral) only. Also,  
use N (Neutral) when the vehicle is being towed.  
.
Going less than about 35 mph (55 km/h), push the  
accelerator pedal about halfway down.  
.
Going about 35 mph (55 km/h), push the  
accelerator all the way down.  
Downshifting the transmission in slippery road  
conditions could result in skidding, see Skiddingunder  
Loss of Control on page 516.  
3-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
I (Intermediate): This position is also used for normal  
driving. However, it reduces vehicle speed without using  
the brakes for slight downgrades where the vehicle  
would otherwise accelerate due to steepness of grade.  
If constant upshifting or downshifting occurs while  
driving up steep hills, this position can be used to  
prevent repetitive types of shifts. You might choose  
I (Intermediate) instead of D (Drive) when driving on  
hilly, winding roads and when towing a trailer, so that  
there is less shifting between gears.  
Manual Transmission Operation  
This is the shift pattern for standard models.  
This is the shift pattern for SS models.  
L (Low): This position reduces vehicle speed more than  
I (Intermediate) without actually using the brakes. You  
can use it on very steep hills, or in deep snow or mud.  
If the shift lever is put in L (Low), the transmission will  
not shift into a low gear until the vehicle is going slowly  
enough.  
Notice: Spinning the tires or holding the vehicle in  
one place on a hill using only the accelerator pedal  
may damage the transmission. The repair will not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. If you are stuck, do  
not spin the tires. When stopping on a hill, use the  
brakes to hold the vehicle in place.  
3-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here is how to operate the manual transmission:  
3 (Third), 4 (Fourth) and 5 (Fifth): Shift into 3 (Third),  
4 (Fourth) and 5 (Fifth) the same way you do for  
2 (Second). Slowly let up on the clutch pedal as you  
press the accelerator pedal down.  
Notice: Do not rest your hand on the shift lever  
while driving. The pressure could cause premature  
wear in the transmission. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
To stop, let up on the accelerator pedal and press  
the brake pedal. Just before the vehicle stops, press  
the clutch pedal and the brake pedal, and shift to  
N (Neutral).  
1 (First): Press the clutch pedal and shift into 1 (First).  
Then, slowly let up on the clutch pedal as you press the  
accelerator pedal.  
N (Neutral): Use this position when you start or idle  
the engine.  
You can shift into 1 (First) when the vehicle is traveling  
less than 20 mph (32 km/h). If you have come to a  
complete stop and it is hard to shift into 1 (First), put the  
shift lever in N (Neutral) and let up on the clutch pedal.  
Press the clutch pedal back down. Then shift into  
1 (First).  
R (Reverse): To back up, press down the clutch pedal  
and shift into R (Reverse).  
For SS models, lift upwards on the ring located on the  
underside of the shift knob to shift into R (Reverse).  
2 (Second): Press the clutch pedal as you let up  
on the accelerator pedal and shift into 2 (Second).  
Then, slowly let up on the clutch pedal as you press  
the accelerator pedal.  
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is  
moving forward could damage the transmission.  
The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only after the vehicle  
is stopped.  
Also, use R (Reverse), along with the parking brake, for  
parking the vehicle.  
3-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Shift Speeds  
NoLift Upshift (SS Models)  
If the vehicle has the 2.0L turbo engine and manual  
transmission, it has the capability of No-Lift Upshifts.  
This feature maximizes vehicle acceleration by allowing  
you to shift the transmission to a higher gear without  
taking your foot off the accelerator. NoLift Upshifting  
is enabled in all Electronic Stability Control modes.  
See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56 for  
more information. Use this feature only when the engine  
has reached normal operating temperature. Correct  
shifting allows the engine to maintain boost pressure  
during shifts, while also keeping the engine from  
over-revving.  
WARNING:  
{
If you skip a gear when you downshift, you could  
lose control of the vehicle. You could injure  
yourself or others. Do not shift down more than  
one gear at a time when you downshift.  
Up-Shift Light  
If the vehicle has a  
To utilize this feature:  
manual transmission,  
there may be an up-shift  
light. This light will show  
you when to shift to the  
next higher gear for the  
best fuel economy.  
1. Accelerate the vehicle by fully depressing the  
accelerator pedal.  
2. Just prior to reaching the maximum engine  
speed, quickly complete the upshift utilizing  
the clutch while keeping the accelerator pedal  
fully applied. A quicker shift maneuver gives the  
best performance. If the engine is operated at  
the maximum engine speed for greater than  
one second, the engine exits the NoLift Upshift  
mode and resumes normal engine overspeed  
protection.  
When this light comes on, you can shift to the next  
higher gear if weather, road, and traffic conditions let  
you. For the best fuel economy, accelerate slowly and  
shift when the light comes on.  
While accelerating, it is normal for the light to go on and  
off if you quickly change the position of the accelerator.  
Ignore the light when downshifting.  
3-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To set the parking brake, hold the brake pedal down  
and pull up on the parking brake lever. If the ignition  
is on, the brake system warning light will come on.  
See Brake System Warning Light on page 423.  
Parking Brake  
To release the parking brake, hold the brake pedal  
down. Pull the parking brake lever up until you can  
press the release button. Hold the release button in  
as you move the brake lever all the way down.  
If you forget to release your parking brake, a chime will  
sound and the PARKING BRAKE message will appear  
along with the brake system warning light when the  
parking brake is applied and the vehicle is moving  
faster than 5 mph (8 km/h). See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 440.  
Notice: Driving with the parking brake on can  
overheat the brake system and cause premature  
wear or damage to brake system parts. Make sure  
that the parking brake is fully released and the  
brake warning light is off before driving.  
Automatic Shown, Manual Similar  
The parking brake lever is located between the  
front seats.  
For vehicles equipped with an armrest, lift the console  
armrest in order to access the parking brake lever.  
3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leaving the Vehicle With the Engine  
Running (Automatic Transmission)  
Shifting Into Park  
(Automatic Transmission)  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
It can be dangerous to leave the vehicle with the  
engine running. The vehicle could move suddenly  
if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the  
parking brake firmly set. And, if you leave the  
vehicle with the engine running, it could overheat  
and even catch fire. You or others could be  
injured. Do not leave the vehicle with the  
engine running.  
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the  
shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking  
brake firmly set. The vehicle can roll. If you have  
left the engine running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be  
sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are  
on fairly level ground, use the steps that follow.  
If you are pulling a trailer, see Towing a Trailer  
(Automatic Transmission) on page 533 or  
Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) on  
If you have to leave an automatic transmission vehicle  
with the engine running, be sure the vehicle is in  
P (Park) and the parking brake is firmly set before you  
leave it. After you have moved the shift lever into  
P (Park), hold the brake pedal down. Then, see if you  
can move the shift lever away from P (Park) without  
first pushing the button. If you can, it means that the  
shift lever was not fully locked into P (Park).  
page 539  
.
To shift into P (Park):  
1. Hold the brake pedal down and set the parking  
brake. See Parking Brake on page 331 for  
more information.  
2. Move the shift lever into P (Park) by holding in the  
button on the shift lever and pushing the lever all  
the way toward the front of the vehicle.  
3. Turn the ignition key to LOCK/OFF.  
3-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Torque Lock (Automatic Transmission)  
Shifting Out of Park  
If you are parking on a hill and you do not shift into  
P (Park) properly, the weight of the vehicle may put too  
much force on the parking pawl in the transmission. You  
may find it difficult to pull the shift lever out of P (Park).  
This is called torque lock.To prevent torque lock, set  
the parking brake and then shift into P (Park) properly  
before you leave the driver seat. To find out how, see  
Shifting Into Park (Automatic Transmission) on  
(Automatic Transmission)  
This vehicle is equipped with an electronic shift lock  
release system. The shift lock release is designed to:  
.
Prevent ignition key removal unless the shift lever  
is in P (Park) with the shift lever button fully  
released, and  
.
Prevent movement of the shift lever out of  
page 332  
.
P (Park) unless the ignition is in ON/RUN or  
ACC/ACCESSORY and the regular brake pedal  
is applied.  
Move the shift lever out of P (Park) before you release  
the parking brake.  
The shift lock release is always functional except in the  
case of a an uncharged or low voltage (less than 9 volt)  
battery.  
If torque lock does occur, you may need to have  
another vehicle push yours a little uphill to take some of  
the pressure from the parking pawl in the transmission,  
so you can pull the shift lever out of P (Park).  
If the vehicle has an uncharged battery or a battery with  
low voltage, try charging or jump starting the battery.  
See Jump Starting on page 642 for more information.  
To shift out of P (Park):  
1. Apply the brake pedal.  
2. Then press the shift lever button.  
3. Move the shift lever to the desired position.  
3-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you still are unable to shift out of P (Park):  
1. Fully release the shift lever button.  
Parking Over Things That Burn  
WARNING:  
2. While holding down the brake pedal, press the  
shift lever button again.  
{
3. Move the shift lever to the desired position.  
Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust  
parts under the vehicle and ignite. Do not park  
over papers, leaves, dry grass, or other things  
that can burn.  
If you still cannot move the shift lever from P (Park),  
consult your dealer/retailer or a professional towing  
service.  
Parking the Vehicle  
(Manual Transmission)  
Before leaving the vehicle, fully press the clutch pedal  
down, move the shift lever into R (Reverse), and firmly  
apply the parking brake. Once the shift lever has been  
placed in R (Reverse) with the clutch pedal pressed  
down, the ignition key can be turned to LOCK/OFF,  
then remove the key and release the clutch pedal.  
See Manual Transmission Operation on page 328.  
3-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Exhaust  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
.
The vehicles exhaust system has been  
modified, damaged or improperly repaired.  
Engine exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled. Exposure to CO  
can cause unconsciousness and even death.  
.
There are holes or openings in the vehicle  
body from damage or after-market  
modifications that are not completely sealed.  
Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:  
If unusual fumes are detected or if it is suspected  
that exhaust is coming into the vehicle:  
.
The vehicle idles in areas with poor ventilation  
(parking garages, tunnels, deep snow that  
may block underbody airflow or tail pipes).  
.
Drive it only with the windows  
completely down.  
.
The exhaust smells or sounds strange or  
different.  
.
Have the vehicle repaired immediately.  
Never park the vehicle with the engine running in  
an enclosed area such as a garage or a building  
that has no fresh air ventilation.  
.
The exhaust system leaks due to corrosion  
or damage.  
(Continued)  
3-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Running the Vehicle While Parked  
It is better not to park with the engine running. But if you  
ever have to, here are some things to know.  
WARNING:  
{
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle  
if the automatic transmission shift lever is not  
fully in P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set.  
The vehicle can roll. Do not leave the vehicle  
when the engine is running unless you have to.  
If you have left the engine running, the vehicle  
can move suddenly. You or others could be  
injured. To be sure the vehicle will not move,  
even when you are on fairly level ground, always  
set the parking brake and move the shift lever to  
P (Park).  
WARNING:  
{
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed area with poor  
ventilation is dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust contains  
Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen  
or smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and  
even death. Never run the engine in an enclosed  
area that has no fresh air ventilation. For more  
information, see Engine Exhaust on page 335.  
Follow the proper steps to be sure the vehicle will not  
move. See Shifting Into Park (Automatic Transmission)  
on page 332  
.
If parking on a hill and pulling a trailer, see Towing a  
Trailer (Automatic Transmission) on page 533 or  
Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) on page 539.  
3-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Outside Manual Mirror  
Adjust the outside mirror just to see the side of your  
vehicle and have a clear view of objects behind you.  
Mirrors  
Manual Rearview Mirror  
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage  
when going through an automatic car wash. To fold, pull  
the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror outward,  
to return it to the original position.  
Hold the inside rearview mirror in the center to move it  
for a clearer view of behind your vehicle. Adjust the  
mirror to avoid glare from the headlamps behind you.  
Push the tab forward for daytime use and pull it for  
nighttime use.  
Vehicles with OnStar® have three additional control  
buttons located at the bottom of the mirror. See your  
dealer/retailer for more information on the system and  
how to subscribe to OnStar®. See the OnStar® owner's  
guide for more information about the services OnStar®  
provides.  
Outside Remote Control Mirror  
Adjust the driver outside mirror with the control lever  
located on the driver door. Adjust the outside mirrors so  
that the side of the vehicle can be seen.  
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage  
when going through an automatic car wash. To fold, pull  
the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror outward,  
to return it to the original position.  
If the vehicle has map lamps, press the buttons located  
at the bottom of the mirror to turn them on or off.  
3-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage  
when going through an automatic car wash. To fold, pull  
the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror outward,  
to return it to the original position.  
Outside Power Mirrors  
Controls for the outside  
power mirrors are  
located on the driver  
door armrest.  
Outside Convex Mirror  
WARNING:  
{
A convex mirror can make things, like other  
vehicles, look farther away than they really are.  
If you cut too sharply into the right lane, you  
could hit a vehicle on the right. Check the inside  
mirror or glance over your shoulder before  
changing lanes.  
To adjust the mirrors:  
1. Move the selector switch located below the  
four-way control pad to the left or right to choose  
either the driver or passenger side mirror.  
The passenger side mirror is convex shaped. A convex  
mirror's surface is curved so more can be seen from the  
driver seat.  
2. Press one of the four arrows located on the control  
pad to move the mirror to the desired direction.  
3. Adjust each outside mirror so that a little of the  
vehicle and the area behind it can be seen.  
Keep the selector switch in the center position when  
not adjusting either outside mirror.  
3-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Center Console Storage  
For vehicles with a center console storage area, open  
with the lever on the front of the console.  
Storage Areas  
Glove Box  
Lift up on the glove box lever to open it.  
Driver Storage Compartment  
Cupholders  
The driver's storage compartment is located near the  
left side of the steering column on the bottom of the  
instrument panel. Pull the cover down to open.  
There are two cupholders located at the front  
of the center console, in front of the shift lever.  
These cupholders have a liner that can be removed  
for cleaning or to accommodate larger cup sizes.  
There are also cupholders for the rear seat  
Convenience Net  
For vehickes with a convenience net, it is located  
in the rear. Use it to store small loads as far forward  
as possible. The net should not be used to store  
heavy loads.  
passengers located at the rear of the center console.  
3-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press the sunroof switch rearward to open the sunroof  
to the vent position. If the sunshade is closed, it must  
be opened manually in the vent position. Press and  
hold the switch rearward a second time to open the  
sunroof. If the sunshade is closed, it will open  
automatically when the sunroof is opened.  
Sunroof  
On vehicles with a  
sunroof, the switch that  
operates it is located on  
the headliner between  
the map lamps.  
To close the sunroof, press the switch forward and hold  
it until the sunroof is closed. The sunroof will stop if the  
switch is released. Close the sunshade by hand.  
Notice: Forcing the sunshade forward of the sliding  
glass panel may cause damage and the sunroof  
may not operate properly. Always close the glass  
panel before closing the sunshade.  
The sunroof glass panel cannot be opened or closed if  
the vehicle has an electrical failure.  
The sunroof will only operate while the ignition is on,  
or turned to ACC/ACCESSORY, or if Retained  
Accessory Power (RAP) is active. See Retained  
Accessory Power (RAP) on page 323.  
Do not keep the sunroof open for long periods of time.  
Debris may collect in the tracks and possibly damage  
the sunroof and plug the water draining system.  
3-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4 Instrument Panel  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17  
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Windshield Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9  
Wiper Activated Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Headlamps on Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Instrument Panel Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Dome Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Entry/Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Mirror Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Electric Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Battery Run-Down Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Accessory Power Outlet(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Instrument Panel Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Speedometer and Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22  
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Up-Shift Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Brake System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light . . . 4-24  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Indicator/  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/Traction  
Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . . 4-26  
Tire Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
4-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4 Instrument Panel  
Security Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55  
Using an MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66  
XM Radio Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-72  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-85  
Fixed Mast Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-86  
XMSatellite Radio Antenna System . . . . . . . . . 4-86  
Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Highbeam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Boost Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Reconfigurable Performance Display (RPD) . . . 4-33  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
DIC Operation and Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
DIC Vehicle Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tilt Wheel  
Instrument Panel Overview  
Hazard Warning Flashers  
| (Hazard Warning Flasher): Press this button  
located on the instrument panel, to make the front and  
rear turn signal lamps flash on and off. This warns  
others that you are having trouble.  
Press | again to turn the flashers off.  
Horn  
To sound the horn, press the center pad on the steering  
wheel.  
The tilt wheel lever is located on the left side of the  
steering column.  
To adjust the steering wheel:  
1. Pull the lever down.  
2. Move the steering wheel up or down into a  
comfortable position.  
3. Pull the lever up to lock the steering wheel in  
place.  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals  
An arrow on the  
instrument panel cluster  
flashes in the direction of  
the turn or lane change.  
Move the lever all the way up or down to signal a turn.  
Raise or lower the lever until the arrow starts to flash to  
signal a lane change. Hold it there until the lane change  
is complete.  
The lever on the left side of the steering column  
operates the following:  
The lever returns to its starting position when it is  
released.  
G : Turn and Lane-Change Signals  
5 3 : Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
O : Exterior Lamp Control  
If after signaling a turn or a lane change the arrows  
flash rapidly or do not come on, a signal bulb could be  
burned out.  
Flash-to-Pass.  
Have the bulbs replaced. If the bulb is not burned out,  
check the fuse. See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on  
Information for these features is on the pages following.  
page 6125  
.
4-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
Windshield Wipers  
To change the headlamps from low beam to high beam,  
push the turn signal lever away from you.  
This indicator light  
appears on the instrument  
panel cluster when the  
high beams are on.  
To change the headlamps from high beam to low beam,  
pull the turn signal lever toward you.  
The windshield wiper lever is on the right side of the  
steering column.  
Move the lever to control the windshield wipers.  
Flash-to-Pass  
9 (Off): Turns the windshield wipers off.  
To signal to a driver in front of you that you want to  
pass, pull the turn signal/multifunction lever until the  
high-beam headlamps come on. Then release the lever  
to turn them off.  
& (Intermittent; Speed Sensitive Wipers): For  
intermittent or speed sensitive operation. The amount  
of delay time varies between wiping cycles due to the  
delay setting selected or the speed of the vehicle.  
As vehicle speed is increased or decreased, the wiper  
interval also increases or decreases.  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
x (Delay): Move the lever to the & position, then  
turn the x band up for more frequent wipes or down  
for less frequent wipes.  
Windshield Washer  
Press the button at the end of the windshield wiper  
lever until the washers begin.  
6 (Low Speed): Slow wipes.  
1 (High Speed): Fast wipes.  
WARNING:  
{
8 (Mist): Single wipe, move the lever down, then  
release it. Several wipes, hold the lever down.  
In freezing weather, do not use your washer until  
the windshield is warmed. Otherwise the washer  
fluid can form ice on the windshield, blocking your  
vision.  
Clear ice and snow from the wiper blades before  
using them.  
If frozen to the windshield, carefully loosen or thaw  
them. Damaged wiper blades should be replaced.  
When the button is released, the washers stop, but the  
wipers continue to wipe about three times or resume the  
previous speed.  
Heavy snow or ice can overload the wiper motor.  
A circuit breaker stops the motor until it cools. If the  
motor gets stuck, turn the wipers off, clear away the  
snow or ice, and then turn the wipers back on.  
Cruise Control  
As an added safety feature, if the wipers are on for  
more than 15 seconds, the vehicle's headlamps turn on  
automatically. They turn off 15 seconds after the wipers  
are turned off.  
With cruise control, a speed of about 40 km/h (25 mph)  
or more can be maintained without keeping your foot on  
the accelerator. Cruise control does not work at speeds  
below 40 km/h (25 mph).  
The brake must be applied at least one time, after the  
vehicle has been started, before cruise control will  
function.  
4-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The cruise control  
buttons are located on  
the outboard side of the  
steering wheel.  
WARNING:  
{
Cruise control can be dangerous where you  
cannot drive safely at a steady speed. So, do not  
use the cruise control on winding roads or in  
heavy traffic.  
Cruise control can be dangerous on slippery  
roads. On such roads, fast changes in tire traction  
can cause excessive wheel slip, and you could  
lose control. Do not use cruise control on slippery  
roads.  
J (On/Off): Press to turn the cruise control system on  
and off.  
RES+ (Resume): Press to resume a set speed and to  
accelerate the speed.  
Setting Cruise Control  
SET(Set): Press to set a speed and to decrease the  
speed.  
WARNING:  
{
To set a speed do the following:  
If you leave your cruise control on when you are  
not using cruise, you might hit a button and go  
into cruise when you do not want to. You could be  
startled and even lose control. Keep the cruise  
control switch off until you want to use cruise  
control.  
1. Press J to turn the cruise control on.  
The indicator light on the button will come on.  
2. Get to the speed desired.  
3. Press the SETpart of the control button and  
release it. The CRUISE ENGAGED message will  
appear on the Driver Information Center (DIC) to  
show the system is engaged.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.  
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Resuming a Set Speed  
Reducing Speed While Using Cruise  
Control  
Suppose the cruise control is set at a desired speed  
and then the brake is applied. This disengages the  
cruise control. To return to the previously set speed,  
you do not need to go through the set process again.  
Once the vehicle is traveling at least 40 km/h (25 mph)  
or more, press the RES+ part of the button briefly.  
If the cruise control system is already engaged,  
.
Push and hold the SETpart of the button until the  
lower speed desired is reached, then release it.  
.
To slow down in very small amounts, push the  
SETpart of the button briefly. Each time this is  
done, the vehicle goes about 1.6 km/h (1 mph)  
slower.  
The vehicle returns to the previously selected speed  
and stays there.  
Increasing Speed While Using Cruise  
Control  
Passing Another Vehicle While Using  
Cruise Control  
There are two ways to go to a higher speed.  
Use the accelerator pedal to increase the vehicle's  
speed. When you take your foot off the pedal, the  
vehicle will slow down to the cruise control speed  
you set earlier.  
1. Disengage the cruise control by applying the brake  
pedal, but do not turn it off. Accelerate to a higher  
speed and reset the cruise control.  
2. If the cruise control system is already engaged,  
press the RES+ part of the button. Hold it there  
until you get up to the speed desired, and then  
release the button. To increase the vehicle speed  
in very small amounts, press the RES+ part of the  
button briefly and then release it. Each time this is  
done, the vehicle goes about 1.6 km/h (1 mph)  
faster.  
Using Cruise Control on Hills  
How well the cruise control will work on hills depends  
upon the vehicle speed, load, and the steepness of  
the hills. When going up steep hills, you might have to  
step on the accelerator pedal to maintain the vehicle's  
speed. When going downhill, you might have to brake  
or shift to a lower gear to keep the vehicle's speed  
down. Applying the brake will turn off the cruise control.  
4-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The exterior lamp switch has the following  
four positions:  
Ending Cruise Control  
There are two ways to end cruise control:  
2 (Headlamps): Turns on the headlamps, parking  
lamps, and taillamps.  
.
Step lightly on the brake pedal or the clutch pedal  
if the vehicle has a manual transmission. This will  
only end the current cruise control session.  
; (Parking Lamps): Turns on the parking lamps and  
taillamps only.  
.
Press J to turn the system completely off.  
AUTO (Automatic Headlamp System): Automatically  
turns on the Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) during  
daytime, and the headlamps, parking lamps, and  
taillamps at night. This position must be selected  
in order for the Wiper Activated Headlamps to be  
activated. See Wiper Activated Headlamps on  
Erasing Speed Memory  
The cruise control set speed memory is erased when  
the cruise control or the ignition is turned off.  
Headlamps  
page 410  
.
P (Off/On): When operating in AUTO, a momentary  
turn of the switch to Off/On will turn the Automatic  
Headlamp System off or back on. For vehicles first  
sold in Canada, the automatic transmission must be in  
P (Park) or the manual transmission must have the park  
brake set, before the Automatic Headlamp System can  
be turned off.  
The lever on the left side of the steering column  
operates the exterior lamps.  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The DRL system will make the headlamps come on  
when the following conditions are met:  
Wiper Activated Headlamps  
The headlamps and parking lamps are activated  
15 seconds after the windshield wipers are turned on.  
For this feature to work, automatic lighting must be  
enabled. See Headlamps on page 49 for additional  
information.  
.
The ignition is on.  
.
The exterior lamps control is in AUTO or the  
parking lamps only position.  
.
The light sensor detects daytime light.  
.
When the ignition is turned off, the wiper-activated  
headlamps will immediately turn off. They also turn  
off 15 seconds after the windshield wiper control is  
turned off.  
The parking brake is released.  
When the DRL system is on, the taillamps, sidemarker  
lamps, parking lamps, and instrument panel lights will  
not be illuminated unless you have turned the exterior  
lamps control to the parking lamp position.  
Headlamps on Reminder  
If the drivers door is opened with the ignition off and the  
lamps on, a warning chime will sound. This indicates  
that the headlamps are still on.  
As with any vehicle, you should turn on the regular  
headlamp system when you need it.  
Fog Lamps  
For vehicles with fog lamps, the button is located on the  
instrument panel, to the left of the steering wheel.  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) can make it easier for  
others to see the front of your vehicle during the day.  
DRL can be helpful in many different driving conditions,  
but they can be especially helpful in the short periods  
after dawn and before sunset. Fully functional daytime  
running lamps are required on all vehicles first sold in  
Canada. The vehicle has a light sensor on top of the  
instrument panel. Make sure it is not covered, or the  
head lamps will be on when not needed.  
The ignition must be on to use the fog lamps.  
# : Press to turn the fog lamps on off. An indicator light  
on the button comes on when the fog lamps are on.  
The parking lamps automatically turn on and off when  
the fog lamps are turned on and off.  
4-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The fog lamps will turn off while the high-beam  
headlamps are turned on.  
Dome Lamp  
The vehicle may have a dome lamp.  
Some localities have laws that require the headlamps to  
be on along with the fog lamps.  
Move the lever to the following positions:  
9 (Off): Turns the lamp off, even when a door is  
opened.  
Instrument Panel Brightness  
1 (Door): Turns the lamp on whenever a door is  
opened.  
The control for this  
feature is located on the  
instrument panel to the  
left of the steering wheel.  
+ (On): Turns the dome lamp on.  
Entry/Exit Lighting  
The lamps inside the vehicle will go on when any door  
is opened. These lamps fade out about 20 seconds  
after all of the doors have been closed or when the  
ignition is turned to ON/RUN. These lamps will also go  
on when pressing the trunk release, unlock symbol,  
or the horn symbol button on the Remote Keyless Entry  
System (RKE) Transmitter.  
Turn the knob clockwise to brighten the lights or  
counterclockwise to dim the instrument panel lights,  
when the parking lamps or headlamps are on.  
After the key is removed from the ignition, the lamps  
inside the vehicle stay on for about 20 seconds to  
provide an illuminated exit.  
Mirror Reading Lamps  
The vehicle may have reading lamps on the rearview  
mirror. Press the button near each lamp to turn the  
reading lamps on and off.  
4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EPM works to prevent excessive discharge of the  
battery. It does this by balancing the generator's output  
and the vehicle's electrical needs. It can increase  
engine idle speed to generate more power, whenever  
needed. It can temporarily reduce the power demands  
of some accessories.  
Electric Power Management  
This vehicle has Electric Power Management (EPM),  
an advanced control system. It estimates the battery's  
temperature and state of charge and then adjusts the  
voltage for best performance and extended life of the  
battery.  
Normally, these actions occur in steps or levels, without  
being noticeable. In rare cases at the highest levels of  
corrective action, this action may be noticeable to the  
driver.  
When the battery's state of charge is low, the voltage  
is raised slightly to quickly put the charge back in.  
When the state of charge is high, the voltage is lowered  
slightly to prevent overcharging. If the vehicle has  
a voltmeter gauge or voltage display on the Driver  
Information Center (DIC), you may see the voltage  
move up or down. This is normal. If there is a problem,  
an alert will be displayed.  
Battery Run-Down Protection  
The vehicle has a battery saver feature designed to  
protect the vehicle's battery.  
When any interior lamp is left on and the ignition is  
turned off, the battery rundown protection system  
automatically turns the lamp off after 20 minutes.  
This prevents draining of the battery.  
The battery can be discharged at idle if the electrical  
loads are very high. This is true for all vehicles. This is  
because the generator (alternator) may not be spinning  
fast enough at idle to produce all the power that is  
needed for very high electrical loads.  
Accessory Power Outlet(s)  
Accessory power outlets can be used to connect  
electrical equipment, such as a cellular phone.  
A high electrical load occurs when several of the  
following loads are on: headlamps, high beams, fog  
lamps, rear window defogger, climate control fan at high  
speed, heated seats, engine cooling fans, trailer loads,  
and loads plugged into accessory power outlets.  
The accessory power outlet is located in the center  
console, rearward of the shift lever.  
To use the accessory power outlet, remove the cover.  
When not in use, always cover the accessory power  
outlet with the protective cap.  
4-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Leaving electrical equipment on for  
extended periods will drain the battery. Always  
turn off electrical equipment when not in use  
and do not plug in equipment that exceeds the  
maximum amperage rating of 20 amperes.  
Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter  
The vehicle may have an ashtray and cigarette lighter.  
To use the lighter, located on the instrument panel  
below the climate controls, push it in all the way and  
let go. When it is ready, it will pop back out by itself.  
Certain electrical accessories may not be compatible  
with the accessory power outlet and could result in  
blown vehicle or adapter fuses. If you experience a  
problem, see your dealer/retailer for additional  
information on the accessory power outlet.  
Notice: Holding a cigarette lighter in while it is  
heating will not allow the lighter to back away from  
the heating element when it is hot. Damage from  
overheating may occur to the lighter or heating  
element, or a fuse could be blown. Do not hold a  
cigarette lighter in while it is heating. Do not use  
equipment exceeding maximum amperage rating  
of 15 amperes.  
Notice: Adding any electrical equipment to the  
vehicle can damage it or keep other components  
from working as they should. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not use  
equipment exceeding maximum amperage rating of  
20 amperes. Check with your dealer/retailer before  
adding electrical equipment.  
To clean the center console ashtray, remove the entire  
ashtray and empty it.  
Notice: If papers, pins, or other flammable items are  
put in the ashtray, hot cigarettes or other smoking  
materials could ignite them and possibly damage  
the vehicle. Never put flammable items in the  
ashtray.  
When adding electrical equipment, be sure to follow the  
installation instructions included with the equipment.  
Notice: Improper use of the power outlet can cause  
damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not  
hang any type of accessory or accessory bracket  
from the plug because the power outlets are  
designed for accessory power plugs only.  
4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To change the current mode, select one of the following:  
Climate Controls  
9 (Off): Turn the fan control to this position to turn the  
fan off.  
Climate Control System  
The heating, cooling, and ventilation for the vehicle can  
be controlled with this system.  
Temperature Control: Turn clockwise or  
counterclockwise to increase or decrease the  
temperature.  
9 (Fan Control): Turn clockwise or counterclockwise  
to increase or decrease the fan speed. In any setting  
other than off, the fan will run continuously with the  
ignition on. The fan must be turned on to run the air  
conditioning compressor.  
Air Delivery Mode Control: Turn clockwise or  
counterclockwise to change the direction of the airflow  
inside the vehicle.  
Select from the following modes:  
H (Vent): Air is directed to the instrument panel  
outlets.  
Vehicles with Air Conditioning shown, without Air  
Conditioning similar  
) (Bi-Level): Air is divided between the instrument  
panel outlets and the floor outlets. Cooler air is directed  
to the upper outlets and warmer air to the floor outlets.  
A. Air Delivery Mode  
Control  
D. Air Conditioning  
E. Rear Window Defogger  
F. Recirculation  
B. Fan Control  
6 (Floor): Air is directed to the floor outlets, with some  
air directed to the windshield and side windows.  
C. Temperature Control  
4-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- (Defog): This mode clears the windows of fog or  
moisture. Air is directed to the windshield, side window,  
and floor outlets. To defog the windows faster, turn the  
temperature control knob clockwise to the warmest  
setting. In this mode, the system runs the air  
conditioning compressor.  
For quick cool down on hot days:  
1. Select the H mode.  
2. Select the h mode.  
3. Select #.  
4. Select the coolest temperature.  
5. Select the highest fan speed.  
0 (Defrost): This mode removes fog or frost from  
the windshield more quickly. Air is directed to the  
windshield, with some air directed to the side window  
outlets and the floor outlets. To defrost the windows  
faster, turn the temperature control knob clockwise to  
the warmest setting. In this mode, the system runs the  
air conditioning compressor.  
Using these settings together for long periods of time  
may cause the air inside of the vehicle to become too  
dry. To prevent this from happening, after the air in the  
vehicle has cooled, turn off the recirculation by pressing  
the button again.  
For best results, clear all snow and ice from the  
windshield before defrosting.  
The air conditioning system removes moisture from  
the air, so a small amount of water might drip under  
the vehicle while idling or after turning off the engine.  
This is normal.  
# (Air Conditioning): For vehicles with air  
conditioning, press this button to turn the air  
conditioning system on or off. An indicator light  
comes on to show that the air conditioning is on.  
The air conditioning compressor cannot be turned on  
when the fan is off.  
On hot days, open the windows to let hot inside air  
escape; then close them. This helps to reduce the time  
it takes for the vehicle to cool down. It also helps the  
system to operate more efficiently.  
h (Recirculation): Press to turn the recirculation  
mode on. An indicator light comes on to show that  
recirculation is on.  
This mode recirculates and helps to quickly cool the  
air inside the vehicle. It can be used to help prevent  
outside air and odors from entering the vehicle.  
4-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The air conditioning compressor also comes on.  
Recirculation is not available for floor, defog and  
defrost modes. If recirculation is selected in any of  
these modes, the recirculate indicator light flashes  
five times and outside air will be delivered. Operation  
in this mode during periods of high humidity and cool  
outside temperatures may result in increased window  
fogging. If window fogging is experienced, select the  
defrost mode.  
The rear window defogger turns off about 15 minutes  
after the button is pressed. If turned on again, the  
defogger only runs for about seven minutes before  
turning off. If the vehicle is moving faster than 50 mph  
(80 kph), the rear defogger will stay on. The defogger  
can also be turned off by turning off the engine.  
Notice: Do not use anything sharp on the inside of  
the rear window. If you do, you could cut or damage  
the warming grid, and the repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not attach a  
temporary vehicle license, tape, a decal or anything  
similar to the defogger grid.  
Outside Air: This mode allows outside air to circulate  
through the vehicle. This mode is automatically active  
if recirculate is not selected. There is no button for  
outside air.  
Outlet Adjustment  
Use the thumbwheels located next to and below the air  
outlets to change the direction of the airflow and to  
open and close the outlets.  
Rear Window Defogger  
The rear window defogger uses a warming grid to  
remove fog from the rear window.  
The rear window defogger only works when the ignition  
is in ON/RUN.  
Operation Tips  
.
Clear away any ice, snow or leaves from the air  
< (Rear): Press to turn the rear window defogger on  
or off. Be sure to clear as much snow from the rear  
window as possible. An indicator light comes on to  
show that the rear window defogger is on.  
inlets at the base of the windshield that may block  
the flow of air into the vehicle.  
.
Use of non-GM approved hood deflectors may  
adversely affect the performance of the system.  
.
Keep the path under the front seats clear of  
objects to help circulate the air inside of the  
vehicle more effectively.  
4-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter  
The filter removes dust and pollen from the air which is  
drawn into the vehicle. Airflow reduction is an indication  
that the filter needs to be replaced.  
The filter should be replaced as part of routine  
scheduled maintenance. See Scheduled Maintenance  
on page 73 for replacement intervals. To find  
out what type of filter to use, see Maintenance  
Replacement Parts on page 713.  
To access the passenger compartment air filter:  
1. Open and empty the glove box.  
3. Pull the tab at the back of the glove box toward  
you and open the passenger compartment air filter  
door downward.  
2. Lower the glove box door by pressing in on each  
side and lowering from the track.  
4-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and  
Indicators  
Warning lights and gauges can signal that something is  
wrong before it becomes serious enough to cause an  
expensive repair or replacement. Paying attention to the  
warning lights and gauges could prevent injury.  
Warning lights come on when there might be or there  
is a problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Some  
warning lights come on briefly when the engine is  
started to indicate they are working.  
Gauges can indicate when there might be or there is  
a problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Often  
gauges and warning lights work together to indicate a  
problem with the vehicle.  
4. Pull the filter out toward you.  
When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on  
while driving, or when one of the gauges shows there  
could be a problem, check the section that explains  
what to do. Follow this manual's advice. Waiting to do  
repairs can be costly and even dangerous.  
Install the new air filter with the AIR FLOW arrow  
pointing downward. Reverse Steps 1 through 3 to  
reassemble.  
4-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel Cluster  
The instrument panel cluster is designed to show how the vehicle is running. It shows how fast the vehicle is going,  
about how much fuel is left in the tank, and many other things needed to drive safely and economically.  
United States SS, Manual Transmission Cluster shown, Canada, Base and Automatic Transmission similar  
4-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speedometer and Odometer  
Safety Belt Reminders  
The speedometer shows the speed in both kilometers  
per hour (km/h) and miles per hour (mph).  
Driver Safety Belt Reminder Light  
When the engine is started, a chime sounds for  
several seconds to remind a driver to fasten the safety  
belt, unless the driver safety belt is already buckled.  
The vehicle's odometer works together with the Driver  
Information Center (DIC). Trip A and Trip B can be set  
on the odometer. See Trip Informationunder DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 438.  
The safety belt light  
comes on and stays on  
for several seconds, then  
flashes for several more.  
The vehicle does not have to be running to check the  
odometer mileage. Simply open the driver's door and  
the mileage briefly displays.  
If the vehicle ever needs a new odometer installed, the  
new one will be set to the correct total mileage of the  
old odometer.  
Tachometer  
The tachometer displays the engine speed in  
revolutions per minute (rpm).  
This chime and light are repeated if the driver remains  
unbuckled and the vehicle is in motion. If the driver  
safety belt is already buckled, neither the chime nor the  
light comes on.  
Notice: If the engine is operated with the  
tachometer in the shaded warning area, the  
vehicle could be damaged, and the damages  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Do not operate the engine with the tachometer in  
the shaded warning area.  
Passenger Safety Belt Reminder Light  
For vehicles equipped with the passenger safety belt  
reminder light, several seconds after the engine is  
started, a chime sounds for several seconds to remind  
the front passenger to buckle their safety belt. The  
passenger safety belt light, located on the instrument  
panel, comes on and stays on for several seconds and  
then flashes for several more.  
4-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This chime and light are  
repeated if the passenger  
remains unbuckled and  
the vehicle is in motion.  
The airbag readiness light  
flashes for a few seconds  
when the engine is  
started. If the light does  
not come on then, have it  
fixed immediately.  
If the passenger safety belt is buckled, neither the  
chime nor the light comes on.  
WARNING:  
{
The front passenger safety belt warning light and chime  
may turn on if an object is put on the seat such as a  
briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop or other  
electronic device. To turn off the warning light and or  
chime, remove the object from the seat or buckle the  
safety belt.  
If the airbag readiness light stays on after the  
vehicle is started or comes on while driving, it  
means the airbag system might not be working  
properly. The airbags in the vehicle might not  
inflate in a crash, or they could even inflate  
without a crash. To help avoid injury, have the  
vehicle serviced right away.  
Airbag Readiness Light  
The system checks the airbag's electrical system for  
possible malfunctions. If the light stays on it indicates  
there is an electrical problem. The system check  
includes the airbag sensor, the pretensioners, the  
airbag modules, the wiring and the crash sensing and  
diagnostic module. For more information on the airbag  
system, see Airbag System on page 253.  
If there is a problem with the airbag system, an airbag  
Driver Information Center (DIC) message can also  
come on. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 440 for more information.  
4-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Then, after several more seconds, the status indicator  
will light either ON or OFF, or either the on or off symbol  
to let you know the status of the right front passenger  
frontal airbag.  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator  
If the vehicle has one of the passenger airbag status  
indicators pictured in the following illustrations, then the  
vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the right  
front passenger position. The passenger airbag status  
indicator, if equipped, is on the instrument panel. See  
Passenger Sensing System (Without Turbo Engine) on  
page 262 or Passenger Sensing System (With Turbo  
Engine) on page 267 for important safety information.  
If the word ON or the on symbol is lit on the passenger  
airbag status indicator, it means that the right front  
passenger frontal airbag is enabled (may inflate).  
If the word OFF or the off symbol is lit on the airbag  
status indicator, it means that the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right front passenger frontal  
airbag.  
In addition, if the vehicle has a passenger sensing  
system for the right front passenger position, the label  
on the vehicle's sun visors refer to ADVANCED  
AIRBAGS.  
If, after several seconds, both status indicator lights  
remain on, or if there are no lights at all, there may be  
a problem with the lights or the passenger sensing  
system. See your dealer/retailer for service.  
WARNING:  
{
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and  
stays on, it means that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to  
yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 421  
for more information, including important safety  
information.  
United States  
Canada  
When the vehicle is started, the passenger airbag  
status indicator will light ON and OFF, or the symbol  
for on and off, for several seconds as a system check.  
If using remote start, if equipped, to start the vehicle  
from a distance, you may not see the system check.  
4-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Charging System Light  
When this light comes on, shift to the next higher gear if  
weather, road, and traffic conditions allow.  
This light comes on briefly  
See Manual Transmission Operation on page 328 for  
more information.  
when the ignition is turned  
on, and the engine is not  
running, as a check to  
show it is working. Then it  
should go out when the  
engine is started.  
Brake System Warning Light  
The vehicle's hydraulic brake system is divided into  
two parts. If one part is not working, the other part can  
still work and stop the vehicle. For good braking both  
parts need to be working well.  
If the light stays on, or comes on while driving, there  
may be a problem with the electrical charging system.  
Have it checked by your dealer/retailer. Driving while  
this light is on could drain the battery.  
If the warning light comes on, there is a brake problem.  
Have the brake system inspected right away.  
If a short distance must be driven with the light on,  
turn off all accessories, such as the radio and air  
conditioner.  
Up-Shift Light  
The vehicle may have an  
up-shift light.  
United States  
Canada  
This light should come on briefly when the engine is  
started. If it does not come on then, have it fixed so it  
will be ready to warn if there is a problem.  
4-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the ignition is on, the brake system warning light  
also comes on when the parking brake is set. The light  
stays on if the parking brake does not fully release. If it  
stays on after the parking brake is fully released, it  
means the vehicle has a brake problem.  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
Warning Light  
For vehicles with the  
Antilock Brake System  
(ABS), this light comes on  
briefly when the engine is  
started.  
If the light comes on while driving, pull off the road and  
stop carefully. Make sure the parking brake is fully  
released. The pedal might be harder to push or, the  
pedal could go closer to the floor. It can take longer to  
stop. Try turning off and restarting the vehicle one or  
two times, if the light is still on, have the vehicle towed  
for service. See Towing Your Vehicle on page 530.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer. If the system is working normally the  
indicator light then goes off.  
WARNING:  
{
If the ABS light stays on, turn the ignition off. If the light  
comes on while driving, stop as soon as it is safely  
possible and turn the ignition off. Then start the engine  
again to reset the system. If the ABS light stays on,  
or comes on again while driving, the vehicle needs  
service. If the regular brake system warning light is not  
on, the vehicle still has brakes, but not antilock brakes.  
If the regular brake system warning light is also on, the  
vehicle does not have antilock brakes and there is a  
problem with the regular brakes. See Brake System  
Warning Light on page 423.  
The brake system might not be working properly if  
the brake system warning light is on. Driving with  
the brake system warning light on can lead to a  
crash. If the light is still on after the vehicle has  
been pulled off the road and carefully stopped,  
have the vehicle towed for service.  
For vehicles with a Driver Information Center (DIC),  
see DIC Warnings and Messages on page 440 for all  
brake related DIC messages.  
4-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
See Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on page 512  
and DIC Warnings and Messages on page 440 for  
more information.  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS)  
Indicator/Warning Light  
For vehicles with the  
Enhanced Traction  
System (ETS), this light  
serves as an indicator  
and warning light.  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
Indicator/Warning Light  
For vehicles with the  
Electronic Stability  
Control (ESC) system  
or the Traction Control  
System (TCS), the  
indicator/warning light  
comes on briefly when  
the engine is started.  
This light comes on briefly while the engine is started.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer. If the system is working normally the  
indicator light then goes off.  
If the indicator/warning light is on and not flashing,  
the ETS system could have been disabled. Check all  
related Driver Information Center (DIC) messages to  
determine whether the system has been turned off or  
if the system is not working properly and the vehicle  
requires service. If the ETS has been disabled, wheel  
spin is not limited.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by the  
dealer/retailer. If the system is working normally the  
indicator light goes off.  
If this light is on while certain DIC messages display,  
this indicates that the ESC and TCS are not working or  
are disabled.  
If the indicator/warning light is on and flashing, the ETS  
is actively working. The LOW TRACTION DIC message  
also appears when the system is actively limiting  
wheel spin.  
4-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If this light is on and not flashing, the TCS and  
potentially the ESC system have been disabled.  
Check the DIC messaging to determine which feature(s)  
is no longer functioning and whether it is because of the  
driver turning off the feature(s), or because the system  
is not working properly and the vehicle requires service.  
Engine Coolant Temperature  
Warning Light  
This light comes on briefly  
while starting the vehicle.  
If the TCS is disabled, wheel spin is not limited. If the  
ESC system is disabled, the system does not aid in  
maintaining directional control of the vehicle.  
If the indicator/warning light is on and flashing, the TCS  
or the ESC system is actively working. Check the DIC  
messaging for details to determine which system is  
working. If the LOW TRACTION message appears,  
the system is limiting wheel spin. If the ESC ACTIVE  
message appears, the system is aiding in maintaining  
directional control of the vehicle.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by the  
dealer/retailer. If the system is working normally  
the indicator light goes off.  
Notice: Driving with the engine coolant temperature  
warning light on could cause the vehicle to  
overheat. See Engine Overheating on page 634  
The vehicle's engine could be damaged, and it  
might not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Never  
drive with the engine coolant temperature warning  
light on.  
See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56  
and Traction Control System (TCS) on page 59 for  
more information.  
.
See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 440 for  
more information on the messages associated with this  
light.  
The engine coolant temperature warning light comes on  
when the engine has overheated.  
If this happens pull over and turn off the engine as soon  
as possible. See Engine Overheating on page 634 for  
more information.  
4-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the Light Flashes First and Then is  
On Steady  
Tire Pressure Light  
For vehicles with a tire  
pressure monitoring  
system, this light comes  
on briefly when the engine  
is started. It provides  
information about tire  
pressures and the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring  
System.  
This indicates that there may be a problem with the  
Tire Pressure Monitor System. The light flashes for  
about a minute and stays on steady for the remainder  
of the ignition cycle. This sequence repeats with every  
ignition cycle. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on  
page 668 for more information.  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
Check Engine Light  
A computer system called OBD II (On-Board  
Diagnostics-Second Generation) monitors operation  
of the fuel, ignition, and emission control systems.  
It ensures that emissions are at acceptable levels for  
the life of the vehicle, helping to produce a cleaner  
environment.  
When the Light is On Steady  
This indicates that one or more of the tires is  
significantly underinflated.  
A tire pressure message in the Driver Information  
Center (DIC), can accompany the light. See Driver  
Information Center (DIC) on page 438 for more  
information. Stop and check the tires as soon as it is  
safe to do so. If underinflated, inflate to the proper  
pressure. See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 666  
for more information.  
This light should come on  
when the ignition is on,  
but the engine is not  
running, as a check to  
show it is working. If it  
does not, have the  
vehicle serviced by  
your dealer/retailer.  
4-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Modifications to these systems could lead to  
costly repairs not covered by the vehicle warranty.  
This could also result in a failure to pass a  
required Emission Inspection/Maintenance test.  
See Accessories and Modifications on page 64.  
If the check engine light comes on and stays on, while  
the engine is running, this indicates that there is an  
OBD II problem and service is required.  
Malfunctions often are indicated by the system before  
any problem is apparent. Being aware of the light can  
prevent more serious damage to the vehicle. This  
system assists the service technician in correctly  
diagnosing any malfunction.  
This light comes on during a malfunction in one of  
two ways:  
Light Flashing: A misfire condition has been detected.  
A misfire increases vehicle emissions and could  
damage the emission control system on the vehicle.  
Diagnosis and service might be required.  
Notice: If the vehicle is continually driven with this  
light on, after a while, the emission controls might  
not work as well, the vehicle's fuel economy might  
not be as good, and the engine might not run as  
smoothly. This could lead to costly repairs that  
might not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
To prevent more serious damage to the vehicle:  
.
Reduce vehicle speed.  
.
Avoid hard accelerations.  
Notice: Modifications made to the engine,  
.
Avoid steep uphill grades.  
transmission, exhaust, intake, or fuel system of the  
vehicle or the replacement of the original tires with  
other than those of the same Tire Performance  
Criteria (TPC) can affect the vehicle's emission  
controls and can cause this light to come on.  
.
If towing a trailer, reduce the amount of cargo  
being hauled as soon as it is possible.  
4-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Make sure to fuel the vehicle with quality fuel.  
Poor fuel quality causes the engine not to run as  
efficiently as designed and can cause: stalling  
after start-up, stalling when the vehicle is changed  
into gear, misfiring, hesitation on acceleration,  
or stumbling on acceleration. These conditions  
might go away once the engine is warmed up.  
If the light continues to flash, when it is safe to do so,  
stop the vehicle. Find a safe place to park the vehicle.  
Turn the key off, wait at least 10 seconds, and restart  
the engine. If the light is still flashing, follow the  
previous steps and see your dealer/retailer for service  
as soon as possible.  
Light On Steady: An emission control system  
malfunction has been detected on the vehicle.  
Diagnosis and service might be required.  
If one or more of these conditions occurs, change  
the fuel brand used. It will require at least one full  
tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off.  
An emission system malfunction might be corrected by  
doing the following:  
See Gasoline Octane on page 67.  
If none of the above have made the light turn off, your  
dealer/retailer can check the vehicle. The dealer/retailer  
has the proper test equipment and diagnostic tools to fix  
any mechanical or electrical problems that might have  
developed.  
.
Make sure the fuel cap is fully installed. See Filling  
the Tank on page 610. The diagnostic system  
can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or  
improperly installed. A loose or missing fuel cap  
allows fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. A few  
driving trips with the cap properly installed should  
turn the light off.  
.
If the vehicle has been driven through a deep  
puddle of water, the vehicle's electrical system  
might be wet. The condition is usually corrected  
when the electrical system dries out. A few driving  
trips should turn the light off.  
4-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Emissions Inspection and Maintenance  
Programs  
Oil Pressure Light  
Some state/provincial and local governments have  
or might begin programs to inspect the emission  
control equipment on the vehicle. Failure to pass this  
inspection could prevent getting a vehicle registration.  
Here are some things to know to help the vehicle pass  
an inspection:  
.
The vehicle will not pass this inspection if the  
check engine light is on with the engine running,  
or if the key is in ON/RUN and the light is not on.  
WARNING:  
{
.
The vehicle will not pass this inspection if the  
OBD II (on-board diagnostic) system determines  
that critical emission control systems have not  
been completely diagnosed by the system.  
The vehicle would be considered not ready for  
inspection. This can happen if the battery has  
recently been replaced or if the battery has run  
down. The diagnostic system is designed to  
evaluate critical emission control systems during  
normal driving. This can take several days of  
routine driving. If this has been done and the  
vehicle still does not pass the inspection for lack  
of OBD II system readiness, your dealer/retailer  
can prepare the vehicle for inspection.  
Do not keep driving if the oil pressure is low.  
The engine can become so hot that it catches fire.  
Someone could be burned. Check the oil as soon  
as possible and have the vehicle serviced.  
Notice: Lack of proper engine oil maintenance  
can damage the engine. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Always follow the  
maintenance schedule in this manual for changing  
engine oil.  
4-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This light comes on briefly while starting the engine.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer. If the system is working normally the  
indicator light then goes off.  
Fog Lamp Light  
The fog lamp light comes  
on when the fog lamps  
are in use.  
If the light comes on and stays on, it means that oil is  
not flowing through the engine properly. The vehicle  
could be low on oil and it might have some other  
system problem.  
Security Light  
The light goes out when the fog lamps are turned off.  
See Fog Lamps on page 410 for more information.  
For information regarding  
this light and the vehicle's  
security system, see  
Highbeam On Light  
Content Theft-Deterrent  
on page 316  
.
This light comes on when  
the high-beam headlamps  
are in use.  
See Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer on page 45  
for more information.  
4-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
The gauge moves a little while turning a corner or  
speeding up.  
Fuel Gauge  
The fuel gauge shows  
about how much fuel the  
vehicle has left.  
The gauge does not go back to empty when the  
ignition is turned off.  
For the fuel tank capacity, see Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6131.  
Boost Gauge  
An arrow on the fuel gauge indicates the side of the  
vehicle the fuel door is on.  
Here are four things that some owners ask about.  
None of these show a problem with the fuel gauge:  
.
At the service station, the gas pump shuts off  
before the gauge reads full.  
United States  
Canada  
.
It takes a little more or less fuel to fill up than the  
gauge indicated. For example, the gauge may  
have indicated the tank was half full, but it actually  
took a little more or less than half the tank's  
capacity to fill the tank.  
If equipped, this gauge is located near the driver side of  
the instrument panel cluster.  
This gauge indicates vacuum during light to moderate  
throttle and boost under heavier throttle.  
4-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This gauge displays the air pressure level in the intake  
manifold before it enters the engine's combustion  
chamber.  
This gauge is automatically centered at zero every  
time the engine is started. Actual vacuum or boost is  
displayed from this zero point. Changes in ambient  
pressure, such as driving in mountains and changing  
weather, will slightly change the zero reading.  
Reconfigurable Performance  
Display (RPD)  
For vehicles with the RPD, the screen displays  
information that can be used to monitor vehicle  
performance. The RPD knob located next to the  
screen is used to configure the display and select  
information to be viewed.  
RPD Screen Example US Version Shown, Canada  
Similar (French Display Currently Not Available)  
The RPD screen displays two divided areas (A, B) of  
information called Regions. Advance through Region A  
screens to show various gauges and speedometer  
displays. Advance through Region B screens to show  
digital readouts and indicator information.  
A short video plays whenever the ignition key is turned  
on. Press the RPD knob to stop the video and go  
directly to RPD displays.  
The position of these regions can be reversed.  
See the SETUP MENU for more information.  
When the ignition is turned off and then back on, the  
RPD shows the last screen displayed.  
4-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SPEEDOMETER & G FORCE : The G FORCE meter  
displays lateral acceleration. While turning right,  
G forces are felt on the left, and vice versa. PEAK  
values are stored indefinitely, and can be reset with a  
press and hold of the RPD knob while viewing the  
G FORCE meter.  
Region A Gauge and Speedometer  
Displays  
Change the information displayed in Region A by  
turning the knob either clockwise or counterclockwise.  
The available gauges are:  
SETUP MENU: Press the RPD knob to enter this  
menu. The vehicle should be stopped while configuring  
the setup menu selections.  
BOOST: Displays positive boost pressure as  
determined by the manifold air pressure (MAP) sensor.  
AIR/FUEL RATIO: Displays the mass ratio of air to fuel.  
SCREEN OFF: Turns the screen off.  
CAM PHASER ANGLES: Displays orientation of the  
intake and exhaust cam shafts relative to their park  
positions as commanded by the engine control module.  
OVERLAP represents the total distance the intake and  
exhaust cam shafts have phased.  
Region B Readout Displays  
Press the RPD knob to highlight Region B. The  
information displayed can be changed by turning  
the RPD knob either clockwise or counterclockwise.  
Press the RPD knob again, to store the selection.  
The selection will also be stored after a few seconds  
of no activity. Available modes are:  
SPARK ADVANCE/ KNOCK RETARD: The spark  
advance gauge displays ignition timing. Knock retard  
indicates the amount of ignition delay to reduce spark  
knock.  
Readouts #1  
ENGINE POWER & TORQUE : Displayed engine  
power and torque are engine flywheel output values  
calculated by the engine control module. These  
values are approximate and may change with the air  
conditioning load, generator output, air temperature,  
air pressure, and fuel octane.  
SHIFT LIGHTS/GEAR INDICATION: The shift lights  
provide visual identification of engine speed for a  
transmission gear. Shift light minimum and maximum  
RPM settings can be viewed and configured in the  
SETUP screen. The gear indication on manual  
transmission vehicles is calculated by the engine  
control module. The gear is only displayed when  
enough torque is available to determine the selected  
forward gear.  
4-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Readouts #2  
INDICATORS  
TIRE PRESSURES: Displays the last gauge tire  
pressures recorded from each of the wheel mounted  
tire pressure sensors.  
The indicators come on when the corresponding  
function is actively working to stabilize or control the  
vehicle. Each indicator light on the RPD display can  
be turned on and off using the SETUP MENU. These  
indicators work independently of the telltales on the  
instrument panel cluster. Turning the indicator on the  
RPD display on or off does not enable or disable the  
functions on the vehicle.  
Readouts #3  
BAROMETER: Displays ambient air pressure as  
measured by the engines ambient pressure sensor.  
OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE: Displays ambient  
temperature as measured by an outside air temperature  
sensor.  
BATTERY VOLTAGE: Displays the vehicles battery  
voltage.  
Readouts #4  
COOLANT TEMPERATURE: Displays engine coolant  
temperature as measured by a coolant temperature  
sensor.  
This indicator comes on whenever the vehicle  
StabiliTrak® is actively working.  
INLET AIR TEMPERATURE: Displays the  
instantaneous temperature of the air at the inlet  
to the induction system.  
FUEL PRESSURE: Displays fuel pressure as  
measured by a sensor on the output of the  
high-pressure fuel pump.  
4-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP MENU  
The SETUP MENU allows for the appearance of each  
display screen to be customized. Turn the knob to scroll  
through the screens to reach the SETUP MENU. Press  
and release the knob to activate the SETUP MENU.  
This indicator comes on when Competitive Driving  
Mode (A) has been set using the traction control switch.  
This telltale comes on whenever conditions are right for  
the Launch Mode (B) to activate.  
See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56 for  
more information on Competitive Driving Mode and  
Launch Control.  
Selecting a SETUP MENU Option  
1. Under SETUP MENU there are six menu options  
to choose. Turn the RPD knob to highlight an  
option.  
This indicator comes on whenever the vehicle Traction  
Control system is actively working.  
2. Press and release the RPD knob to select the  
highlighted menu option.  
4-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTRAST: While the contrast slider is highlighted,  
press the knob to allow adjustment. Turn the knob to  
adjust the contrast of the screen. Press the knob again  
when the desired contrast is reached.  
SETUP MENU Options  
GAUGE APPEARANCE: While the gauge is  
highlighted, press the RPD knob. Then turn the knob to  
choose the background color for a gauge. Press the  
knob again when gauge color is chosen.  
RESTORE DEFAULTS: Restores the original factory  
screen defaults.  
SHIFT LIGHT SETUP: This screen establishes a RPM  
range where the shift light comes on for each gear.  
Turn the RPD knob to highlight a shift light setting.  
Press the knob to allow adjustment of the highlighted  
setting. Turn the knob to adjust the value up or down,  
then press the knob again to allow the selection of  
another item. The number above each gear shows  
the highest RPM the light comes on for a gear range.  
The number below each gear indicates the lowest RPM  
the light comes on for a gear range.  
Applying a SETUP MENU Option  
After each screen is customized, use this procedure to  
apply the change and return to the SETUP MENU.  
SET: Applies the changes to the display.  
1. Turn until SET is highlighted.  
2. Press and release while SET is highlighted to lock  
in the setting and return to the previous screen.  
RETURN /RET: Returns the display to the previous  
screen without saving changes.  
INDICATORS ON/OFF: Select on or off for each  
indicator by turning the RPD knob to highlight ON or  
OFF. Press and Release the RPD knob to apply the  
choice. The actual Traction Control, StabiliTrak®,  
Competitive Mode, Launch Control functions and  
instrument panel cluster telltales are not enabled or  
disabled by these indicators.  
1. Turn to highlight the RETURN/RET option.  
2. Press and release knob to return to the  
previous menu.  
SCREEN ORDER: While the screen order is  
highlighted, press the knob to allow adjustment. Turn  
the knob to reverse the displayed order of Region A and  
Region B. Press the knob again once the screen is  
chosen.  
4-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press and hold the information and reset buttons at the  
same time for one second, then release the buttons to  
enter the personalization menu. See DIC Vehicle  
Personalization on page 446 for more information.  
Driver Information Center (DIC)  
Your vehicle has a Driver Information Center (DIC).  
The DIC display gives you the status of many of your  
vehicle's systems. The DIC is also used to display  
driver personalization menu modes and warning/status  
messages. All messages will appear in the DIC display,  
located at the bottom of the instrument panel cluster.  
DIC Operation and Displays  
The DIC comes on when the ignition is on. The DIC has  
different modes which can be accessed by pressing the  
DIC buttons. The button functions are detailed in the  
following.  
The DIC buttons are  
located on the left side of  
the steering wheel.  
Information Modes  
INFO (Information): Press this button to scroll through  
the following vehicle information modes:  
Outside Air Temperature and Odometer  
Press the information button until the outside air  
temperature and the odometer display. This mode  
shows the temperature outside of the vehicle in either  
degrees Fahrenheit (°F) or degrees Celsius (°C) and  
the total distance the vehicle has been driven in  
either miles (mi) or kilometers (km). The outside air  
temperature appears on the left side of the DIC display  
and the odometer appears on the right side of the  
display.  
INFO (Information): Press this button to scroll through  
the vehicle information mode displays.  
r (Reset): Press this button to reset some vehicle  
information mode displays, select a personalization  
menu mode setting, or acknowledge a warning  
message.  
To change the DIC display to English or metric units,  
see UNITSunder DIC Vehicle Personalization on  
page 446  
.
4-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TRIPA or TRIP B  
MPG (L/100 KM) AVG (Average)  
Press the information button until TRIPA or TRIP B  
display. These modes show the current distance  
traveled since the last reset for each trip odometer in  
either miles (mi) or kilometers (km). Both odometers  
can be used at the same time.  
Press the information button until MPG (L/100 KM) AVG  
displays. This mode shows how many miles per  
gallon (mpg) or liters per 100 kilometers (L/100 km)  
your vehicle is getting based on current and past  
driving conditions.  
To reset the trip odometer to zero, press and hold the  
reset button for a few seconds while the desired trip  
odometer is displayed.  
To reset the average fuel economy, press and hold the  
reset button while MPG (L/100 KM) AVG is displayed.  
Average fuel economy is then calculated starting from  
that point. If the average fuel economy is not reset, it is  
continually updated each time you drive.  
FUEL RANGE  
Press the information button until FUEL RANGE  
displays. This mode shows the remaining distance  
you can drive without refueling in either miles (mi) or  
kilometers (km). It is based on fuel economy and the  
fuel remaining in the tank.  
MPG (L/100 KM) INST (Instantaneous)  
Press the information button until MPG (L/100 KM) INST  
displays. This mode shows the current fuel economy at  
a particular moment and changes frequently as driving  
conditions change. This mode shows the instantaneous  
fuel economy in miles per gallon (mpg) or liters per  
100 kilometers (L/100 km). Unlike average fuel  
economy, this screen cannot be reset.  
When the fuel level is low, FUEL RANGE LOW  
displays.  
The fuel economy data used to determine fuel range  
is an average of recent driving conditions. As your  
driving conditions change, this data is gradually  
updated. The FUEL RANGE mode cannot be reset.  
AV (Average) SPEED  
Press the information button until AV SPEED displays.  
This mode shows the vehicle's average speed in miles  
per hour (mph) or kilometers per hour (km/h).  
To reset the average vehicle speed, press and hold the  
reset button while AV SPEED is displayed.  
4-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press the information button until LF ## PSI (kPa) ## RF  
displays for the front tires. Press the information button  
again until LR ## PSI (kPa) ## RR displays for the rear  
tires.  
OIL LIFE  
Press the information button until OIL LIFE displays.  
The engine oil life system shows an estimate of the oil's  
remaining useful life. It shows 100% when the system is  
reset after an oil change. It alerts you to change the oil  
on a schedule consistent with your driving conditions.  
If a low tire pressure condition is detected by the  
system while driving, a message advising you to  
check the tire pressure appears in the display.  
See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 666 and  
DIC Warnings and Messages on page 440 for  
more information.  
In addition to the engine oil life system monitoring the  
oil life, additional maintenance is recommended in the  
Maintenance Schedule in this manual. See Engine Oil  
on page 617 and Scheduled Maintenance on  
page 73  
.
DIC Warnings and Messages  
These messages appear if there is a problem detected  
in one of your vehicle's systems.  
Always reset the engine oil life system after an oil  
change. See How to Reset the Engine Oil Life System”  
under Engine Oil Life System on page 621.  
A message clears when the vehicle's condition is no  
longer present. To acknowledge a message and clear it  
from the display, press and hold any of the DIC buttons.  
If the condition is still present, the warning message  
comes back on the next time the vehicle is turned off  
and back on. With most messages, a warning chime  
sounds when the message displays. Your vehicle may  
have other warning messages.  
COOLANT  
Press the information button until COOLANT displays.  
This mode shows the temperature of the engine  
coolant in either degrees Fahrenheit (°F) or degrees  
Celsius (°C).  
Tire Pressure  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure  
AUTO (Automatic) LIGHTS OFF  
Monitoring System (TPMS), the pressure for each tire  
can be viewed in the DIC. The tire pressure is shown in  
either pounds per square inch (psi) or kilopascals (kPa).  
This message displays if the automatic headlamp  
system is disabled with the headlamp switch.  
4-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO (Automatic) LIGHTS ON  
COMPETITIVE MODE  
This message displays if the automatic headlamp  
system is enabled with the headlamp switch.  
If your vehicle has this feature, this message displays  
when the Competitive Driving mode is selected. The  
Traction Control System (TCS) will not be operating  
while in the Competitive Driving mode and the  
ESC/TCS light on the instrument panel cluster will be  
on solid. Adjust your driving accordingly. See Traction  
Control System (TCS) on page 59, Electronic  
Stability Control (ESC) on page 56, and Electronic  
Stability Control (ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS)  
Indicator/Warning Light on page 425 for more  
information.  
BRAKE FLUID  
This message displays, while the ignition is on, when  
the brake fluid level is low. The brake system warning  
light on the instrument panel cluster also comes on.  
See Brake System Warning Light on page 423 for  
more information. Have the brake system serviced by  
your dealer/retailer as soon as possible.  
CHANGE OIL SOON  
COOLING MODE ON  
This message displays when the life of the engine oil  
has expired and it should be changed.  
This message may display on some vehicles. Under  
severe conditions, hot ambient temperatures, steep  
grades, and towing, your vehicle may experience more  
transmission shifting. This is temporary and normal  
under these conditions. This does not require engine  
or transmission service.  
When this message is acknowledged and cleared from  
the display, the engine oil life system must still be reset  
separately. See Engine Oil Life System on page 621  
and Scheduled Maintenance on page 73 for more  
information.  
CRUISE ENGAGED  
CHECK GAS CAP  
This message displays when the cruise control system  
is active. See Cruise Control on page 46 for more  
information.  
This message displays if the fuel cap has not been fully  
tightened. Recheck the fuel cap to make sure that it is  
on properly. A few driving trips with the cap properly  
installed should turn the message off.  
4-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DOOR AJAR  
ESC (Electronic Stability Control) ACTIVE  
This message displays if one or more of the vehicle's  
doors are open. Make sure that the door(s) are closed  
completely.  
If your vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC),  
this message displays and the ESC/TCS light on the  
instrument panel cluster flashes when ESC is assisting  
you with directional control of the vehicle. You may  
feel or hear the system working and see this message  
displayed in the DIC. Slippery road conditions may  
exist when this message is displayed, so adjust your  
driving accordingly. This message may stay on for  
a few seconds after ESC stops assisting you with  
directional control of the vehicle. This is normal  
when the system is operating. See Electronic Stability  
Control (ESC) on page 56 and Electronic Stability  
Control (ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS)  
Indicator/Warning Light on page 425 for more  
information.  
ENGINE DISABLED  
This message displays if the starting of the engine  
is disabled. Have your vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer immediately.  
ENG (Engine) PWR (Power) REDUCED  
This message displays to inform you that the vehicle  
has reduced engine power to avoid damaging the  
engine. Reduced engine power can affect the vehicle's  
ability to accelerate. If this message is on, but there  
is no reduction in performance, proceed to your  
destination. The performance may be reduced the  
next time the vehicle is driven. The vehicle may be  
driven at a reduced speed while this message is on,  
but acceleration and speed may be reduced. Anytime  
this message stays on, the vehicle should be taken to  
your dealer/retailer for service as soon as possible.  
ESC (Electronic Stability Control) NOT  
READY  
If your vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC),  
this message may display briefly after starting the  
vehicle if the system's sensors are not yet calibrated.  
The system is not functional until the message stops  
displaying. Adjust your driving accordingly. When  
the message is no longer displayed, the system is  
functional. See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on  
page 56 for more information.  
4-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ESC (Electronic Stability Control) OFF  
LAUNCH CONTROL  
If your vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC),  
this message displays and the ESC/TCS light on  
the instrument panel cluster comes on solid when  
ESC is turned off. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56  
and Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/Traction Control  
System (TCS) Indicator/Warning Light on page 425 for  
more information.  
If your vehicle has this feature, this message displays  
after the COMPETITIVE MODE message when the  
vehicle is stopped. Launch control is a form of traction  
control to control wheel spin while launching the vehicle  
during closed track events and competitive driving  
venues. The system will exit to COMPETITIVE MODE  
after the vehicle is launched. See COMPETITIVE  
MODEearlier in this section. See Launch Control”  
under Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56  
for more information.  
ICE POSSIBLE  
This message displays when the outside air  
temperature is cold enough to create icy road  
conditions. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
LEARN COMPLETE  
On vehicles without the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
system, this message displays when the Tire Pressure  
Monitor System (TPMS) has completed the tire learning  
process. See Tire Pressure Monitor System on  
page 667 for more information.  
KEY FOB BATT (Battery) LOW  
This message displays if the Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) transmitter battery is low. Replace the battery  
in the transmitter. See Battery Replacementunder  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
LOW COOLANT  
page 34  
.
If your vehicle has a 2.0L engine, this message displays  
when there is a low level of engine coolant. Have the  
cooling system serviced by your dealer/retailer as soon  
as possible. See Engine Coolant on page 629 for  
more information.  
4-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LOW FUEL  
POWER STEERING  
This message displays when your vehicle is low on  
fuel. Refill the fuel tank as soon as possible. See Fuel  
Gauge on page 432, Fuel on page 66, and Filling  
the Tank on page 610 for more information.  
This message displays if a problem has been detected  
with the electric power steering. Have your vehicle  
serviced by your dealer/retailer immediately.  
SERVICE AIR BAG  
LOW TRACTION  
This message displays when there is a problem with  
the airbag system. Have your vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer immediately.  
If your vehicle has the Enhanced Traction System  
(ETS) or Traction Control System (TCS), this message  
displays and the ETS light or the ESC/TCS light on the  
instrument panel cluster flashes when the system is  
actively limiting wheel spin. Slippery road conditions  
may exist if this message is displayed, so adjust your  
driving accordingly. This message stays on for a few  
seconds after the system stops limiting wheel spin.  
See Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on page 512  
or Traction Control System (TCS) on page 59 and  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 425 or Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 425 for more information.  
SERVICE ESC (ELECTRONIC STABILITY  
CONTROL)  
If your vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC),  
this message displays and a chime sounds if there has  
been a problem detected with ESC. The ESC/TCS light  
also appears on the instrument panel cluster. This light  
stays on solid as long as the detected problem remains  
present. When this message displays, the system is not  
working. Adjust your driving accordingly. See Electronic  
Stability Control (ESC) on page 56 and Electronic  
Stability Control (ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS)  
Indicator/Warning Light on page 425 for more  
information.  
PARKING BRAKE  
This message displays if the parking brake is left  
engaged. See Parking Brake on page 331 for more  
information.  
4-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If this message turns on while you are driving, pull off  
the road as soon as possible and stop carefully. Try  
resetting the system by turning the ignition off and then  
back on. If this message still stays on or turns back on  
again while you are driving, your vehicle needs service.  
Have the ESC inspected by your dealer/retailer as soon  
as possible.  
SVC (Service) BRAKE SYSTEM  
This message may display if you have a turbocharged  
vehicle with Electronic Stability Control (ESC) and if  
the hydraulic brake boost is not working or is working  
improperly. Have the brake system serviced by your  
dealer/retailer as soon as possible.  
SVC (Service) TIRE MONITOR  
SERVICE TRACTION  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure  
Monitoring System (TPMS), this message displays if  
a part on the TPMS is not working properly. The tire  
pressure light also flashes and then remains on during  
the same ignition cycle. See Tire Pressure Light on  
page 427. Several conditions may cause this message  
to appear. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on  
page 668 for more information. If the warning comes  
on and stays on, there may be a problem with the  
TPMS. See your dealer/retailer.  
If your vehicle has the Enhanced Traction System  
(ETS) or Traction Control System (TCS), this message  
displays and a chime sounds when the system is not  
functioning properly. The ETS light or the ESC/TCS light  
also appears on the instrument panel cluster. This light  
stays on solid as long as the detected problem remains  
present. When this message displays, the system is not  
working. Adjust your driving accordingly. See Enhanced  
Traction System (ETS) on page 512 or Traction  
Control System (TCS) on page 59 and Enhanced  
Traction System (ETS) Indicator/Warning Light on  
page 425 or Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/Traction  
Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning Light on  
page 425 for more information. Have the system  
serviced by your dealer/retailer as soon as possible.  
4-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TIRE LEARN ON  
TRACTION OFF  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure  
If your vehicle has the Enhanced Traction System  
(ETS) or Traction Control System (TCS), this message  
displays and the ETS light or the ESC/TCS light on  
the instrument panel cluster comes on solid when the  
system is turned off. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
See Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on page 512  
or Traction Control System (TCS) on page 59 and  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 425 or Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 425 for more information.  
Monitoring System (TPMS) and does not have the  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system, this message  
displays when the TPMS is re-learning the tire positions  
on your vehicle. The tire positions must be re-learned  
after rotating the tires or after replacing a tire or sensor.  
See Tire Inspection and Rotation on page 673  
,
Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 667, and  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 666 for more  
information.  
TIRE LOW ADD AIR  
TRUNK AJAR  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure  
Monitoring System (TPMS), this message displays  
when the pressure in one or more of the vehicle's tires  
is low. The low tire pressure warning light will also come  
on. See Tire Pressure Light on page 427. If a tire  
pressure message appears on the DIC, stop as soon  
as you can. Have the tire pressures checked and set  
to those shown on the Tire Loading Information label.  
See Tires on page 657, Loading the Vehicle on  
This message displays when the trunk is not closed  
completely. Make sure that the trunk is closed  
completely. See Trunk on page 312.  
DIC Vehicle Personalization  
Your vehicle has personalization capabilities that allow  
you to program certain features to a preferred setting.  
All of the features listed may not be available on your  
vehicle. Only the features available will be displayed on  
the DIC.  
page 525, and Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 666  
.
The DIC also shows the tire pressure values. See DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 438  
.
4-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The default settings for the features were set when your  
vehicle left the factory, but may have been changed  
from their default state since that time.  
Personalization Menu Modes  
OIL LIFE RESET  
To change feature settings, use the following procedure:  
When this feature is displayed, you can reset the  
engine oil life system. To reset the system, see Engine  
Oil Life System on page 621. See OIL LIFEunder  
DIC Operation and Displays on page 438 for more  
information.  
Entering Personalization Menu  
1. Turn the ignition on while the vehicle is stopped.  
To avoid excessive drain on the battery, it is  
recommended that the headlamps are turned off.  
UNITS  
2. Press and hold the information and reset buttons at  
the same time for one second, then release to  
enter the personalization menu.  
This feature allows you to select the units of  
measurement in which the DIC will display the vehicle  
information. When UNITS appears on the display, press  
and hold the reset button for at least one second to  
scroll through the available settings:  
If the vehicle speed is greater than 3 km/h (2 mph),  
only the UNITS menu will be accessible.  
ENGLISH (default in United States): All information  
will be displayed in English units.  
3. Press the information button to scroll through the  
available personalization menu modes.  
Press the reset button to scroll through the  
available settings for each mode.  
METRIC (default in Canada): All information will be  
displayed in metric units.  
If you do not make a selection within ten seconds,  
the display will go back to the previous information  
displayed.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TIRE LEARN?  
LOCK HORN  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure  
Monitoring System (TPMS), this mode is available on  
vehicles without the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
system. After rotating the tires or after replacing a tire  
or sensor, the TPMS must re-learn the tire positions.  
To re-learn the tire positions, see Tire Pressure Monitor  
System on page 667. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 673 and DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 440 for more information.  
If your vehicle has Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), this  
feature, which allows the vehicle's horn to chirp every  
time the lock button on the RKE transmitter is pressed,  
can be enabled or disabled. When LOCK HORN  
appears on the display, press and hold the reset button  
for at least one second to scroll through the available  
settings:  
OFF (default): The horn will not chirp on the first press  
of the lock button on the RKE transmitter. The horn will  
still chirp on the second press.  
REMOTE START  
ON: The horn will chirp on the first press of the lock  
button on the RKE transmitter.  
If your vehicle has remote start, this feature allows  
remote start to be turned off or on. Remote start allows  
you to start the engine from outside of the vehicle using  
your Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. When  
REMOTE START appears on the display, press and  
hold the reset button for at least one second to scroll  
through the available settings:  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34 for more information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
OFF: The remote start feature will be disabled.  
ON (default): The remote start feature will be enabled.  
See Remote Vehicle Start on page 36 for more  
information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNLOCK HORN  
LIGHT FLASH  
If your vehicle has Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), this  
feature, which allows the vehicle's horn to chirp on the  
first press of the unlock button on the RKE transmitter,  
can be enabled or disabled. When UNLOCK HORN  
appears on the display, press and hold the reset button  
for at least one second to scroll through the available  
settings:  
If your vehicle has Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), this  
feature, which allows the vehicle's exterior hazard/turn  
signal lighting to flash every time the lock, unlock,  
or trunk release buttons on the RKE transmitter are  
pressed, can be enabled or disabled. When LIGHT  
FLASH appears on the display, press and hold the reset  
button for at least one second to scroll through the  
available settings:  
OFF (default): The horn will not chirp when the unlock  
button on the RKE transmitter is pressed.  
OFF: The exterior hazard/turn signal lighting will not  
flash when the lock, unlock, or trunk release buttons on  
the RKE transmitter are pressed.  
ON: The horn will chirp on the first press of the unlock  
button on the RKE transmitter.  
ON (default): The exterior hazard/turn signal lighting  
will flash when the lock, unlock, or trunk release buttons  
on the RKE transmitter are pressed.  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34 for more information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34 for more information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DELAY LOCK  
AUTO UNLK (Unlock)  
This feature, which delays the actual locking of the  
vehicle, can be enabled or disabled. When DELAY  
LOCK appears on the display, press and hold the reset  
button for at least one second to scroll through the  
available settings:  
This feature, which allows the vehicle to automatically  
unlock certain doors, can be enabled or disabled. When  
AUTO UNLK appears on the display, press and hold the  
reset button for at least one second to scroll through the  
available settings:  
ON (default): The doors will not lock until five seconds  
after the last door is closed. You can temporarily  
override delayed locking by pressing the power lock  
switch or the lock button on the Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) transmitter a second time.  
ALL (default): All of the doors will automatically unlock.  
DRIVER: The driver's door will automatically unlock.  
NONE: None of the doors will automatically unlock.  
You will need to manually unlock the doors.  
If you have a manual transmission vehicle, the door(s)  
will automatically unlock when the ignition is turned off.  
OFF: The doors will lock immediately when pressing  
the power lock switch or the lock button on the RKE  
transmitter.  
If you have an automatic transmission vehicle, you  
can select when the automatic unlocking will occur.  
See UNLK (Unlock) (Automatic Transmission Only)”  
following.  
See Power Door Locks on page 39, Delayed Locking  
on page 310, and Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
System Operation on page 34 for more information.  
See Programmable Automatic Door Unlock on  
page 310 for more information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNLK (Unlock) (Automatic  
Transmission Only)  
EXT (Exterior) LIGHTS  
If your vehicle has Remote Keyless Entry (RKE), this  
feature, which allows the vehicle's exterior perimeter  
lighting to turn on each time the unlock button on the  
RKE transmitter is pressed, can be enabled or disabled.  
When EXT LIGHTS appears on the display, press and  
hold the reset button for at least one second to scroll  
through the available settings:  
This screen displays only if your vehicle has an  
automatic transmission and DRIVER or ALL is selected  
for the AUTO UNLK feature. This feature determines  
when the automatic door unlocking will occur. When  
UNLK appears on the display, press and hold the reset  
button for at least one second to scroll through the  
available settings:  
OFF: The exterior perimeter lighting will not turn on  
when the unlock button on the RKE transmitter is  
pressed.  
KEY OFF: The door(s) will unlock when the key is  
turned off.  
ON (default): The exterior perimeter lighting will turn  
on when the unlock button on the RKE transmitter is  
pressed.  
SHIFT TO P (Park) (default): The door(s) will unlock  
when the vehicle is shifted into P (Park).  
See Programmable Automatic Door Unlock on  
page 310 for more information.  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34 for more information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LANGUAGE  
Audio System(s)  
Determine which radio the vehicle has and read the  
following pages to become familiar with its features.  
This feature allows you to select the language in which  
the DIC will display. When LANGUAGE appears on the  
display, press and hold the reset button for at least  
one second to scroll through the available settings:  
WARNING:  
{
ENGLISH (default): All messages will appear in  
English.  
FRENCH: All messages will appear in French.  
SPANISH: All messages will appear in Spanish.  
GERMAN: All messages will appear in German.  
Taking your eyes off the road for extended periods  
could cause a crash resulting in injury or death to  
you or others. Do not give extended attention to  
entertainment tasks while driving.  
To select a setting and exit out of the personalization  
menu mode, press the information button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
This system provides access to many audio and non  
audio listings.  
Exiting Personalization Menu  
The personalization menu will be exited when any of  
the following conditions occur:  
To minimize taking your eyes off the road while driving,  
do the following while the vehicle is parked:  
.
Become familiar with the operation and controls of  
the audio system.  
.
A ten second time period has elapsed.  
.
Set up the tone, speaker adjustments, and preset  
.
The ignition is turned off.  
radio stations.  
.
The end of the personalization menu list is  
For more information, see Defensive Driving on  
reached.  
page 52  
.
4-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Contact your dealer/retailer before adding  
any equipment.  
Setting the Clock  
Without Date Display  
Adding audio or communication equipment could  
interfere with the operation of the vehicle's engine,  
radio, or other systems, and could damage them.  
Follow federal rules covering mobile radio and  
telephone equipment.  
AM/FM Base Radio with a Single CD Player  
To set the time:  
1. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or  
Notice: The chime signals related to safety belts,  
parking brake, and other functions of your vehicle  
operate through the radio/entertainment system.  
If that equipment is replaced or additional  
equipment is added to your vehicle, the chimes  
may not work. Make sure that replacement or  
additional equipment is compatible with your  
vehicle before installing it. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 64.  
ON/RUN. Press O to turn the radio on.  
2. Press H until the hour begins flashing on the  
display. Press H a second time and the minute  
begins flashing on the display.  
3. While either the hour or the minute numbers are  
flashing, turn f to increase or decrease the time.  
4. Press H again until the clock display stops flashing  
to set the currently displayed time; otherwise, the  
flashing stops after five seconds and the current  
time displayed is automatically set.  
The vehicle has Retained Accessory Power (RAP). With  
RAP, the audio system can be played even after the  
ignition is turned off. See Retained Accessory Power  
(RAP) on page 323 for more information.  
To change the time default setting from 12 hour to  
24 hour, press the H button until 12H or 24H is  
displayed. Once 12H or 24H is displayed, turn  
the f knob to the desired option to select the setting.  
Press the H button again to apply the setting, or let the  
screen time out.  
4-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The date does not automatically display. To see the  
With Date Display  
date press H while the radio is on. The date with  
display times out after a few seconds and goes back  
to the normal radio and time display.  
Radio with CD (MP3) and USB Port, and  
Radio with Single CD (MP3) Player  
To set the time and date:  
To change the time default setting from 12 hour to  
24 hour or to change the date default setting from  
month/day/year to day/month/year:  
1. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or  
ON/RUN. Press O to turn the radio on.  
1. Press H and then the softkey located below the  
forward arrow label. Once the time 12H and 24H,  
and the date MM/DD/YYYY (month, day, and year)  
and DD/MM/YYYY (day, month, and year) displays.  
2. Press H and the HR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY  
(hour, minute, month, day, and year) displays.  
3. Press the softkey located below any one of the  
tabs that you want to change.  
2. Press the softkey located below the desired option.  
4. To increase the time or date do one of the  
following:  
3. Press H again to apply the selected default, or let  
the screen time out.  
.
Press the softkey located below the  
selected tab.  
.
Press ¨ SEEK, or \ FWD.  
.
Turn f clockwise.  
5. To decrease the time or date do one of the  
following:  
.
Press © SEEK or s REV.  
.
Turn f counterclockwise.  
4-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio(s)  
Radio with CD (MP3) and USB Port shown, Radio  
with CD (MP3) similar  
Radio with CD (Base)  
The vehicle has one of these radios as its audio  
system.  
Radio Data System (RDS)  
The radio may have RDS. The RDS feature is  
available for use only on FM stations that broadcast  
RDS information. This system relies upon receiving  
specific information from these stations and only  
works when the information is available.  
4-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
While the radio is tuned to an FM-RDS station, the  
station name or call letters display. In rare cases, a  
radio station could broadcast incorrect information that  
causes the radio features to work improperly. If this  
happens, contact the radio station.  
Finding a Station  
BAND: Press to choose between FM1, FM2, AM,  
or XM(if equipped) on the Radio with CD (Base).  
Press to choose between FM, AM, XM (if equipped) on  
the Radio with CD (MP3) and USB Port or the Radio  
with CD (MP3).  
Playing the Radio  
f (Tune): Turn to select radio stations.  
O (Power/Volume): Press to turn the system on and  
off. Turn to increase or decrease the volume.  
© SEEK: Press to seek or scan stations with a strong  
signal in the selected band.  
Speed Compensated Volume (SCV): Radios with  
the Speed Compensated Volume (SCV) feature  
automatically adjust the radio volume to compensate  
for road and wind noise as the vehicle speeds up or  
slows down, so that the volume level is consistent.  
.
To seek stations, press and release © SEEK to  
go to the previous station and stay there.  
.
To scan stations, press and hold © SEEK for a  
few seconds until the radio beeps once. The radio  
goes to a station, plays for a few seconds, then  
To activate SCV:  
1. Set the radio volume to the desired level.  
2. Press MENU to display the radio setup menu.  
goes to the next station. Press © SEEK again to  
stop scanning.  
3. Press the softkey under the AUTO VOLUM tab on  
the radio display.  
.
To scan preset stations in the selected band, press  
and hold © SEEK for four seconds until a double  
beep sounds. The radio goes to a stored preset,  
plays for a few seconds, then goes to the next  
4. Press the softkey under the desired Speed  
Compensated Volume setting (OFF, Low, Med,  
or High) to select the level of radio volume  
compensation. The display times out after  
approximately 10 seconds. Each higher setting  
allows for more radio volume compensation at  
faster vehicle speeds.  
stored preset. Press © SEEK again to stop  
scanning preset stations.  
4-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
line of the display while the artist information will be  
displayed on the bottom line, it the information is  
available during XM, CD, MP3, or WMA playback.  
When information is not available, No Infodisplays.  
¨ SEEK: Press to seek or scan stations with a strong  
signal in the selected band.  
.
To seek stations, press and release ¨ SEEK to  
go to the next station and stay there.  
Storing Radio Stations  
Depending on which radio the vehicle has, radio  
stations are stored as either favorites or presets.  
.
To scan stations, press and hold ¨ SEEK for a  
few seconds until the radio beeps once. The radio  
goes to a station, plays for a few seconds, then  
goes to the next station. Press ¨ SEEK again to  
Storing a Radio Station as a Favorite  
stop scanning.  
Radio that have a FAV button store radio stations as  
favorites.  
.
To scan preset stations in the selected band, press  
and hold ¨ SEEK for four seconds until a double  
beep sounds. The radio goes to a stored preset,  
plays for a few seconds, then goes to the next  
Drivers are encouraged to set up radio station favorites  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). Tune to favorite stations  
using the softkeys, favorites button, and steering wheel  
controls. See Defensive Driving on page 52.  
stored preset. Press ¨ SEEK again to stop  
scanning preset stations.  
FAV (Favorites): A maximum of 36 stations can be  
stored as favorites using the six softkeys located below  
the radio station frequency tabs and by using the radio  
favorites page button (FAV button). Press FAV to go  
through up to six pages of favorites, each having  
six favorite stations available per page. Each page of  
favorites can contain any combination of AM, FM, or  
XM stations. The current balance/fade and tone settings  
are also stored with the favorite stations.  
4 (Information): For vehicles with the Radio with CD  
(Base), press to switch the display between the radio  
station frequency and the time. While the ignition is off,  
press 4 to display the time.  
For vehicles with XM, MP3, WMA, or RDS features,  
press 4 to display additional text information related to  
the current FM-RDS or XM station; or CD, MP3, WMA  
song. Song title information will be displayed on the top  
4-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To store a station as a favorite:  
Auto Text (Satellite Radio Service, CD, MP3, and  
WMA features): If additional information is available  
for the current song being played, Auto Text will  
automatically page/scroll the information every  
three seconds above the FAV presets on the radio  
display. By default, Auto Text is enabled.  
1. Tune to the desired radio station and set the  
balance/fade and tone settings to the desired  
levels.  
2. Press FAV to display the page where to store the  
station.  
To change the Auto Text setting:  
3. Press and hold one of the six softkeys until a beep  
sounds.  
1. Press MENU to display the radio setup menu.  
2. Press the softkey under AUTO TXT tab on the  
radio display.  
4. Repeat the steps for each radio station to be  
stored as a favorite.  
3. Press the softkey under the ON or OFF tab on the  
radio display.  
To setup the number of favorites pages:  
1. Press MENU to display the radio setup menu.  
2. Press the softkey located below the FAV 1-6 tab.  
If 4 is pressed and the song title or artist information is  
longer than what can be displayed, the extra information  
will page every three seconds when Auto Text is  
activated.  
3. Select the desired number of favorites pages by  
pressing the softkey located below the displayed  
page numbers.  
4. Press FAV, or let the menu time out, to return to  
the original main radio screen showing the radio  
station frequency tabs and to begin programming  
favorites.  
4-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To adjust the tone settings on the Radio with CD (MP3)  
and USB Port or the Radio with CD (MP3):  
Storing a Radio Station as a Preset  
Radios that have numbered pushbuttons store radio  
stations as presets.  
1. Press f until the tone control tabs display.  
Up to 18 stations (six FM1, six FM2, and six AM), can  
be programmed on the six numbered buttons.  
2. Press the softkey below the desired tab to be  
adjusted.  
3. To increase the level of the bass, midrange,  
or treble:  
To store preset stations:  
1. Tune in the desired station.  
.
Press ¨ SEEK, or \ FWD.  
2. Press and hold one of the six numbered buttons  
for three seconds until a beep sounds.  
.
Turn f clockwise.  
3. Repeat the Steps 1 and 2 for each numbered  
button.  
4. To decrease the level of the bass, midrange,  
or treble:  
Setting the Tone (Bass/Midrange/Treble)  
.
Press © SEEK, or s REV.  
BASS/MID/TREB (Bass, Midrange, or Treble): The  
radio may display some or all tones such as BASS,  
MID, and TREB.  
.
Turn f counterclockwise.  
The radio may be capable of adjusting bass, midrange,  
or treble to the middle position by pressing the softkey  
below the BASS, MID, or TREB tab for more than  
two seconds. The radio beeps once and the level  
adjusts to the middle position.  
To adjust the tone settings on the Radio with  
CD (Base):  
Press f until the tone control labels display, then  
turn f to change the setting.  
The radio may also be capable of adjusting all  
tone and speaker controls to the middle position by  
pressing f for more than two seconds until the radio  
beeps once.  
If a station's frequency is weak, or has static, decrease  
the treble.  
4-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EQ (Equalization): Press this button to select preset  
equalization settings.  
To adjust balance or fade using `:  
1. Press ` until the speaker control labels display.  
To return to the manual mode, press EQ until Manual  
displays or start to manually adjust the bass, midrange,  
2. Continue pressing ` until the desired speaker  
or treble by pressing f.  
control label displays.  
3. Turn f to adjust the setting. The setting can also  
be adjusted by pressing either SEEK arrow,  
\ FWD, or s REV.  
The radio may be capable of adjusting balance or fade  
to the middle position by pressing the softkey below the  
BAL or FADE tab for more than two seconds. The radio  
beeps once and the level adjusts to the middle position.  
Adjusting the Speakers (Balance/Fade)  
Depending on which radio the vehicle has, the  
Balance/Fade can be adjusted using f or `.  
To adjust balance or fade using f:  
1. Press f until the speaker control tabs display.  
2. Press the softkey under the desired tab,  
The radio may also be capable of adjusting all tone  
and speaker controls to the middle position by  
or continue pressing f to highlight the desired tab.  
pressing f for more than two seconds until the radio  
beeps once.  
3. Turn f to adjust the highlighted setting.  
The highlighted setting can also be adjusted  
by pressing either SEEK arrow.  
On some radios, \ FWD and s REV can also  
be used to adjust the highlighted level.  
4-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Undesired XM categories can be removed through the  
setup menu. To remove an undesired category:  
Finding a Category (CAT) Station  
(XM Satellite Radio Service Only)  
CAT (Category): The radio may have the CAT button  
feature.  
1. Press MENU to display the radio setup menu.  
2. Press the softkey below the XM CAT tab.  
3. Turn f to display the category to be removed.  
To select and find a desired category:  
4. Press the softkey below the Remove tab until the  
category name along with the word Removed  
displays.  
1. Press BAND until the XM frequency displays.  
2. Press CAT to display the category tabs on the  
radio display. Continue pressing the CAT button  
until the desired category name displays.  
5. Repeat the steps to remove additional categories.  
3. Press either of the two softkeys below the desired  
category tab to immediately tune to the first XM  
station associated with that category.  
Removed categories can be restored by pressing the  
softkey under the Add tab when a removed category  
displays or by pressing the softkey below the Restore  
All tab.  
4. To go to the previous or to the next XM station  
within the selected category, do one of the  
following:  
Categories cannot be removed or added while the  
vehicle is moving faster than 5 mph (8 km/h).  
.
Turn f.  
Radio Messages  
Calibration Error: Displays if the radio is no longer  
calibrated properly for the vehicle. The vehicle must be  
returned to your dealer/retailer for service.  
Loc or Locked: Displays when the THEFTLOCK®  
system has activated. Take the vehicle to your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
.
Press the softkeys below the right or left arrows  
on the radio display.  
.
Press © SEEK or ¨ SEEK.  
5. To exit the category search mode, press the FAV  
button or BAND button to display the favorites  
again.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be  
corrected, contact your dealer/retailer.  
4-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM Satellite Radio Service  
Ejecting a CD  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM Satellite Radio has a wide variety  
of programming and commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound. A service  
fee is required to receive the XM service. For more  
information, contact XM at www.xmradio.com or call  
1-800-929-2100 in the U.S. and www.xmradio.ca or  
call 1-877-438-9677 in Canada.  
Z EJECT: Press to eject the CD. If the CD is not  
removed, after several seconds, the CD automatically  
pulls back into the player.  
Playing a CD  
If the ignition or radio is turned off with a CD in the  
player it stays in the player. When the ignition or radio  
is turned on, the CD starts to play where it stopped, if it  
was the last selected audio source.  
Radio Messages for XM Only  
f (Tune): Turn to select tracks on the CD currently  
playing.  
See XM Radio Messages on page 472 for more  
© SEEK: Press to go to the start of the current track,  
if more than ten seconds have played. Press and hold  
or press multiple times to continue moving backward  
through the tracks on the CD.  
information.  
Loading a CD  
Insert a CD partway into the slot, label side up.  
The player pulls it in and the CD begins playing.  
¨ SEEK: Press to go to the next track. Press and  
hold or press multiple times to continue moving forward  
through the tracks on the CD.  
When the CD is inserted, the CD symbol displays. As  
each new track starts to play, the track number displays.  
s REV (Reverse): Press and hold to reverse  
playback quickly within a track. Sound is heard at a  
reduced volume and the elapsed time of the track  
displays. Release to resume playing the track.  
The CD player can play the smaller 3 inch (8 cm)  
single CDs with an adapter ring. Full-size CDs and  
the smaller CDs are loaded in the same manner.  
4-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance  
playback quickly within a track. Sound is heard at a  
reduced volume and the elapsed time of the track  
displays. Release to resume playing the track.  
CD Messages  
CHECK DISC: If an error message displays and/or the  
CD comes out, it could be for one of the following  
reasons:  
RDM (Random): Tracks can be listened to in random,  
rather than sequential order.  
.
The CD player is very hot. When the temperature  
returns to normal, the CD should play.  
To use random:  
.
The road is very rough. When the road becomes  
1. Press the softkey below RDM tab until Random  
Current Disc displays.  
smoother, the CD should play.  
.
The CD is dirty, scratched, wet, or upside down.  
2. Press the softkey again to turn off random play.  
.
The air is very humid. If so, wait about an hour and  
try again.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio while a CD is  
playing. The CD remains inside the radio for future  
listening.  
.
A problem may have occurred while burning  
the CD.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to play a CD while  
listening to the radio. The CD icon and a message  
showing the track number displays when a CD is in  
the player. Press this button again and the system  
automatically searches for an auxiliary input device,  
such as a portable audio player. If a portable audio  
player is not connected, No Aux Input Device Found  
may display.  
.
The label could be caught in the CD player.  
If the CD is not playing correctly, for any other reason,  
try a known good CD.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be  
corrected, contact your dealer/retailer. If the radio  
displays an error message, write it down and provide it  
to your dealer/retailer when reporting the problem.  
Playing an MP3 CD-R or CD-RW Disc  
The radio may have the ability to play an MP3 CD-R or  
CD-RW disc. See Using an MP3 on page 466 for  
more information.  
4-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If a label is added to a CD, or more than  
one CD is inserted into the slot at a time, or an  
attempt is made to play scratched or damaged CDs,  
the CD player could be damaged. While using the  
CD player, use only CDs in good condition without  
any label, load one CD at a time, and keep the  
CD player and the loading slot free of foreign  
materials, liquids, and debris.  
Care of CDs  
Store CD(s) in their original cases or other protective  
cases and away from direct sunlight and dust. The CD  
player scans the bottom of the disc. If the bottom of a  
CD is damaged it may not play properly or at all. Do not  
touch the bottom of a CD while handling it. Pick up CDs  
by grasping the outer edges or the edge of the hole and  
the outer edge.  
If an error displays, see CD Messagesearlier in this  
section.  
If the surface of a CD is dirty, take a soft, lint free  
cloth or dampen a clean, soft cloth in a mild, neutral  
detergent solution mixed with water, and clean it. Make  
sure the wiping process starts from the center to  
the edge.  
Using the Auxiliary Input Jack  
The radio system may have an auxiliary input jack  
located on the lower right side of the faceplate. This is  
not an audio output; do not plug the headphone set into  
the front auxiliary input jack. An external audio device  
such as an iPod®, laptop computer, MP3 player,  
CD changer, etc. can be connected to the auxiliary  
input jack for use as another audio source.  
Care of the CD Player  
Do not add labels to a CD, it could get caught in the  
CD player. Use a marking pen to write on the top of the  
CD if a description is needed.  
Do not use CD lens cleaners, they could damage the  
CD player.  
Drivers are encouraged to set up any auxiliary device  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). See Defensive Driving  
on page 52 for more information on driver distraction.  
4-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To use a portable audio player, connect a 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) cable to the radio's front auxiliary input jack.  
When a device is connected, press the radio CD/AUX  
button to begin playing audio from the device over the  
vehicle speakers.  
USB Support  
The USB connector is located on the front of the radio  
and uses the USB 2.0 standard.  
USB Supported Devices  
O (Power/Volume): Turn to adjust the volume.  
Additional volume adjustments may have to be made  
from the portable device if the volume is too quiet or  
not loud.  
.
USB Flash Drives  
.
Portable USB Hard Drives  
.
Fifth generation or later iPod  
.
BAND: Press to listen to the radio while a portable  
audio device is connected to the auxiliary input.  
The portable audio device continues playing until  
it is stopped or turned off.  
iPod nano  
.
iPod touch  
.
iPod classic  
Not all iPods and USB Drives are compatible with the  
USB port.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to play a CD while a  
portable audio device is connected to the auxiliary  
input. Press again and the system begins playing audio  
from the connected portable audio player. If a portable  
audio player is not connected, No Aux Input Device  
may display.  
Make sure the iPod has the latest firmware from  
Apple® for proper operation. iPod firmware can be  
updated using the latest iTunes® application.  
See www.apple.com/itunes.  
For help with identifying your iPod, go to  
www.apple.com/support.  
Using the USB Port  
Radio's with a USB port can control a USB storage  
device or an iPod® using the radio buttons and knobs.  
See Using an MP3 on page 466 for information about  
how to connect and control a USB storage device or  
an iPod.  
4-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USB Supported File and Folder Structure  
Using an MP3  
Format  
The radio supports:  
.
Up to 700 folders.  
Radios that have the capability of playing MP3's can  
play.mp3 or .wma files that were recorded onto a CD-R  
or CD-RW disc. Radios that have a USB port can  
play.mp3 and .wma files that are stored on a USB  
storage device as well as AAC files that are stored on  
an iPod®.  
.
Up to 8 folders in depth.  
.
Up to 65,535 files.  
.
Folder and file names up to 64 bytes.  
.
Files with an .mp3 or .wma file extension.  
.
AAC files stored on an iPod.  
Compressed Audio  
.
FAT16  
The radio can play discs that contain both  
.
FAT32  
uncompressed CD audio and MP3 files. If both  
formats are on the disc, the radio reads all MP3 files  
first, then the uncompressed CD audio files.  
Root Directory  
The root directory is treated as a folder. Files are stored  
in the root directory when the disc or storage device  
does not contain folders. Files accessed from the root  
directory of a CD display as F1 ROOT.  
CDR or CDRW Supported File and Folder  
Structure  
The radio supports:  
.
Empty Folder  
Up to 50 folders.  
.
Folders that do not contain files are skipped, and the  
player advances to the next folder that contains files.  
Up to 8 folders in depth.  
.
Up to 50 playlists.  
.
Up to 255 files.  
.
Playlists with an .m3u or .wpl extension.  
.
Files with an .mp3, .wma, or .cda file extension.  
4-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Order of Play  
Preprogrammed Playlists  
Tracks are played in the following order:  
CDs that have preprogrammed playlists that were  
created using WinAmp, MusicMatch, or Real  
Jukeboxsoftware can be accessed, however, there  
is no playlist editing capability using the radio. These  
playlists are treated as special folders containing  
compressed audio song files.  
.
Play begins from the first track in the first playlist  
and continues sequentially through all tracks in  
each playlist. When the last track of the last playlist  
has played, play continues from the first track of  
the first playlist.  
Playlists that have an .m3u or .pls file extension and are  
stored on a USB device may be supported by the radio  
with a USB port.  
.
Play begins from the first track in the first folder  
and continues sequentially through all tracks in  
each folder. When the last track of the last folder  
has played, play continues from the first track of  
the first folder.  
Playing a CD-R or CD-RW MP3  
f (Tune): Turn to select MP3 files on the CD currently  
When play enters a new folder, the display does not  
automatically show the new folder name unless the  
folder mode has been chosen as the default display.  
The new track name displays.  
playing.  
© SEEK: Press to go to the start of the track, if more  
than ten seconds have played. Press and hold or press  
multiple times to continue moving backward through  
tracks.  
File System and Naming  
The song name that displays is the song name that  
is contained in the ID3 tag. If the song name is not  
present in the ID3 tag, then the radio displays the file  
name without the extension (such as .mp3) as the  
track name.  
¨ SEEK: Press to go to the next track. Press and hold  
or press multiple times to continue moving forward  
through tracks.  
s REV (Reverse): Press and hold to reverse  
playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced  
volume and the elapsed time of the file displays.  
Track names longer than 32 characters or four pages  
are shortened. The display does not show parts of  
words on the last page of text and the extension of the  
filename is not displayed.  
Release s REV to resume playing.  
4-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the scan is finished, the disc begins playing files  
in order by artist. The current artist playing is shown on  
the second line of the display. Once all songs by that  
artist are played, the player moves to the next artist in  
alphabetical order and begins playing files by that artist.  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance  
playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced  
volume and the elapsed time of the file displays.  
Release \ FWD to resume playing. The elapsed  
time of the file displays.  
To listen to files by another artist, press the softkey  
located below either arrow tab. The disc goes to the  
next or previous artist in alphabetical order. Continue  
pressing either softkey below the arrow tab until the  
desired artist displays.  
S c (Previous Folder): Press the softkey  
below S c to go to the first track in the previous  
folder.  
c T (Next Folder): Press the softkey below c T to  
go to the first track in the next folder.  
To change from playback by artist to playback by  
album:  
RDM (Random): MP3 files can be listened to on a CD  
in random, rather than sequential order. To use random,  
press the softkey under the RDM tab until Random  
Current Disc displays to play songs from the current CD  
in random order. Press the same softkey again to turn  
off random play.  
1. Press the softkey located below the Sort By tab.  
2. Press one of the softkeys below the album tab  
from the sort screen.  
3. Press the softkey below the back tab to return to  
the main music navigator screen.  
h (Music Navigator): Press the softkey  
The album name displays on the second line between  
the arrows and songs from the current album begins to  
play. Once all songs from that album have played, the  
player moves to the next album in alphabetical order on  
the CD and begins playing MP3 files from that album.  
below h to have the files played in order by  
artist or album. The player scans the disc to sort  
the files by artist and album ID3 tag information. It can  
take several minutes to scan the disc depending on the  
number of files on the disc. The radio may begin playing  
while it is scanning in the background.  
To exit music navigator mode, press the softkey below  
the Back tab to return to normal MP3 playback.  
4-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting a USB Storage Device  
or iPod®  
Using the Radio to Control a USB  
Storage Device or iPod  
The USB Port can be used to control an iPod or a USB  
storage device.  
The radio can control a USB storage device or an iPod  
using the radio buttons and knobs and display song  
information on the radios display.  
To connect a USB storage device, connect the device to  
the USB port located on the front of the radio.  
f (Tune): Turn to select files.  
To connect an iPod, connect one end of the USB cable  
that came with the iPod to the iPods dock connector  
and connect the other end to the USB port located on  
the front of the radio. If the vehicle is on and the USB  
connection works, OK to disconnectand a GM logo  
may appear on the iPod and iPod appears on the  
radio's display. The iPod music appears on the radios  
display and begins playing.  
© SEEK: Press to go to the start of the track, if more  
than ten seconds have played. Press and hold or press  
multiple times to continue moving backward through  
tracks.  
¨ SEEK: Press to go to the next track. Press and hold  
or press multiple times to continue moving forward  
through tracks.  
s REV (Reverse): Press and hold to reverse  
The iPod charges while it is connected to the vehicle if  
the vehicle is in the ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN  
position. When the vehicle is turned off, the iPod  
automatically powers off and will not charge or draw  
power from the vehicle's battery.  
playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced volume.  
Release s REV to resume playing. The elapsed time  
of the file displays.  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance  
playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced volume.  
If you have an older iPod model that is not supported, it  
can still be used by connecting it to the Auxiliary Input  
Jack using a standard 3.5 mm (1/8 in) stereo cable.  
See Using the Auxiliary Input Jackearlier for more  
information.  
Release \ FWD to resume playing. The elapsed time  
of the file displays.  
4 (Information): Press to display additional information  
about the selected track.  
4-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Softkeys to Control a USB  
Storage Device or iPod  
The five softkeys below the radio display are used to  
control the functions listed below.  
c (Folder View): Press the softkey below c to view  
the contents of the current folder on the USB drive.  
To browse and select files:  
1. Press the softkey below c.  
To use the softkeys:  
2. Turn f to scroll through the list of folders.  
1. Press the first or fifth softkey below the radio  
display to display the functions listed below,  
or press the softkey below the function if it is  
currently displayed.  
3. Press f to select the desired folder. If there is  
more then one folder, repeat Steps 1 and 2 until  
the desired folder is reached.  
4. Turn f to scroll through the files in the selected  
2. Press the softkey below the tab with the function  
on it to use that function.  
folder.  
5. Press f to select the desired file to be played.  
j (Pause): Press the softkey below j to pause the  
track. The tab appears raised when pause is being  
To skip through large lists, the five softkeys can be used  
to navigate in the following order:  
used. Press the softkey below j again to resume  
playback.  
.
First softkey, first item in the list.  
Back: Press the softkey below the back tab to go back  
to the main display screen on an iPod, or the root  
directory on a USB storage device.  
.
Second softkey, 1% through the list each time the  
softkey is pressed.  
.
Third softkey, 5% through the list each time the  
softkey is pressed.  
.
Fourth softkey, 10% through the list each time the  
softkey is pressed.  
.
Fifth softkey, end of the list.  
4-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To skip through large lists, the five softkeys can be used  
to navigate in the following order:  
h (Music Navigator): Press the softkey  
below h to view and select a file on an iPod,  
using the iPod's menu system. Files are sorted by:  
.
First softkey, first item in the list.  
.
.
Second softkey, 1% through the list each time the  
softkey is pressed.  
Playlists  
.
Artists  
.
Third softkey, 5% through the list each time the  
softkey is pressed.  
.
Albums  
.
Genres  
.
Fourth softkey, 10% through the list each time the  
softkey is pressed.  
.
Songs  
.
.
Composers  
Fifth softkey, end of the list.  
To select files:  
Repeat Functionality  
1. Press the softkey below h.  
2. Turn f to scroll through the list of menus.  
3. Press f to select the desired menu.  
To use Repeat:  
Press the softkey below " or ' to select between  
Repeat All and Repeat Track.  
" (Repeat All): Press the softkey below " to repeat  
all tracks. The tab appears lowered when Repeat All is  
being used. This is the default mode when a USB  
storage device or iPod is first connected.  
4. Turn f to scroll through the folders or files in the  
selected menu.  
5. Press f to select the desired file to be played.  
' (Repeat Track): Press the softkey below ' to  
repeat one track. The tab appears raised when Repeat  
Track is being used.  
4-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Shuffle Functionality  
XM Radio Messages  
XL (Explicit Language Channels): These channels,  
or any others, can be blocked at a customer's request,  
by calling 1-800-852-XMXM (9696).  
To use Shuffle:  
Press the softkey below > , 2 , < or = to  
select between Shuffle Off, Shuffle All Songs/Shuffle  
Songs, Shuffle Album, or Shuffle Folder.  
XM Updating: The encryption code in the receiver is  
being updated, and no action is required. This process  
should take no longer than 30 seconds.  
> (Shuffle Off): Press the softkey below 2 to  
turn shuffle off. This is the default mode when a  
USB storage device or iPod is first connected.  
No XM Signal: The system is functioning correctly,  
but the vehicle is in a location that is blocking the  
XMsignal. When the vehicle is moved into an open  
area, the signal should return.  
2 (Shuffle All Songs / Shuffle Songs): Press the  
softkey below = or < to shuffle all songs on the  
USB storage device or iPod.  
Loading XM: The audio system is acquiring and  
processing audio and text data. No action is needed.  
This message should disappear shortly.  
< (Shuffle Album): Press the softkey below > to  
shuffle all songs in the current album on an iPod.  
= (Shuffle Folder): Press the softkey below > to  
shuffle all songs in the current folder on a USB storage  
device.  
Channel Off Air: This channel is not currently in  
service. Tune in to another channel.  
Channel Unauth : This channel is blocked or cannot  
be received with your XM Subscription package.  
Channel Unavail: This previously assigned channel  
is no longer assigned. Tune to another station. If this  
station was one of the presets, choose another station  
for that preset button.  
No Artist Info: No artist information is available at this  
time on this channel. The system is working properly.  
4-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
No Title Info: No song title information is available at  
this time on this channel. The system is working  
properly.  
Check Antenna: If this message does not clear within  
a short period of time, the receiver or antenna could  
have a fault. Consult with your dealer/retailer.  
No CAT Info: No category information is available at  
this time on this channel. The system is working  
properly.  
Check XM Receivr: If this message does not clear  
within a short period of time, the receiver could have a  
fault. Consult with your dealer/retailer.  
No Information: No text or informational messages are  
available at this time on this channel. The system is  
working properly.  
XM Not Available: If this message does not clear  
within a short period of time, the receiver could have a  
fault. Consult with your dealer/retailer.  
CAT Not Found: There are no channels available for  
the selected category. The system is working properly.  
Bluetooth®  
Vehicles with a Bluetooth system can use a Bluetooth  
capable cell phone with a Hands Free Profile to make  
and receive phone calls. The system can be used while  
the key is in ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY position.  
The range of the Bluetooth system can be up to 9.1 m  
(30 ft). Not all phones support all functions, and not all  
phones are guaranteed to work with the in-vehicle  
Bluetooth system. See www.gm.com/bluetooth for more  
information on compatible phones.  
XM Theftlocked: The XM receiver in the vehicle could  
have previously been in another vehicle. For security  
purposes, XM receivers cannot be swapped between  
vehicles. If this message is received after having the  
vehicle serviced, check with your dealer/retailer.  
XM Radio ID: If tuned to channel 0, this message  
alternates with the XMRadio 8 digit radio ID label.  
This label is needed to activate the service.  
Unknown: If this message is received when tuned to  
channel 0, there could be a receiver fault. Consult with  
your dealer/retailer.  
4-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Recognition  
Bluetooth Controls  
The Bluetooth system uses voice recognition to  
interpret voice commands to dial phone numbers  
and name tags.  
Use the buttons located on the steering wheel to  
operate the invehicle Bluetooth system. See Audio  
Steering Wheel Controls on page 484 for more  
information.  
Noise: Keep interior noise levels to a minimum.  
The system may not recognize voice commands if  
there is too much background noise.  
b g (Push To Talk): Press to answer incoming calls, to  
confirm system information, and to start speech  
recognition.  
When to Speak: A short tone sounds after the system  
responds indicating when it is waiting for a voice  
command. Wait until the tone and then speak.  
c x (Phone On Hook): Press to end a call, reject a  
call, or to cancel an operation.  
How to Speak: Speak clearly in a calm and natural  
voice.  
Pairing  
A Bluetooth enabled cell phone must be paired to the  
invehicle Bluetooth system first and then connected to  
the vehicle before it can be used. See the cell phone  
manufacturers user guide for Bluetooth functions  
before pairing the cell phone. If a Bluetooth phone  
is not connected, calls will be made using OnStar®  
HandsFree Calling, if available. Refer to the OnStar  
owner's guide for more information.  
Audio System  
When using the invehicle Bluetooth system, sound  
comes through the vehicle's front audio system  
speakers and overrides the audio system. Use the  
audio system volume knob, during a call, to change  
the volume level. The adjusted volume level remains  
in memory for later calls. To prevent missed calls, a  
minimum volume level is used if the volume is turned  
down too low.  
4-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pairing Information:  
3. Say Pair. The system responds with instructions  
and a four digit PIN number. The PIN number will  
be used in Step 4.  
.
Up to five cell phones can be paired to the  
invehicle Bluetooth system.  
4. Start the Pairing process on the cell phone that will  
be paired to the vehicle. Reference the cell phone  
manufacturers user guide for information on this  
process.  
.
.
The pairing process is disabled when the vehicle is  
moving.  
The invehicle Bluetooth system automatically links  
with the first available paired cell phone in the  
order the phone was paired.  
Locate the device named General Motorsin the  
list on the cellular phone and follow the instructions  
on the cell phone to enter the four digit PIN  
number that was provided in Step 3.  
.
.
Only one paired cell phone can be connected to  
the invehicle Bluetooth system at a time.  
Pairing should only need to be completed once,  
unless changes to the pairing information have  
been made or the phone is deleted.  
5. The system prompts for a name for the phone. Use  
a name that best describes the phone. This name  
will be used to indicate which phone is connected.  
The system then confirms the name provided.  
To link to a different paired phone, see Linking to a  
Different Phone later in this section.  
6. The system responds with <Phone name> has  
been successfully pairedafter the pairing process  
is complete.  
Pairing a Phone  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
7. Repeat Steps 1 through 7 for additional phones to  
be paired.  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
4-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listing All Paired and Connected Phones  
Linking to a Different Phone  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
3. Say List. The system lists all the paired Bluetooth  
devices. If a phone is connected to the vehicle, the  
system will say Is connectedafter the connected  
phone.  
3. Say Change phone. The system responds with  
Please wait while I search for other phones.  
.
If another phone is found, the response will be  
<Phone name> is now connected.  
.
Deleting a Paired Phone  
If another phone is not found, the original  
phone remains connected.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
Storing Name Tags  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
The system can store up to thirty phone numbers as  
name tags that are shared between the Bluetooth and  
OnStar systems.  
3. Say Delete. The system asks which phone to  
delete followed by a tone.  
The system uses the following commands to store and  
retrieve phone numbers:  
4. Say the name of the phone to be deleted. If the  
phone name is unknown, use the Listcommand  
for a list of all paired phones. The system responds  
with Would you like to delete <phone name>? Yes  
or Nofollowed by a tone.  
.
Store  
.
Digit Store  
.
Directory  
5. Say Yesto delete the phone. The system  
responds with OK, deleting <phone name>.  
4-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Say a name tag for the phone number. The name  
tag is recorded and the system responds with  
About to store <name tag>. Does that  
sound OK?.  
Using the Store Command  
The store command allows a phone number to be  
stored without entering the digits individually.  
.
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
If the name tag does not sound correct, say  
Noand repeat Step 5.  
.
2. Say Store. The system responds with Store,  
number pleasefollowed by a tone.  
If the name tag sounds correct, say Yesand  
the name tag is stored. After the number is  
stored the system returns to the main menu.  
3. Say the complete phone number to be stored at  
once with no pauses.  
Using the Digit Store Command  
.
If the system recognizes the number it  
The digit store command allows a phone number to be  
stored by entering the digits individually.  
responds with OK, Storingand repeats the  
phone number.  
.
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
If the system is unsure it recognizes the phone  
number, it responds with Storeand repeats  
the number followed by Please say yes or no.  
If the number is correct, say Yes. If the  
number is not correct, say No. The system  
will ask for the number to be reentered.  
2. Say Digit Store. The system responds with  
Please say the first digit to storefollowed by  
a tone.  
4. After the system stores the phone number, it  
responds with Please say the name tagfollowed  
by a tone.  
4-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Say the first digit to be stored. The system will  
repeat back the digit it heard followed by a tone.  
Continue entering digits until the number to be  
stored is complete.  
Using the Directory Command  
The directory command lists all of the name tags stored  
by the system. To use the directory command:  
.
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
If an unwanted number is recognized by the  
system, say Clearat any time to clear the last  
number.  
2. Say Directory. The system responds with  
Directoryand then plays back all of the stored  
name tags. When the list is complete, the system  
returns to the main menu.  
.
To hear all of the numbers recognized by the  
system, say Verifyat any time and the system  
will repeat them.  
4. After the complete number has been entered, say  
Store. The system responds with Please say the  
name tagfollowed by a tone.  
Deleting Name Tags  
The system uses the following commands to delete  
name tags:  
5. Say a name tag for the phone number. The name  
tag is recorded and the system responds with  
About to store <name tag>. Does that  
sound OK?.  
.
Delete  
.
Delete all name tags  
Using the Delete Command  
.
If the name tag does not sound correct, say  
Noand repeat Step 5.  
The delete command allows specific name tags to be  
deleted.  
.
If the name tag sounds correct, say Yesand  
the name tag is stored. After the number is  
stored the system returns to the main menu.  
To use the delete command:  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Delete. The system responds with Delete,  
please say the name tagfollowed by a tone.  
4-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Say the name tag to be deleted. The system  
responds with Would you like to delete,  
<name tag>? Please say yes or no.  
Making a Call  
Calls can be made using the following commands:  
.
Dial  
.
If the name tag is correct, say Yesto delete  
.
the name tag. The system responds with  
OK, deleting <name tag>, returning to the  
main menu.”  
Digit Dial  
.
Call  
.
Redial  
.
If the name tag is incorrect, say No.  
The system responds with No. OK, let's  
try again, please say the name tag.”  
Using the Dial Command  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
Using the Delete All Name Tags Command  
The delete all name tags command deletes all stored  
phone book name tags and route name tags for OnStar,  
if present.  
2. Say Dial. The system responds with Dial using  
<phone name>. Number pleasefollowed by  
a tone.  
To use the delete all name tags command:  
3. Say the entire number without pausing.  
.
If the system recognizes the number, it  
responds with OK, Dialingand dials the  
number.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Delete all name tags. The system responds  
with You are about to delete all name tags stored  
in your phone directory and your route destination  
directory. Are you sure you want to do this? Please  
say yes or no.”  
.
If the system does not recognize the number,  
it confirms the numbers followed by a tone.  
If the number is correct, say Yes. The system  
responds with OK, Dialingand dials the  
number. If the number is not correct, say No.  
The system will ask for the number to be re‐  
entered.  
.
Say Yesto delete all name tags.  
.
Say Noto cancel the function and return to  
the main menu.  
4-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Say the name tag of the person to call.  
Using the Digit Dial Command  
.
If the system clearly recognizes the name tag it  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
responds with OK, calling, <name tag>and  
dials the number.  
2. Say Digit Dial. The system responds with Digit  
dial using <phone name>, please say the first digit  
to dialfollowed by a tone.  
.
If the system is unsure it recognizes the right  
name tag, it confirms the name tag followed by  
a tone. If the name tag is correct, say Yes.  
The system responds with OK, calling, <name  
tag>and dials the number. If the name tag is  
not correct, say No. The system will ask for  
the name tag to be reentered.  
3. Say the digit to be dialed one at a time. Following  
each digit, the system will repeat back the digit it  
heard followed by a tone.  
4. Continue entering digits until the number to be  
dialed is complete. After the whole number has  
been entered, say Dial. The system responds  
with OK, Dialingand dials the number.  
Once connected, the person called will be heard  
through the audio speakers.  
Using the Redial Command  
.
If an unwanted number is recognized by the  
system, say Clearat any time to clear the last  
number.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
.
To hear all of the numbers recognized by the  
system, say Verifyat any time and the system  
will repeat them.  
2. After the tone, say Redial. The system responds  
with Redial using <phone name>and dials the  
last number called from the connected Bluetooth  
phone.  
Using the Call Command  
Once connected, the person called will be heard  
through the audio speakers.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Call. The system responds with Call using  
<phone name>. Please say the name tagfollowed  
by a tone.  
4-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Receiving a Call  
ThreeWay Calling  
When an incoming call is received, the audio system  
mutes and a ring tone is heard in the vehicle.  
ThreeWay Calling must be supported on the Bluetooth  
phone and enabled by the wireless service carrier  
to work.  
.
Press b g and begin speaking to answer the call.  
1. While on a call press b g. The system responds  
with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
.
Press c x to ignore a call.  
2. Say Threeway call. The system responds with  
Threeway call, please say dial or call.  
Call Waiting  
Call waiting must be supported on the Bluetooth phone  
and enabled by the wireless service carrier to work.  
3. Use the dial or call command to dial the number of  
the third party to be called.  
.
Press b g to answer an incoming call when  
another call is active. The original call is placed  
on hold.  
4. Once the call is connected, press b g to link all  
the callers together.  
.
Ending a Call  
Press b g again to return to the original call.  
To ignore the incoming call, continue with the  
original call with no action.  
.
Press c x to end a call.  
.
Press c x to disconnect the current call and  
switch to the call on hold.  
4-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Muting a Call  
Transferring a Call  
During a call, all sounds from inside the vehicle can be  
muted so that the person on the other end of the call  
cannot hear them.  
Audio can be transferred between the invehicle  
Bluetooth system and the cell phone.  
To Transfer Audio to the Cell Phone  
To Mute a call  
During a call with the audio in the vehicle:  
1. Press b g. The system responds with Ready”  
1. Press b g. The system responds with Ready”  
followed by a tone.  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Mute Call. The system responds with Call  
muted.  
2. Say Transfer Call.The system responds with  
Transferring calland the audio will switch from  
the vehicle to the cell phone.  
To Cancel Mute  
To Transfer Audio to the In-Vehicle  
Bluetooth System  
1. Press b g. The system responds with Ready”  
followed by a tone.  
2. After the tone, say Mute Call. The system  
responds with Resuming call.  
The cellular phone must be paired and connected  
with the Bluetooth system before a call can be  
transferred. The connection process can take up to  
two minutes after the key is turned to the ON/RUN or  
ACC/ACCESSORY position.  
During a call with the audio on the cell phone,  
press b g for more than two seconds. The audio  
switches from the cell phone to the vehicle.  
4-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a Number During a Call  
Voice Pass-Thru  
Voice PassThru allows access to the voice recognition  
commands on the cell phone. See the cell phone  
manufacturers user guide to see if the cell phone  
supports this feature. This feature can be used to  
verbally access contacts stored in the cell phone.  
1. Press b g. The system responds with Ready”  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Dial. The system responds with Say a  
number to send tonesfollowed by a tone.  
3. Say the number to send.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
.
If the system clearly recognizes the number it  
responds with OK, Sending Numberand the  
dial tones are sent and the call continues.  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
.
If the system is not sure it recognized the  
3. Say Voice. The system responds with  
OK, accessing <phone name>.  
number properly, it responds Dial Number,  
Please say yes or no?followed by a tone.  
If the number is correct, say Yes. The system  
responds with OK, Sending Numberand the  
dial tones are sent and the call continues.  
.
The cell phone's normal prompt messages will  
go through its cycle according to the phone's  
operating instructions.  
Sending a Stored Name Tag During a Call  
Dual Tone Multi-Frequency (DTMF)  
Tones  
The invehicle Bluetooth system can send numbers and  
numbers stored as name tags during a call. This is used  
when calling a menu driven phone system. Account  
numbers can be programmed into the phonebook for  
retrieval during menu driven calls.  
1. Press b g. The system responds with Ready”  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Send name tag.The system responds with  
Say a name tag to send tonesfollowed by a tone.  
4-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Say the name tag to send.  
Theft-Deterrent Feature  
.
If the system clearly recognizes the name tag it  
THEFTLOCK® is designed to discourage theft of the  
vehicle's radio by learning a portion of the Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN). The radio does not operate  
if it is stolen or moved to a different vehicle.  
responds with OK, Sending <name tag>and  
the dial tones are sent and the call continues.  
.
If the system is not sure it recognized the name  
tag properly, it responds Dial <name tag>,  
Please say yes or no?followed by a tone.  
If the name tag is correct, say Yes.  
The system responds with OK, Sending  
<name tag>and the dial tones are sent  
and the call continues.  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls  
Vehicles with audio  
steering wheel controls  
could differ depending  
on the vehicle's options.  
Some audio controls  
can be adjusted at the  
steering wheel.  
Clearing the System  
Unless information is deleted out of the invehicle  
Bluetooth system, it will be retained indefinitely. This  
includes all saved name tags in the phonebook and  
phone pairing information. For information on how to  
delete this information, see the above sections on  
Deleting a Paired Phone and Deleting Name Tags.  
Other Information  
e + / e (Volume): Press to increase or to decrease  
the radio volume.  
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are owned by the  
Bluetooth® SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by  
General Motors is under license. Other trademarks and  
trade names are those of their respective owners.  
w / x (Next / Previous): Press to change radio  
stations, select tracks on a CD, or to select tracks and  
navigate folders on an iPod® or USB device.  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 820 for FCC  
information.  
4-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To change radio stations:  
3. Press and release w or x to scroll up or down  
the list.  
.
Press and release w or x to go to the next or  
previous radio station stored as a preset.  
.
To select a folder, press and hold w when the  
folder is highlighted.  
.
Press and hold w or x to go to the next or  
previous radio station in the selected band with  
a strong signal.  
.
To go back further in the folder list, press and  
hold x.  
To select tracks on a CD:  
c (End): Press to reject an incoming call, or end a  
current call.  
Press and release w or x to go to the next or previous  
track.  
b g (Mute / Voice Recognition): Press to silence the  
vehicle speakers only. Press again to turn the sound on.  
To select tracks on an iPod or USB device:  
For vehicles with Bluetooth® or OnStar® systems press  
1. Press and hold w or x while listening to a song  
until the contents of the current folder display on  
the radio display.  
and hold b g for longer than two seconds to interact  
with those systems. See Bluetooth® on page 473 and  
the OnStar Owner's Guide for more information.  
2. Press and release w or x to scroll up or down the  
Radio Reception  
list, then press and hold w to play the highlighted  
track.  
Frequency interference and static can occur during  
normal radio reception if items such as cell phone  
chargers, vehicle convenience accessories, and  
external electronic devices are plugged into the  
accessory power outlet. If there is interference or static,  
unplug the item from the accessory power outlet.  
To navigate folders on an iPod or USB device:  
1. Press and hold w or x while listening to a song  
until the contents of the current folder display on  
the radio display.  
2. Press and hold x to go back to the previous  
folder list.  
4-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AM  
Cellular Phone Usage  
The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM,  
especially at night. The longer range can cause station  
frequencies to interfere with each other. For better radio  
reception, most AM radio stations boost the power  
levels during the day, and then reduce these levels  
during the night. Static can also occur when things like  
storms and power lines interfere with radio reception.  
When this happens, try reducing the treble on the radio.  
Cellular phone usage may cause interference with  
the vehicle's radio. This interference may occur  
when making or receiving phone calls, charging the  
phone's battery, or simply having the phone on. This  
interference causes an increased level of static while  
listening to the radio. If static is received while listening  
to the radio, unplug the cellular phone and turn it off.  
Fixed Mast Antenna  
FM Stereo  
The fixed mast antenna can withstand most car  
washes without being damaged as long as it is securely  
attached to the base. If the mast becomes slightly bent,  
straighten it out by hand. If the mast is badly bent,  
replace it.  
FM signals only reach about 10 to 40 miles  
(16 to 65 km). Although the radio has a built-in electronic  
circuit that automatically works to reduce interference,  
some static can occur, especially around tall buildings  
or hills, causing the sound to fade in and out.  
Occasionally check to make sure the antenna is  
tightened to its base. If tightening is required, tighten  
by hand until fully seated plus one quarter turn.  
XMSatellite Radio Service  
XM Satellite Radio Service gives digital radio reception  
from coast-to-coast in the 48 contiguous United States,  
and in Canada. Just as with FM, tall buildings or hills  
can interfere with satellite radio signals, causing the  
sound to fade in and out. In addition, traveling or  
standing under heavy foliage, bridges, garages,  
or tunnels may cause loss of the XM signal for a  
period of time.  
XMSatellite Radio Antenna  
System  
The XM Satellite Radio antenna is located on the roof  
or the rear of the vehicle. Keep the antenna clear of  
obstructions for clear radio reception.  
4-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5 Driving Your Vehicle  
Your Driving, the Road, and the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Driving at Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Before Leaving on a Long Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice,  
or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Loading the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Drunk Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Braking in Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
Limited-Slip Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Racing or Other Competitive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Towing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Towing a Trailer (Automatic Transmission) . . . . . 5-33  
Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) . . . . . . . . 5-39  
5-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drunk Driving  
Your Driving, the Road, and  
the Vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
Defensive Driving  
Drinking and then driving is very dangerous.  
Your reflexes, perceptions, attentiveness, and  
judgment can be affected by even a small amount  
of alcohol. You can have a serious or even  
fatal collision if you drive after drinking. Do not  
drink and drive or ride with a driver who has been  
drinking. Ride home in a cab; or if you are with a  
group, designate a driver who will not drink.  
Defensive driving means always expect the  
unexpected.The first step in driving defensively is to  
wear your safety belt See Safety Belts: They Are for  
Everyone on page 210.  
WARNING:  
{
Assume that other road users (pedestrians,  
bicyclists, and other drivers) are going to be  
careless and make mistakes. Anticipate what they  
might do and be ready. In addition:  
Death and injury associated with drinking and driving is  
a global tragedy.  
Alcohol affects four things that anyone needs to drive a  
vehicle: judgment, muscular coordination, vision, and  
attentiveness.  
.
Allow enough following distance between you  
and the driver in front of you.  
.
Focus on the task of driving.  
Police records show that almost 40 percent of all motor  
vehicle-related deaths involve alcohol. In most cases,  
these deaths are the result of someone who was  
drinking and driving. In recent years, more than  
17,000 annual motor vehicle-related deaths have  
been associated with the use of alcohol, with about  
250,000 people injured.  
Driver distraction can cause collisions resulting in  
injury or possible death. These simple defensive  
driving techniques could save your life.  
5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For persons under 21, it is against the law in every  
U.S. state to drink alcohol. There are good medical,  
psychological, and developmental reasons for  
these laws.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
vehicle performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 64.  
Braking  
The obvious way to eliminate the leading highway  
safety problem is for people never to drink alcohol and  
then drive.  
See Brake System Warning Light on page 423.  
Braking action involves perception time and reaction  
time. Deciding to push the brake pedal is perception  
time. Actually doing it is reaction time.  
Medical research shows that alcohol in a person's  
system can make crash injuries worse, especially  
injuries to the brain, spinal cord, or heart. This means  
that when anyone who has been drinking driver or  
passenger is in a crash, that person's chance of  
being killed or permanently disabled is higher than if the  
person had not been drinking.  
Average reaction time is about threefourths of a  
second. But that is only an average. It might be less  
with one driver and as long as two or three seconds or  
more with another. Age, physical condition, alertness,  
coordination, and eyesight all play a part. So do alcohol,  
drugs, and frustration. But even in threefourths of a  
second, a vehicle moving at 100 km/h (60 mph) travels  
20 m (66 feet). That could be a lot of distance in an  
emergency, so keeping enough space between the  
vehicle and others is important.  
Control of a Vehicle  
The following three systems help to control the vehicle  
while driving brakes, steering, and accelerator. At  
times, as when driving on snow or ice, it is easy to ask  
more of those control systems than the tires and road  
can provide. Meaning, you can lose control of the  
vehicle. See Traction Control System (TCS) on  
page 59, Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on  
page 512, and Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on  
And, of course, actual stopping distances vary greatly  
with the surface of the road, whether it is pavement or  
gravel; the condition of the road, whether it is wet, dry,  
or icy; tire tread; the condition of the brakes; the weight  
of the vehicle; and the amount of brake force applied.  
page 56  
.
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Avoid needless heavy braking. Some people drive in  
spurts, heavy acceleration followed by heavy braking,  
rather than keeping pace with traffic. This is a mistake.  
The brakes might not have time to cool between hard  
stops. The brakes will wear out much faster with a lot  
of heavy braking. Keeping pace with the traffic and  
allowing realistic following distances eliminates a lot  
of unnecessary braking. That means better braking  
and longer brake life.  
feel changes or the brake pedal feels hard to push, the  
system might not be receiving the intended brake boost  
and the SVC BRAKE SYSTEM DIC message may be  
displayed.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can  
affect vehicle performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 64.  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
The vehicle might have the Antilock Brake System  
(ABS), an advanced electronic braking system that  
helps prevent a braking skid.  
If the engine ever stops while the vehicle is being  
driven, brake normally but do not pump the brakes.  
If the brakes are pumped, the pedal could get harder to  
push down. If the engine stops, there will still be some  
power brake assist but it will be used when the brake is  
applied. Once the power assist is used up, it can take  
longer to stop and the brake pedal will be harder  
to push.  
If the vehicle has ABS,  
this warning light on the  
instrument panel comes  
on briefly when the  
vehicle is started.  
If the vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC) and  
the 2.0L turbocharged engine, it also has a hydraulic  
brake boost feature which supplements the power brake  
system to maintain consistent brake performance under  
conditions of low brake booster vacuum. Low brake  
booster vacuum conditions can include initial start up  
after the vehicle has been parked for several hours,  
very frequent brake stops, or high altitude driving. When  
hydraulic brake boost is active, minor brake pulsation or  
movement might be felt but this is normal. If brake pedal  
When the engine is started, or when the vehicle begins  
to drive away, ABS checks itself. A momentary motor  
or clicking noise might be heard while this test is going  
on, and it might even be noticed that the brake pedal  
moves or pulses a little. This is normal.  
5-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Let us say the road is wet and you are driving safely.  
Suddenly, an animal jumps out in front of you. You slam  
on the brakes and continue braking. Here is what  
happens with ABS:  
Braking in Emergencies  
At some time, nearly every driver gets into a situation  
that requires hard braking.  
If the vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC)  
with Antilock Brake System (ABS), it allows the driver  
to steer and brake at the same time. However, if the  
vehicle does not have ESC with ABS, the first  
reaction to hit the brake pedal hard and hold it  
down might be the wrong thing to do. The wheels can  
stop rolling. Once they do, the vehicle cannot respond  
to the driver's steering. Momentum will carry it in  
whatever direction it was headed when the wheels  
stopped rolling. That could be off the road, into the very  
thing the driver was trying to avoid, or into traffic.  
A computer senses that the wheels are slowing down.  
If one of the wheels is about to stop rolling, the  
computer will separately work the brakes at each wheel.  
ABS can change the brake pressure to each wheel, as  
required, faster than any driver could. This can help the  
driver steer around the obstacle while braking hard.  
As the brakes are applied, the computer keeps  
receiving updates on wheel speed and controls braking  
pressure accordingly.  
Remember: ABS does not change the time needed to  
get a foot up to the brake pedal or always decrease  
stopping distance. If you get too close to the vehicle in  
front of you, there will not be enough time to apply the  
brakes if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops. Always  
leave enough room up ahead to stop, even with ABS.  
If the vehicle does not have ABS, use a squeeze”  
braking technique. This gives maximum braking while  
maintaining steering control. Do this by pushing on the  
brake pedal with steadily increasing pressure.  
In an emergency, you will probably want to squeeze the  
brakes hard without locking the wheels. If you hear or  
feel the wheels sliding, ease off the brake pedal. This  
helps retain steering control. Without ABS, it is different.  
See Antilock Brake System (ABS) on page 54.  
Using ABS  
Do not pump the brakes. Just hold the brake pedal  
down firmly and let antilock work. A slight brake pedal  
pulsation might be felt or some noise noticed, but this is  
normal.  
In many emergencies, steering can help more than  
even the very best braking.  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brake Assist  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)  
If this vehicle has ESC with ABS, it also has a Brake  
Assist feature designed to assist the driver in stopping  
or decreasing vehicle speed in emergency driving  
conditions. This feature uses the stability system  
hydraulic brake control module to supplement the power  
brake system under conditions where the driver has  
quickly and forcefully applied the brake pedal in an  
attempt to quickly stop or slow down the vehicle.  
The stability system hydraulic brake control module  
increases brake pressure at each corner of the vehicle  
until the ABS activates. Minor brake pedal pulsations or  
pedal movement during this time is normal and the  
driver should continue to apply the brake pedal as the  
driving situation dictates The Brake Assist feature will  
automatically disengage when the brake pedal is  
released or brake pedal pressure is quickly decreased.  
The vehicle may have an Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC) system which combines antilock brake, and  
traction and stability control systems that help the driver  
maintain directional control of the vehicle in most driving  
conditions.  
When the vehicle is started and begins to move, the  
system performs several diagnostic checks to ensure  
there are no problems. The system may be heard or felt  
while it is working. This is normal and does not mean  
there is a problem with the vehicle. The system should  
initialize before the vehicle reaches 32 km/h (20 mph).  
If the system fails to turn on or activate, the ESC/TCS  
light comes on, and the ESC OFF and/or SERVICE  
ESC message displays.  
For more information, see Driver Information Center  
(DIC) on page 438 and Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 425.  
5-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system is  
automatically enabled whenever the vehicle is started.  
To assist the driver with vehicle directional control,  
especially in slippery road conditions, always leave the  
system on. ESC can be turned off if needed.  
This light flashes on the  
instrument panel cluster  
when the ESC system is  
on and activated.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control when the system  
begins to assist the driver maintain directional control of  
the vehicle, the ESC/TCS light will flash and the cruise  
control will automatically disengage. The cruise control  
can be re-engaged when road conditions allow. See  
Cruise Control on page 46.  
ESC activates when the computer senses a  
discrepancy between the intended path and the  
direction the vehicle is actually traveling. ESC  
selectively applies braking pressure at any one of the  
vehicle's brakes to help steer the vehicle in the intended  
direction.  
The ESC/TCS button is  
located on the instrument  
panel.  
When the system activates, an ESC ACTIVE message  
displays on the Driver Information Center. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 440. This light also  
flashes on the instrument panel cluster when the ESC  
system is on and activated. Noise or vibration may be  
felt in the brake pedal. This is normal. Continue to steer  
the vehicle in the desired direction.  
The traction control system can be turned off or back on  
by pressing the ESC/TCS button. To disable both  
traction control and ESC, press and hold the button  
from five to ten seconds.  
When the light is on solid and the message(s),  
SERVICE ESC, ESC OFF, or both display, the system  
will not assist the driver in maintaining directional  
control of the vehicle. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 440.  
5-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the ESC system is turned off, the TRACTION  
OFF and ESC OFF messages appear, and the  
ESC/TCS light comes on to warn the driver that  
both traction control and ESC are disabled.  
Competitive Driving Mode  
(SS Models Only)  
The driver can select this optional handling mode by  
pressing the ESC/TCS button on the console two times  
quickly. COMPETITIVE MODE will be displayed in the  
It is recommended that the system remain on for normal  
driving conditions, but it may be necessary to turn the  
system off if the vehicle is stuck in sand, mud, ice or  
snow, and you want to rockyour vehicle to attempt to  
free it. It may also be necessary to turn off the system  
when driving in extreme off-road conditions where high  
wheel spin is required. See If Your Vehicle is Stuck in  
DIC. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 440  
.
Competitive Driving Mode allows the driver to have full  
control of the front wheels while the ESC system helps  
maintain directional control of the vehicle by selective  
brake application. The ESC/TCS light will be on and the  
traction control system will not be operating. Adjust your  
driving accordingly. This electronic stability control  
mode is recommended only for use during closed track  
events and competitive driving venues.  
Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow on page 524  
.
ESC may also turn off automatically if it determines that  
a problem exists with the system. The ESC OFF and  
SERVICE ESC messages and the ESC/TCS light  
comes on to warn the driver that ESC is disabled and  
requires service. If the problem does not clear after  
restarting the vehicle, see your dealer/retailer for  
service. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 440 for more information.  
When the ESC button is pressed again, or the vehicle is  
restarted, the ESC and TCS will be turned back on.  
Notice: When traction control is turned off,  
or Competitive Driving Mode is active, it is possible  
to lose traction. If you attempt to shift with the  
front wheels spinning with a loss of traction, it is  
possible to cause damage to the transmission.  
Do not attempt to shift when the front wheels do  
not have traction. Damage caused by misuse of the  
vehicle is not covered. See your warranty book for  
additional information.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
the vehicle's performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 64 for more information.  
5-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Launch Control (SS Models Only)  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
Launch Control is a form of traction control, to control  
tire spin while launching the vehicle during closed track  
events and competitive driving. The feature is activated  
when the vehicle is at rest while in Competitive Mode.  
At rest, if the accelerator pedal is pressed to the floor  
with the clutch engaged, the RPM is limited to a  
predetermined level. A smooth, quick release of the  
clutch while keeping the accelerator pedal on the floor  
will provide controlled wheel spin for consistent  
acceleration. Complete shifts as described in Manual  
Transmission Operation on page 328.  
The vehicle may have a Traction Control System (TCS)  
that limits wheel spin. This is especially useful in  
slippery road conditions. The system operates only if it  
senses that the front wheels are spinning too much or  
are beginning to lose traction. When this happens, the  
system works the front brakes and reduces engine  
power by closing the throttle and managing engine  
spark to limit wheel spin.  
This light flashes while  
the traction control system  
is limiting wheel spin.  
LAUNCH CONTROL displays in the DIC after the  
COMPETITIVE MODE message, when the vehicle is  
stopped. The system will exit to COMPETITIVE MODE  
after the vehicle is launched. See Competitive Driving  
Modeearlier in this section. The normal Traction  
Control System (TCS) will not be operating while in the  
Competitive Driving mode and the TCS light on the  
instrument panel cluster comes on. Adjust your driving  
accordingly. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 440 for more information.  
The system may be heard or felt while it is working.  
This is normal and does not mean there is a problem  
with the vehicle.  
See Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/Traction Control  
System (TCS) Indicator/Warning Light on page 425 for  
more information.  
5-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control while TCS begins to  
limit wheel spin, the cruise control will automatically  
disengage. The cruise control can be re-engaged when  
road conditions allow. See Turn Signal/Multifunction  
Lever on page 44.  
It may also be necessary to turn off the system when  
driving in off-road conditions where high wheel spin is  
required. See If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud,  
Ice, or Snow on page 524.  
To turn the system off or  
on, press and release the  
ESC/TCS button located  
on the instrument panel.  
When this light is on and  
either the SERVICE  
TRACTION or TRACTION  
OFF message is  
displayed, the system will  
not limit wheel spin.  
The DIC displays the appropriate message as  
described previously when the button is pressed.  
Adjust your driving accordingly. See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 440 for more information.  
Traction Control Operation  
The Traction Control System comes on automatically  
whenever the vehicle is started. It is recommended to  
leave the system on for normal driving conditions,  
but it may be necessary to turn the system off if the  
vehicle is stuck in sand, mud, ice or snow, and you  
want to rockyour vehicle to attempt to free it.  
Traction control limits wheel spin by reducing engine  
power to the wheels (engine speed management) and  
by applying brakes to each individual wheel  
(brake-traction control) as necessary.  
5-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The traction control system is enabled automatically  
when the vehicle is started, and it will activate and flash  
the ESC/TCS light and display the LOW TRACTION  
message if it senses that either of the front wheels are  
spinning or beginning to lose traction while driving. For  
more information on the LOW TRACTION message,  
see Driver Information Center (DIC) on page 438.  
The traction control system may activate on dry or  
rough roads or under conditions such as heavy  
acceleration while turning or abrupt upshifts/downshifts  
of the transmission. When this happens, a reduction in  
acceleration may be noticed or a noise or vibration may  
be heard. This is normal.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control while the system  
activates, the ESC/TCS light flashes and the cruise  
control automatically disengages. The cruise control  
can be re-engaged when road conditions allow. See  
Cruise Control on page 46.  
Notice: If the wheel(s) of one axle are allowed to  
spin excessively while the ESC/TCS, ABS and  
Brake warning lights and the SERVICE ESC and/or  
SERVICE TRACTION messages are displayed, the  
differential could be damaged. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Reduce  
engine power and do not spin the wheel(s)  
excessively while these lights and this message  
are displayed.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
the vehicle's performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 64 for more information.  
Notice: When traction control is turned off,  
or Competitive Driving Mode is active, it is possible  
to lose traction. If you attempt to shift with the  
drive wheels spinning with a loss of traction, it is  
possible to cause damage to the transmission. Do  
not attempt to shift when the drive wheels do not  
have traction. Damage caused by misuse of the  
vehicle is not covered. See the warranty book for  
additional information.  
5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS)  
The vehicle may have an Enhanced Traction System  
(ETS) that limits wheel spin. This is especially useful in  
slippery road conditions. The system operates only if it  
senses that one or both of the front wheels are spinning  
or beginning to lose traction. When this happens, the  
system reduces engine power and may also upshift the  
transmission to limit wheel spin.  
The ETS indicator/warning light may come on for the  
following reasons:  
If the vehicle has ETS, there is not an ESC/TCS button  
on the instrument panel. To turn the system off, shift to  
L (Low) or R (Reverse). There is more information about  
how to turn the system off later in this section.  
.
The indicator/warning light flashes while the  
traction control system is limiting wheel spin.  
.
If the system is turned off by moving the shift lever  
The ETS indicator/warning light flashes and LOW  
TRACTION appears on the Driver Information Center  
(DIC) when the traction control system is actively  
limiting wheel spin. The system may be heard or felt  
while it is working, but this is normal. Slippery road  
conditions may exist if this message is displayed, so  
adjust your driving accordingly.  
to L (Low), the indicator/warning light comes on  
and stays on. To turn the system back on, move  
the shift lever back to a position other than L (Low).  
The indicator/warning light should go off.  
.
The indicator/warning light will come on when the  
parking brake is set with the engine running, and it  
will stay on if the parking brake does not release  
fully. If the transmission shift lever is in any position  
other than L (Low) and the indicator/warning light  
stays on after the parking brake is fully released,  
there is a problem with the system.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control when the ETS begins  
to limit wheel spin, the cruise control will automatically  
disengage. The cruise control can be re-engaged when  
road conditions allow. See Cruise Control on page 46.  
.
If the traction control system is affected by an  
engine related problem, the system will turn off  
and the indicator/warning light will come on.  
5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the ETS indicator/warning light comes on and  
stays on for an extended period of time when the  
transmission shift lever is in any position other than  
L (Low), the vehicle may need service.  
When the system is turned off, the ETS indicator/  
warning light will come on and stay on and the  
TRACTION OFF message will be displayed when  
the gear shift is in L (Low). The indicator/warning light  
and message will not come on when the gear shift is in  
R (Reverse). If the ETS is limiting wheel spin when the  
transmission is shifted to L (Low) or R (Reverse) to  
turn the system off, the indicator/warning light and  
TRACTION OFF will come on in L (Low). But the  
system will not turn off right away. It will wait until  
there is no longer a current need to limit wheel spin.  
See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 440 for  
more information on the messages associated with  
this light.  
When this light is on solid, the system will not limit  
wheel spin. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
Check the DIC messaging to determine whether it is  
because of the driver turning off the system, or that the  
system may not be working properly and the vehicle  
requires service. When this light is turned on, either the  
SERVICE TRACTION or TRACTION OFF message will  
be displayed.  
See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 440 for  
more information on the messages associated with  
this light.  
The system can be turned back on at any time by  
shifting to D (Automatic Overdrive) or I (Intermediate).  
The ETS indicator/warning light should go off.  
To limit wheel spin, especially in slippery road  
conditions, ETS should always be left on. But the  
system can be turned off if needed.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
the vehicle's performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 64 for more information.  
To turn the system off, shift to L (Low) or R (Reverse).  
5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The electric power steering system does not require  
regular maintenance. If you suspect steering system  
problems and/or the POWER STEERING message  
comes on, contact your dealer/retailer for service  
repairs. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
Limited-Slip Differential  
Vehicles with a limited-slip differential can give more  
traction on snow, mud, ice, sand or gravel. It works like  
a standard axle most of the time, but when traction is  
low, this feature allows the drive wheel with the most  
traction to move the vehicle. The limited slip design  
has minimal impact to the steering feel, but boosts the  
traction performance under all conditions.  
page 440  
.
Steering Tips  
It is important to take curves at a reasonable speed.  
Traction in a curve depends on the condition of the tires  
and the road surface, the angle at which the curve is  
banked, and vehicle speed. While in a curve, speed is  
the one factor that can be controlled.  
Steering  
Electric Power Steering  
If the engine stalls while driving, the power steering  
assist system will continue to operate until you are able  
to stop the vehicle. If power steering assist is lost  
because the electric power steering system is not  
functioning, the vehicle can be steered but it will take  
more effort.  
If there is a need to reduce speed, do it before entering  
the curve, while the front wheels are straight.  
Try to adjust the speed so you can drive through the  
curve. Maintain a reasonable, steady speed. Wait to  
accelerate until out of the curve, and then accelerate  
gently into the straightaway.  
If you turn the steering wheel in either direction several  
times until it stops, or hold the steering wheel in the  
stopped position for an extended amount of time, you  
may notice a reduced amount of power steering assist.  
The normal amount of power steering assist should  
return shortly after a few normal steering movements.  
5-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Steering in Emergencies  
There are times when steering can be more effective  
than braking. For example, you come over a hill and  
find a truck stopped in your lane, or a car suddenly  
pulls out from nowhere, or a child darts out from  
between parked cars and stops right in front of you.  
These problems can be avoided by braking if you  
can stop in time. But sometimes you cannot stop in time  
because there is no room. That is the time for evasive  
action steering around the problem.  
The vehicle can perform very well in emergencies like  
these. First apply the brakes but, unless the vehicle  
has antilock brakes, not enough to lock the wheels.  
See Braking on page 53. It is better to remove as  
much speed as possible from a collision. Then steer  
around the problem, to the left or right depending on  
the space available.  
An emergency like this requires close attention and a  
quick decision. If holding the steering wheel at the  
recommended 9 and 3 o'clock positions, it can be  
turned a full 180 degrees very quickly without removing  
either hand. But you have to act fast, steer quickly, and  
just as quickly straighten the wheel once you have  
avoided the object.  
The fact that such emergency situations are always  
possible is a good reason to practice defensive driving  
at all times and wear safety belts properly.  
5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Off-Road Recovery  
Passing  
The vehicle's right wheels can drop off the edge of a  
road onto the shoulder while driving.  
Passing another vehicle on a two-lane road can be  
dangerous. To reduce the risk of danger while passing:  
.
Look down the road, to the sides, and to  
crossroads for situations that might affect a  
successful pass. If in doubt, wait.  
.
Watch for traffic signs, pavement markings, and  
lines that could indicate a turn or an intersection.  
Never cross a solid or doublesolid line on your  
side of the lane.  
.
Do not get too close to the vehicle you want to  
pass. Doing so can reduce your visibility.  
.
Wait your turn to pass a slow vehicle.  
.
When you are being passed, ease to the right.  
Loss of Control  
Let us review what driving experts say about what  
happens when the three control systems brakes,  
steering, and acceleration do not have enough  
friction where the tires meet the road to do what the  
driver has asked.  
If the level of the shoulder is only slightly below the  
pavement, recovery should be fairly easy. Ease off the  
accelerator and then, if there is nothing in the way, steer  
so that the vehicle straddles the edge of the pavement.  
Turn the steering wheel 8 to 13 cm (3 to 5 inches),  
about one-eighth turn, until the right front tire contacts  
the pavement edge. Then turn the steering wheel to go  
straight down the roadway.  
In any emergency, do not give up. Keep trying to steer  
and constantly seek an escape route or area of less  
danger.  
5-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC), the  
ESC might activate. See Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC) on page 56.  
Skidding  
In a skid, a driver can lose control of the vehicle.  
Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking  
reasonable care suited to existing conditions, and by  
not overdriving those conditions. But skids are always  
possible.  
Of course, traction is reduced when water, snow, ice,  
gravel, or other material is on the road. For safety, slow  
down and adjust your driving to these conditions. It is  
important to slow down on slippery surfaces because  
stopping distance will be longer and vehicle control  
more limited.  
The three types of skids correspond to the vehicle's  
three control systems. In the braking skid, the wheels  
are not rolling. In the steering or cornering skid, too  
much speed or steering in a curve causes tires to slip  
and lose cornering force. And in the acceleration skid,  
too much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin.  
While driving on a surface with reduced traction, try  
your best to avoid sudden steering, acceleration,  
or braking, including reducing vehicle speed by shifting  
to a lower gear. Any sudden changes could cause the  
tires to slide. You may not realize the surface is slippery  
until the vehicle is skidding. Learn to recognize warning  
clues such as enough water, ice, or packed snow on  
the road to make a mirrored surface and slow down  
when you have any doubt.  
If the vehicle has the Traction Control System (TCS) or  
the Enhanced Traction System (ETS), remember: It  
helps to avoid only the acceleration skid. See Traction  
Control System (TCS) on page 59 or Enhanced  
Traction System (ETS) on page 512. If the vehicle  
does not have TCS or ETS, or if the system is off, then  
an acceleration skid is best handled by easing your foot  
off the accelerator pedal.  
If the vehicle has the Antilock Brake System (ABS),  
remember: It helps avoid only the braking skid. If the  
vehicle does not have ABS, then in a braking skid,  
where the wheels are no longer rolling, release enough  
pressure on the brakes to get the wheels rolling again.  
This restores steering control. Push the brake pedal  
down steadily when you have to stop suddenly. As long  
as the wheels are rolling, you will have steering control.  
If the vehicle starts to slide, ease your foot off the  
accelerator pedal and quickly steer the way you want  
the vehicle to go. If you start steering quickly enough,  
the vehicle may straighten out. Always be ready for a  
second skid if it occurs.  
5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
.
.
Watch for animals.  
Racing or Other Competitive Driving  
When tired, pull off the road.  
Do not wear sunglasses.  
See your warranty book before using your vehicle for  
racing or other competitive driving. After reviewing your  
warranty book, please see the GM Performance Parts  
website or catalog and contact the race sanctioning  
bodies, for example Sports Car Club of America  
(SCCA) or Grand American, for parts and equipment  
required for racing or other competitive driving.  
Avoid staring directly into approaching headlamps.  
Keep the windshield and all glass on your vehicle  
clean inside and out.  
.
Keep your eyes moving, especially during turns or  
curves.  
Driving at Night  
No one can see as well at night as in the daytime.  
But, as we get older, these differences increase.  
A 50-year-old driver might need at least twice as much  
light to see the same thing at night as a 20-year-old.  
Night driving is more dangerous than day driving  
because some drivers are likely to be impaired by  
alcohol or drugs, with night vision problems, or by  
fatigue.  
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads  
Night driving tips include:  
Rain and wet roads can reduce vehicle traction and  
affect your ability to stop and accelerate. Always drive  
slower in these types of driving conditions and avoid  
driving through large puddles and deepstanding or  
flowing water.  
.
Drive defensively.  
.
Do not drink and drive.  
.
Reduce headlamp glare by adjusting the inside  
rearview mirror.  
.
Slow down and keep more space between you and  
other vehicles because headlamps can only light  
up so much road ahead.  
5-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hydroplaning  
WARNING:  
{
Hydroplaning is dangerous. Water can build up under  
your vehicle's tires so they actually ride on the water.  
This can happen if the road is wet enough and you are  
going fast enough. When your vehicle is hydroplaning, it  
has little or no contact with the road.  
Wet brakes can cause crashes. They might not  
work as well in a quick stop and could cause  
pulling to one side. You could lose control of the  
vehicle.  
There is no hard and fast rule about hydroplaning. The  
best advice is to slow down when the road is wet.  
After driving through a large puddle of water or a  
car/vehicle wash, lightly apply the brake pedal  
until the brakes work normally.  
Other Rainy Weather Tips  
Besides slowing down, other wet weather driving tips  
include:  
Flowing or rushing water creates strong forces.  
Driving through flowing water could cause your  
vehicle to be carried away. If this happens, you  
and other vehicle occupants could drown. Do not  
ignore police warnings and be very cautious about  
trying to drive through flowing water.  
.
Allow extra following distance.  
.
Pass with caution.  
.
.
.
Keep windshield wiping equipment in good shape.  
Keep the windshield washer fluid reservoir filled.  
Have good tires with proper tread depth. See Tires  
on page 657  
.
.
Turn off cruise control.  
5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other driving tips include:  
Before Leaving on a Long Trip  
To prepare your vehicle for a long trip, consider having  
it serviced by your dealer/retailer before departing.  
.
Keep the vehicle well ventilated.  
.
Keep interior temperature cool.  
.
Keep your eyes moving scan the road  
ahead and to the sides.  
Things to check on your own include:  
.
Windshield Washer Fluid: Reservoir full?  
.
Check the rearview mirror and vehicle  
instruments often.  
Windows clean inside and outside?  
.
Wiper Blades: In good shape?  
.
Fuel, Engine Oil, Other Fluids: All levels checked?  
Hill and Mountain Roads  
Driving on steep hills or through mountains is different  
than driving on flat or rolling terrain. Tips for driving in  
these conditions include:  
.
Lamps: Do they all work and are lenses clean?  
.
Tires: Are treads good? Are tires inflated to  
recommended pressure?  
.
.
Weather and Maps: Safe to travel?  
Have up-to-date maps?  
Keep the vehicle serviced and in good shape.  
.
Check all fluid levels and brakes, tires, cooling  
system, and transmission.  
Highway Hypnosis  
.
Going down steep or long hills, shift to a  
Always be alert and pay attention to your surroundings  
while driving. If you become tired or sleepy, find a safe  
place to park your vehicle and rest.  
lower gear.  
5-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
You would then have poor braking or even none  
going down a hill. You could crash. Always have  
the engine running and the vehicle in gear when  
going downhill.  
If you do not shift down, the brakes could get so  
hot that they would not work well. You would then  
have poor braking or even none going down a hill.  
You could crash. Shift down to let the engine  
assist the brakes on a steep downhill slope.  
.
Stay in your own lane. Do not swing wide or cut  
across the center of the road. Drive at speeds that  
let you stay in your own lane.  
WARNING:  
{
.
.
Top of hills: Be alert something could be in your  
lane (stalled car, accident).  
Coasting downhill in N (Neutral) or with the  
ignition off is dangerous. The brakes will have  
to do all the work of slowing down and they  
could get so hot that they would not work well.  
Pay attention to special road signs (falling rocks  
area, winding roads, long grades, passing or  
no-passing zones) and take appropriate action.  
(Continued)  
5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Without ABS, if the vehicle begins to slide, let up on the  
brake pedal a little and apply steady pedal pressure to  
get the most traction. On vehicles without ABS, braking  
so hard that the wheels stop rolling can cause the  
vehicle to slide brake so the wheels always keep  
rolling so you can still steer.  
Winter Driving  
Driving on Snow or Ice  
Drive carefully when there is snow or ice between the  
tires and the road, creating less traction or grip. Wet ice  
can occur at about 0°C (32°F) when freezing rain  
begins to fall, resulting in even less traction. Avoid  
driving on wet ice or in freezing rain until roads can be  
treated with salt or sand.  
Allow greater following distance on any slippery road  
and watch for slippery spots. Icy patches can occur  
on otherwise clear roads in shaded areas. The surface  
of a curve or an overpass can remain icy when the  
surrounding roads are clear. Avoid sudden steering  
maneuvers and braking while on ice.  
Drive with caution, whatever the condition. Accelerate  
gently so traction is not lost. Accelerating too quickly  
causes the wheels to spin and makes the surface under  
the tires slick, so there is even less traction.  
Turn off cruise control, if equipped, on slippery surfaces.  
Try not to break the fragile traction. If you accelerate too  
fast, the drive wheels will spin and polish the surface  
under the tires even more.  
Blizzard Conditions  
Being stuck in snow can be in a serious situation. Stay  
with the vehicle unless there is help nearby. If possible,  
If the vehicle has the Traction Control System (TCS) on  
page 59 or Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on  
page 512, it improves the ability to accelerate on  
slippery roads, but slow down and adjust your driving to  
the road conditions. When driving through deep snow,  
turn off the ETS, if equipped, to help maintain vehicle  
motion at lower speeds.  
use the Roadside Assistance Program on page 87  
To get help and keep everyone in the vehicle safe:  
.
.
Turn on the Hazard Warning Flashers on  
page 43  
.
.
Tie a red cloth to an outside mirror.  
The Antilock Brake System (ABS) on page 54  
improves vehicle stability during hard stops on a  
slippery roads, but whether the vehicle has ABS or not,  
apply the brakes sooner than when on dry pavement.  
5-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
Snow can trap engine exhaust under the vehicle.  
This may cause exhaust gases to get inside.  
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
For more information about carbon monoxide, see  
Engine Exhaust on page 335.  
Snow can trap exhaust gases under your vehicle.  
This can cause deadly CO (carbon monoxide) gas  
to get inside. CO could overcome you and kill you.  
You cannot see it or smell it, so you might not  
know it is in your vehicle. Clear away snow from  
around the base of your vehicle, especially any  
that is blocking the exhaust.  
If the vehicle is stuck in the snow:  
.
Clear away snow from around the base of  
your vehicle, especially any that is blocking  
the exhaust pipe.  
.
Check again from time to time to be sure  
Run the engine for short periods only as needed to  
keep warm, but be careful.  
snow does not collect there.  
.
Open a window about 5 cm (two inches) on  
the side of the vehicle that is away from the  
wind to bring in fresh air.  
To save fuel, run the engine for only short periods as  
needed to warm the vehicle and then shut the engine  
off and close the window most of the way to save heat.  
Repeat this until help arrives but only when you feel  
really uncomfortable from the cold. Moving about to  
keep warm also helps.  
.
Fully open the air outlets on or under the  
instrument panel.  
.
Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting  
If it takes some time for help to arrive, now and then  
when you run the engine, push the accelerator pedal  
slightly so the engine runs faster than the idle speed.  
This keeps the battery charged to restart the vehicle  
and to signal for help with the headlamps. Do this as  
little as possible to save fuel.  
that circulates the air inside the vehicle and  
set the fan speed to the highest setting.  
See Climate Control System in the Index.  
(Continued)  
5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand,  
Mud, Ice, or Snow  
Slowly and cautiously spin the wheels to free the  
vehicle when stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow. See  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out on page 524.  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out  
Turn the steering wheel left and right to clear the area  
around the front wheels. Turn off any traction system.  
Shift back and forth between R (Reverse) and a forward  
gear, or with a manual transmission, between 1 (First) or  
2 (Second) and R (Reverse), spinning the wheels as  
little as possible. To prevent transmission wear, wait  
until the wheels stop spinning before shifting gears.  
Release the accelerator pedal while shifting, and press  
lightly on the accelerator pedal when the transmission is  
in gear. Slowly spinning the wheels in the forward and  
reverse directions causes a rocking motion that could  
free the vehicle. If that does not get the vehicle out after  
a few tries, it might need to be towed out. If the vehicle  
does need to be towed out, see Towing Your Vehicle on  
If the vehicle has a traction system, it can often help to  
free a stuck vehicle. Refer to the vehicle's traction  
system in the Index. If stuck too severely for the traction  
system to free the vehicle, turn the traction system off  
and use the rocking method.  
WARNING:  
{
page 530  
.
If the vehicle's tires spin at high speed, they  
can explode, and you or others could be injured.  
The vehicle can overheat, causing an engine  
compartment fire or other damage. Spin the  
wheels as little as possible and avoid going above  
55 km/h (35 mph) as shown on the speedometer.  
For information about using tire chains on the vehicle,  
see Tire Chains on page 682.  
5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire and Loading Information Label  
Loading the Vehicle  
It is very important to know how much weight your  
vehicle can carry. This weight is called the vehicle  
capacity weight and includes the weight of all  
occupants, cargo and all nonfactoryinstalled  
options. Two labels on your vehicle show how  
much weight it may properly carry, the Tire and  
Loading Information label and the Certification  
label.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than the  
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),  
or either the maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do, parts  
on the vehicle can break, and it can change  
the way the vehicle handles. These could  
cause you to lose control and crash. Also,  
overloading can shorten the life of the  
vehicle.  
Label Example  
A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information  
label is attached to the vehicle's center pillar  
(B-pillar). With the driver door open, you will find  
the label either attached above the door lock post  
for a two door vehicle or below the door lock post  
for a four door vehicle. The Tire and Loading  
Information label shows the number of occupant  
seating positions (A), and the maximum vehicle  
capacity weight (B) in kilograms and pounds.  
5-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Tire and Loading Information label also  
shows the tire size of the original equipment  
tires (C) and the recommended cold tire inflation  
pressures (D). For more information on tires and  
inflation see Tires on page 657 and Inflation - Tire  
4. The resulting figure equals the available  
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity.  
For example, if the XXXamount equals  
1400 lbs and there will be five 150 lb  
passengers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load capacity is  
650 lbs (1400 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs).  
Pressure on page 666  
.
There is also important loading information on the  
Certification label. It tells you the Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) and the Gross Axle  
Weight Rating (GAWR) for the front and rear axle;  
see Certification Labellater in this section.  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage  
and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That  
weight may not safely exceed the available  
cargo and luggage load capacity calculated  
in Step 4.  
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, the load  
from your trailer will be transferred to your  
vehicle. Consult this manual to determine  
how this reduces the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
1. Locate the statement The combined weight  
of occupants and cargo should never exceed  
XXX kg or XXX lbson your vehicle's placard.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver  
and passengers that will be riding in your  
vehicle.  
If your vehicle can tow a trailer, see Towing a  
Trailer (Automatic Transmission) on page 533  
or Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) on  
page 539 for important information on towing  
a trailer, towing safety rules, and  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver  
and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs.  
trailering tips.  
5-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Example 1  
Description  
Example 2  
Description  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Vehicle Capacity  
Weight for  
Example 1 =  
Vehicle Capacity  
Weight for  
Example 2 =  
A
A
(453 kg)  
(453 kg)  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 150 lbs  
(68 kg) × 2 =  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 150 lbs  
(68 kg) × 5 =  
B
C
300 lbs (136 kg)  
700 lbs (317 kg)  
B
C
750 lbs (340 kg)  
250 lbs (113 kg)  
Available Occupant  
and Cargo Weight =  
Available Cargo  
Weight =  
5-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Refer to your vehicle's Tire and Loading  
Information label for specific information about  
your vehicle's capacity weight and seating  
positions. The combined weight of the driver,  
passengers, and cargo should never exceed  
your vehicle's capacity weight.  
Certification Label  
Example 3  
Description  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Vehicle Capacity  
Weight for  
Example 3 =  
A
(453 kg)  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 200 lbs  
(91 kg) × 5 =  
1,000 lbs  
(453 kg)  
B
C
Available Cargo  
Weight =  
0 lbs (0 kg)  
A vehicle specific Certification label, found on  
the rear edge of the driver door, tells you the  
gross weight capacity of your vehicle, called  
the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR).  
5-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle,  
all occupants, fuel, and cargo. Never exceed the  
GVWR for your vehicle, or the Gross Axle Weight  
Rating (GAWR) for either the front or rear axle.  
WARNING:  
{
Things you put inside the vehicle can strike  
and injure people in a sudden stop or turn,  
or in a crash.  
If there is a heavy load, it should be spread out.  
.
Put things in the cargo area of the  
WARNING:  
{
vehicle. In the cargo area, put them as far  
forward as you can. Try to spread the  
weight evenly.  
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than the  
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),  
or either the maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do, parts  
on the vehicle can break, and it can change  
the way the vehicle handles. These could  
cause you to lose control and crash. Also,  
overloading can shorten the life of the  
vehicle.  
.
Never stack heavier things, like  
suitcases, inside the vehicle so that some  
of them are above the tops of the seats.  
.
Do not leave an unsecured child restraint  
in the vehicle.  
.
When you carry something inside the  
vehicle, secure it whenever you can.  
.
Do not leave a seat folded down unless  
you need to.  
If you put things inside your vehicle like  
suitcases, tools, packages, or anything  
else they will go as fast as the vehicle goes.  
If you have to stop or turn quickly, or if there is a  
crash, they will keep going.  
5-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here are some important things to consider before  
recreational vehicle towing:  
Towing  
.
What is the towing capacity of the towing vehicle?  
Towing Your Vehicle  
Be sure to read the tow vehicle manufacturer's  
recommendations.  
To avoid damage, the disabled vehicle should be towed  
with all four wheels off the ground. Consult your dealer/  
retailer or a professional towing service if the disabled  
vehicle must be towed. See Roadside Assistance  
Program on page 87.  
.
What is the distance that will be travelled? Some  
vehicles have restrictions on how far and how long  
they can tow.  
.
Is the proper towing equipment going to be used?  
To tow the vehicle behind another vehicle for  
recreational purposes, such as behind a motorhome,  
see Recreational Vehicle Towingfollowing.  
See your dealer/retailer or trailering professional  
for additional advice and equipment  
recommendations.  
.
Is the vehicle ready to be towed? Just as preparing  
Recreational Vehicle Towing  
the vehicle for a long trip, make sure the vehicle is  
prepared to be towed. See Before Leaving on a  
Long Trip on page 520.  
Recreational vehicle towing means towing the vehicle  
behind another vehicle such as behind a motorhome.  
The two most common types of recreational vehicle  
towing are known as dinghy towing and dolly towing.  
Dinghy towing is towing the vehicle with all four wheels  
on the ground. Dolly towing is towing the vehicle with  
two wheels on the ground and two wheels up on a  
device known as a dolly.  
5-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Shift an automatic transmission to N (Neutral) or a  
manual transmission to Neutral.  
Dinghy Towing  
Dinghy Towing From the Front  
4. Release the parking brake.  
To prevent the battery from draining while the vehicle is  
being towed, remove the following fuse from the floor  
console fuse block: 8 (Ignition Switch, PASSKey® III+).  
See Floor Console Fuse Block on page 6125 for more  
information.  
Remember to reinstall the fuse once the destination has  
been reached.  
Notice: If 105 km/h (65 mph) is exceeded while  
towing the vehicle, it could be damaged. Never  
exceed 105 km/h (65 mph) while towing the vehicle.  
The vehicle may be dinghy towed from the front with all  
four wheels on the ground following these steps:  
1. Set the parking brake.  
2. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY to  
unlock the steering wheel.  
5-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dinghy Towing From the Rear  
Dolly Towing  
The vehicle cannot be dolly towed, but can be dinghy  
towed. See Dinghy Towingearlier in this section.  
Notice: Towing the vehicle from the rear could  
damage it. Also, repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Never have the vehicle towed  
from the rear.  
Notice: Dolly towing your vehicle may cause  
damage because of reduced ground clearance.  
Always tow your vehicle using the dinghy towing  
procedure listed in this section or put your vehicle  
on a flatbed truck.  
5-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trailering is different than just driving the vehicle  
by itself. Trailering means changes in handling,  
acceleration, braking, durability and fuel economy.  
Successful, safe trailering takes correct equipment,  
and it has to be used properly.  
Towing a Trailer  
(Automatic Transmission)  
WARNING:  
{
The following information has many time-tested,  
important trailering tips and safety rules. Many of  
these are important for your safety and that of your  
passengers. So please read this section carefully  
before pulling a trailer.  
The driver can lose control when pulling a trailer if  
the correct equipment is not used or the vehicle is  
not driven properly. For example, if the trailer is  
too heavy, the brakes may not work well or  
even at all. The driver and passengers could be  
seriously injured. The vehicle may also be  
damaged; the resulting repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Pull a trailer only  
if all the steps in this section have been followed.  
Ask your dealer/retailer for advice and information  
about towing a trailer with the vehicle.  
Load-pulling components such as the engine,  
transmission, rear axle, wheel assemblies and tires are  
forced to work harder against the drag of the added  
weight. The engine is required to operate at relatively  
higher speeds and under greater loads, generating  
extra heat. The trailer also adds considerably to wind  
resistance, increasing the pulling requirements.  
The vehicle can tow a trailer if it is equipped with the  
proper trailer towing equipment.  
To identify the trailering capacity of the vehicle, read the  
information in Weight of the Trailerthat appears later  
in this section.  
5-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Three important considerations have to do with weight:  
Pulling A Trailer  
If you do, here are some important points:  
.
The weight of the trailer  
.
The weight of the trailer tongue  
.
There are many different laws, including speed  
.
limit restrictions, having to do with trailering. Make  
sure the rig will be legal, not only where you live  
but also where you will be driving. A good source  
for this information can be state or provincial  
police.  
The total weight on the vehicle's tires  
Weight of the Trailer  
How heavy can a trailer safely be?  
It should never weigh more than 1,000 lbs (450 kg). But  
even that can be too heavy.  
.
Do not tow a trailer at all during the first  
1,000 miles (1 600 km) the new vehicle is driven.  
The engine, transmission or other parts could be  
damaged.  
It depends on how the rig is used. For example, speed,  
altitude, road grades, outside temperature and how  
much the vehicle is used to pull a trailer are all  
important. It can depend on any special equipment on  
the vehicle, and the amount of tongue weight the  
vehicle can carry. See Weight of the Trailer Tongue”  
later in this section for more information.  
.
Then, during the first 500 miles (800 km) that a  
trailer is towed, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h)  
and do not make starts at full throttle. This helps  
the engine and other parts of the vehicle wear in at  
the heavier loads.  
Maximum trailer weight is calculated assuming only the  
driver is in the tow vehicle and it has all the required  
trailering equipment. The weight of additional optional  
equipment, passengers and cargo in the tow vehicle  
must be subtracted from the maximum trailer weight.  
.
Obey speed limit restrictions when towing a trailer.  
Do not drive faster than the maximum posted  
speed for trailers, or no more than 55 mph  
(90 km/h), to save wear on the vehicle's parts.  
.
Do not tow when the outside air temperature is  
above 100°F (38°C).  
Ask your dealer/retailer for our trailering information or  
advice, or write us at our Customer Assistance Offices.  
See Customer Assistance Offices on page 86 for  
more information.  
.
Do not tow more than 1,000 miles (1 600 km)  
per year.  
5-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not exceed the maximum allowable tongue weight  
for the vehicle. Choose the shortest hitch extension that  
will position the hitch ball closest to the vehicle. This will  
help reduce the effect of trailer tongue weight on the  
rear axle.  
Weight of the Trailer Tongue  
The tongue load (A) of any trailer is an important weight  
to measure because it affects the total gross weight of  
the vehicle. The Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) includes  
the curb weight of the vehicle, any cargo carried in it,  
and the people who will be riding in the vehicle. If there  
are a lot of options, equipment, passengers or cargo in  
the vehicle, it will reduce the tongue weight the vehicle  
can carry, which will also reduce the trailer weight the  
vehicle can tow. If towing a trailer, the tongue load must  
be added to the GVW because the vehicle will be  
carrying that weight, too. See Loading the Vehicle on  
page 525 for more information about the vehicle's  
maximum load capacity.  
After loading the trailer, weigh the trailer and then the  
tongue, separately, to see if the weights are proper.  
If they are not, adjustments might be made by moving  
some items around in the trailer.  
Total Weight on the Vehicle's Tires  
Be sure the vehicle's tires are inflated to the upper limit  
for cold tires. These numbers can be found on the  
Tire-Loading Information label. See Loading the Vehicle  
on page 525. Make sure not to go over the GVW limit  
for the vehicle, or the GAWR, including the weight of the  
trailer tongue.  
If using a weight-carrying hitch, the trailer tongue (A)  
should weigh 10 to 15 percent of the total loaded trailer  
weight (B).  
5-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hitches  
Trailer Brakes  
It is important to have the correct hitch equipment.  
Crosswinds, large trucks going by and rough roads  
are a few reasons why the right hitch is needed.  
Does the trailer have its own brakes? Be sure to read  
and follow the instructions for the trailer brakes so they  
are installed, adjusted and maintained properly.  
.
The rear bumper on the vehicle is not intended  
Driving with a Trailer  
for hitches. Do not attach rental hitches or  
other bumper-type hitches to it. Use only a  
frame-mounted hitch that does not attach to  
the bumper.  
Towing a trailer requires a certain amount of  
experience. Get to know the rig before setting out for  
the open road. Get acquainted with the feel of handling  
and braking with the added weight of the trailer. And  
always keep in mind that the vehicle you are driving is  
now longer and not as responsive as the vehicle is by  
itself.  
.
Will there be any holes in the body of the vehicle  
after installing a trailer hitch? If there are, then be  
sure to seal the holes later when the hitch is  
removed. If the holes are not sealed, deadly  
carbon monoxide (CO) from exhaust can get into  
the vehicle. See Engine Exhaust on page 335  
Dirt and water can also enter the vehicle.  
Before starting, check all trailer hitch parts and  
attachments, safety chains, electrical connectors,  
lamps, tires and mirror adjustments. If the trailer has  
electric brakes, start the vehicle and trailer moving and  
then apply the trailer brake controller by hand to be sure  
the brakes are working. This checks the electrical  
connection at the same time.  
.
Safety Chains  
Always attach chains between the vehicle and the  
trailer. Cross the safety chains under the tongue of the  
trailer to help prevent the tongue from contacting the  
road if it becomes separated from the hitch. Always  
leave just enough slack so the rig can turn. Never allow  
safety chains to drag on the ground.  
During the trip, check occasionally to be sure that the  
load is secure, and that the lamps and any trailer  
brakes are still working.  
5-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Following Distance  
Making Turns  
Stay at least twice as far behind the vehicle ahead as  
you would when driving the vehicle without a trailer.  
This can help to avoid situations that require heavy  
braking and sudden turns.  
Notice: Making very sharp turns while trailering  
could cause the trailer to come in contact with  
the vehicle. The vehicle could be damaged.  
Avoid making very sharp turns while trailering.  
When turning with a trailer, make wider turns than  
normal. Do this so the trailer will not strike soft  
shoulders, curbs, road signs, trees or other objects.  
Avoid jerky or sudden maneuvers. Signal well in  
advance.  
Passing  
More passing distance is needed when towing a trailer.  
Because the rig is longer, it is necessary to go much  
farther beyond the passed vehicle before returning to  
the lane.  
Turn Signals When Towing a Trailer  
Backing Up  
The arrows on the instrument panel flash whenever  
signaling a turn or lane change. Properly hooked up,  
the trailer lamps also flash, telling other drivers the  
vehicle is turning, changing lanes or stopping.  
Hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand.  
Then, to move the trailer to the left, move that hand to  
the left. To move the trailer to the right, move your hand  
to the right. Always back up slowly and, if possible,  
have someone guide you.  
When towing a trailer, the arrows on the instrument  
panel flash for turns even if the bulbs on the trailer are  
burned out. For this reason you may think other drivers  
are seeing the signal when they are not. It is important  
to check occasionally to be sure the trailer bulbs are  
still working.  
5-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving on Grades  
Parking on Hills  
Notice: Do not tow on steep continuous grades  
exceeding 6 miles (9.6 km). Extended, higher than  
normal engine and transmission temperatures may  
result and damage the vehicle. Frequent stops are  
very important to allow the engine and transmission  
to cool.  
WARNING:  
{
Parking the vehicle on a hill with the trailer  
attached can be dangerous. If something goes  
wrong, the rig could start to move. People can be  
injured, and both the vehicle and the trailer can be  
damaged. When possible, always park the rig on  
a flat surface.  
Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear before starting  
down a long or steep downgrade. If the transmission is  
not shifted down, the brakes might have to be used so  
much that they would get hot and no longer work well.  
Pay attention to the engine coolant gauge. If the  
indicator is in the red area, turn off the air conditioning  
to reduce engine load. See Engine Overheating on  
If parking the rig on a hill:  
1. Press the brake pedal, but do not shift into P (Park)  
yet. Turn the wheels into the curb if facing downhill  
or into traffic if facing uphill.  
page 634  
.
When towing under severe conditions such as hot  
ambient temperatures or steep grades, the vehicle may  
experience more transmission shifting. A COOLING  
MODE ON message may also appear in the DIC. This  
alerts the driver that the shifting mode is in progress  
and is aiding engine cooling. See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 440 for more information.  
2. Have someone place chocks under the trailer  
wheels.  
3. When the wheel chocks are in place, release the  
brake pedal until the chocks absorb the load.  
4. Reapply the brake pedal. Then apply the parking  
brake and shift into P (Park).  
5. Release the brake pedal.  
5-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leaving After Parking on a Hill  
Engine Cooling When Trailer Towing  
1. Apply and hold the brake pedal while you:  
The cooling system may temporarily overheat during  
severe operating conditions. See Engine Overheating  
.
Start the engine.  
on page 634  
.
.
Shift into a gear.  
.
Release the parking brake.  
Towing a Trailer  
(Manual Transmission)  
Do not tow a trailer if the vehicle is equipped with a  
manual transmission.  
2. Let up on the brake pedal.  
3. Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of the chocks.  
4. Stop and have someone pick up and store the  
chocks.  
Maintenance When Trailer Towing  
The vehicle needs service more often when pulling a  
trailer. See Scheduled Maintenance on page 73 for  
more on this. Things that are especially important in  
trailer operation are automatic transmission fluid, engine  
oil, axle lubricant, belts, cooling system and brake  
system. It is a good idea to inspect these before and  
during the trip.  
Check periodically to see that all hitch nuts and bolts  
are tight.  
5-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
5-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter (2.2L Engine) . . . . . . . . 6-25  
Automatic Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Manual Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Hydraulic Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29  
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34  
Windshield Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-36  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-41  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-42  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
California Proposition 65 Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
California Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of the  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gasoline Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker, and  
Parking Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-50  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) . . . . . 6-51  
Taillamps and Turn Signal Lamps (Coupe) . . . . . 6-52  
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps and Back-up  
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13  
Engine Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter (2.0L Turbo  
Lamps (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53  
Back-Up Lamps (Coupe) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54  
License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-55  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-55  
Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . 6-56  
6-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-57  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare  
Tire (SS Model) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-102  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . 6-111  
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-114  
Winter Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-58  
Tire Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-59  
Tire Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-63  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-66  
Tire Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-67  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
Tire Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-75  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-76  
Different Size Tires and Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-80  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-80  
Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit Storage . . . . . . 6-91  
Changing a Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-92  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare  
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-115  
Interior Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-115  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-116  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Care of Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-119  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-119  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-120  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels  
and Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-121  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-122  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-122  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-122  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-122  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-123  
Tire (All Models Except SS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98  
6-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-123  
Power Windows and Other Power Options . . . 6-124  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-125  
Floor Console Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-125  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-127  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . 6-123  
Service Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-124  
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-124  
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-124  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-124  
Windshield Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-124  
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-131  
6-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories and Modifications  
Service  
When nondealer/nonretailer accessories are added  
to the vehicle, they can affect vehicle performance  
and safety, including such things as airbags, braking,  
stability, ride and handling, emissions systems,  
aerodynamics, durability, and electronic systems  
like antilock brakes, traction control, and stability  
control. Some of these accessories could even  
cause malfunction or damage not covered by  
the vehicle warranty.  
For service and parts needs, visit your dealer/retailer.  
You will receive genuine GM parts and GM-trained and  
supported service people.  
Genuine GM parts have one of these marks:  
Damage to vehicle components resulting from the  
installation or use of nonGM certified parts, including  
control module modifications, is not covered under the  
terms of the vehicle warranty and may affect remaining  
warranty coverage for affected parts.  
GM Accessories are designed to complement and  
function with other systems on the vehicle. Your GM  
dealer/retailer can accessorize the vehicle using  
genuine GM Accessories. When you go to your  
GM dealer/retailer and ask for GM Accessories,  
you will know that GM-trained and supported service  
technicians will perform the work using genuine GM  
Accessories.  
Also, see Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle on page 273.  
6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
California Proposition 65 Warning  
Doing Your Own Service Work  
WARNING:  
Most motor vehicles, including this one, contain and/  
or emit chemicals known to the State of California to  
cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive  
harm. Engine exhaust, many parts and systems, many  
fluids, and some component wear by-products contain  
and/or emit these chemicals.  
{
You can be injured and the vehicle could be  
damaged if you try to do service work on a vehicle  
without knowing enough about it.  
California Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements  
Certain types of automotive applications, such as  
airbag initiators, seat belt pretensioners, and lithium  
batteries contained in remote keyless transmitters,  
may contain perchlorate materials. Special handling  
may be necessary. For additional information, see  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
.
Be sure you have sufficient knowledge,  
experience, the proper replacement parts,  
and tools before attempting any vehicle  
maintenance task.  
.
Be sure to use the proper nuts, bolts, and  
other fasteners. English and metric fasteners  
can be easily confused. If the wrong fasteners  
are used, parts can later break or fall off.  
You could be hurt.  
If doing some of your own service work, use the proper  
service manual. It tells you much more about how to  
service the vehicle than this manual can. To order the  
proper service manual, see Service Publications  
Ordering Information on page 816.  
This vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting  
to do your own service work, see Servicing Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 272.  
6-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keep a record with all parts receipts and list the  
mileage and the date of any service work performed.  
See Maintenance Record on page 715.  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of  
the Vehicle  
Things added to the outside of the vehicle can affect  
the airflow around it. This can cause wind noise and  
can affect fuel economy and windshield washer  
performance. Check with your dealer/retailer before  
adding equipment to the outside of the vehicle.  
Fuel  
Use of the recommended fuel is an important part  
of the proper maintenance of this vehicle. To help  
keep the engine clean and maintain optimum vehicle  
performance, we recommend the use of gasoline  
advertised as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.  
The 8th digit of the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
shows the code letter or number that identifies the  
vehicle's engine. The VIN is at the top left of the  
instrument panel. See Vehicle Identification Number  
(VIN) on page 6123.  
Look for the TOP TIER label on the fuel pump to  
ensure gasoline meets enhanced detergency standards  
developed by auto companies. A list of marketers  
providing TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be  
found at www.toptiergas.com.  
6-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Gasoline Octane  
Gasoline Specifications  
If the vehicle has the 2.2L L4 engine (VIN Code 5),  
use regular unleaded gasoline with a posted octane  
rating of 87 or higher. If the octane rating is less than  
87, an audible knocking noise, commonly referred to  
as spark knock, might be heard when driving. If this  
occurs, use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher  
as soon as possible. If heavy knocking is heard when  
using gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, the engine  
needs service.  
At a minimum, gasoline should meet ASTM  
specification D 4814 in the United States or  
CAN/CGSB3.5 or 3.511 in Canada. Some gasolines  
contain an octane-enhancing additive called  
methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT).  
We recommend against the use of gasolines containing  
MMT. See Additives on page 68 for additional  
information.  
California Fuel  
If the vehicle has the 2.0L L4 engine (VIN Code X), use  
premium unleaded gasoline with a posted octane rating  
of 91 or higher. You can also use regular unleaded  
gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, but the vehicle's  
acceleration could be slightly reduced, and a slight  
audible knocking noise, commonly referred to as spark  
knock, might be heard. If the octane is less than 87, you  
might notice a heavy knocking noise when you drive.  
If this occurs, use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or  
higher as soon as possible. Otherwise, you could  
damage the engine. If heavy knocking is heard when  
using gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, the engine  
needs service.  
If the vehicle is certified to meet California Emissions  
Standards, it is designed to operate on fuels that meet  
California specifications. See the underhood emission  
control label. If this fuel is not available in states  
adopting California emissions standards, the vehicle  
will operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal  
specifications, but emission control system performance  
might be affected. The malfunction indicator lamp could  
turn on and the vehicle might fail a smogcheck test.  
See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 427. If this  
occurs, return to your authorized dealer/retailer for  
diagnosis. If it is determined that the condition is caused  
by the type of fuel used, repairs might not be covered  
by the vehicle warranty.  
6-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
oil change, can help clean deposits from fuel injectors  
and intake valves. GM Fuel System Treatment PLUS  
is the only gasoline additive recommended by General  
Motors.  
Additives  
To provide cleaner air, all gasolines in the United States  
are now required to contain additives that help prevent  
engine and fuel system deposits from forming, allowing  
the emission control system to work properly. In most  
cases, nothing should have to be added to the fuel.  
However, some gasolines contain only the minimum  
amount of additive required to meet U.S. Environmental  
Protection Agency regulations. To help keep fuel  
injectors and intake valves clean, or if the vehicle  
experiences problems due to dirty injectors or valves,  
look for gasoline that is advertised as TOP TIER  
Detergent Gasoline.  
Also, your dealer/retailer has additives that will help  
correct and prevent most depositrelated problems.  
Gasolines containing oxygenates, such as ethers  
and ethanol, and reformulated gasolines might be  
available in your area. We recommend that you use  
these gasolines, if they comply with the specifications  
described earlier. However, E85 (85% ethanol) and  
other fuels containing more than 10% ethanol must  
not be used in vehicles that were not designed for  
those fuels.  
For customers who do not use TOP TIER Detergent  
Gasoline regularly, one bottle of GM Fuel System  
Treatment PLUS, added to the fuel tank at every engine  
6-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: This vehicle was not designed for fuel that  
contains methanol. Do not use fuel containing  
methanol. It can corrode metal parts in the fuel  
system and also damage plastic and rubber parts.  
That damage would not be covered under the  
vehicle warranty.  
Fuels in Foreign Countries  
If you plan on driving in another country outside the  
United States or Canada, the proper fuel might be hard  
to find. Never use leaded gasoline or any other fuel  
not recommended in the previous text on fuel. Costly  
repairs caused by use of improper fuel would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low  
emissions can contain an octane-enhancing additive  
called methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl  
(MMT); ask the attendant where you buy gasoline  
whether the fuel contains MMT. We recommend against  
the use of such gasolines. Fuels containing MMT can  
reduce the life of spark plugs and the performance  
of the emission control system could be affected.  
The malfunction indicator lamp might turn on. If this  
occurs, return to your dealer/retailer for service.  
To check the fuel availability, ask an auto club,  
or contact a major oil company that does business  
in the country where you will be driving.  
6-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling the Tank  
WARNING:  
{
Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can  
cause bad injuries. To help avoid injuries to you  
and others, read and follow all the instructions  
on the fuel pump island. Turn off the engine  
when refueling. Do not smoke near fuel or when  
refueling the vehicle. Do not use cellular phones.  
Keep sparks, flames, and smoking materials away  
from fuel. Do not leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling the vehicle. This is against the law  
in some places. Do not re-enter the vehicle while  
pumping fuel. Keep children away from the fuel  
pump; never let children pump fuel.  
The tethered fuel cap is located behind a hinged fuel  
door on the passenger side of the vehicle.  
6-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To remove the fuel cap, turn it slowly counterclockwise.  
The fuel cap has a spring in it; if the cap is released too  
soon, it will spring back to the right.  
When replacing the fuel cap, turn it clockwise  
until it clicks. Make sure the cap is fully installed.  
The diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap  
has been left off or improperly installed. This would  
allow fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. See  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 427.  
While refueling, hang the tethered fuel cap from the  
hook on the fuel door.  
The CHECK GAS CAP message displays on the Driver  
Information Center (DIC) if the fuel cap is not properly  
installed. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 440 for more information.  
WARNING:  
{
Fuel can spray out on you if you open the fuel cap  
too quickly. If you spill fuel and then something  
ignites it, you could be badly burned. This spray  
can happen if the tank is nearly full, and is more  
likely in hot weather. Open the fuel cap slowly and  
wait for any hiss noise to stop. Then unscrew the  
cap all the way.  
WARNING:  
{
If a fire starts while you are refueling, do not  
remove the nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by  
shutting off the pump or by notifying the station  
attendant. Leave the area immediately.  
Be careful not to spill fuel. Do not top off or overfill the  
tank and wait a few seconds after you have finished  
pumping before removing the nozzle. Clean fuel from  
painted surfaces as soon as possible. See Washing  
Your Vehicle on page 6118.  
Notice: If you need a new fuel cap, be sure to  
get the right type. Your dealer/retailer can get one  
for you. If you get the wrong type, it may not fit  
properly. This may cause the malfunction indicator  
lamp to light and may damage the fuel tank and  
emissions system. See Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
on page 427  
.
6-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container  
WARNING:  
Checking Things Under  
the Hood  
{
WARNING:  
{
Never fill a portable fuel container while it is in  
the vehicle. Static electricity discharge from the  
container can ignite the fuel vapor. You can be  
badly burned and the vehicle damaged if this  
occurs. To help avoid injury to you and others:  
An electric fan under the hood can start up and  
injure you even when the engine is not running.  
Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any  
underhood electric fan.  
.
Dispense fuel only into approved containers.  
.
Do not fill a container while it is inside a  
vehicle, in a vehicle's trunk, pickup bed,  
or on any surface other than the ground.  
WARNING:  
{
.
Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the inside  
of the fill opening before operating the nozzle.  
Contact should be maintained until the filling is  
complete.  
Things that burn can get on hot engine parts and  
start a fire. These include liquids like fuel, oil,  
coolant, brake fluid, windshield washer and other  
fluids, and plastic or rubber. You or others could  
be burned. Be careful not to drop or spill things  
that will burn onto a hot engine.  
.
Do not smoke while pumping fuel.  
.
Do not use a cellular phone while  
pumping fuel.  
6-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hood Release  
To open the hood, do the following.  
1. Pull the interior hood  
release lever with  
this symbol on it.  
It is located under  
the instrument panel  
on the driver's side  
of the vehicle.  
2. Then go to the front of the vehicle and push the  
secondary hood release lever to the left. It is  
located under the front center of the hood toward  
the driver's side of the vehicle.  
3. After you have partially lifted the hood, a gas strut  
will automatically take over to lift and hold the hood  
in the fully open position.  
Before closing the hood, be sure all the filler caps  
are on properly. Lower the hood until the lifting  
force of the strut is reduced, then release the hood  
to latch fully. Check to make sure the hood is  
closed and repeat the process if necessary.  
6-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Compartment Overview  
When you open the hood on the 2.2L L4 engine, here is what you will see:  
6-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter (2.0L Turbo Engine) on  
page 623 or Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
(2.2L Engine) on page 625.  
E. Engine Compartment Fuse Block on page 6127.  
F. Remote Positive (+) Terminal. See Jump Starting  
on page 642  
G. Remote Negative () Terminal. See Jump Starting  
on page 642  
H. Engine Coolant Surge Tank. See Cooling System  
on page 628  
.
B. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See When to Add Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 617.  
.
C. Engine Oil Dipstick (Out of View). See Checking  
Engine Oilunder Engine Oil on page 617.  
.
D. Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir. See Brake  
Fluidunder Brakes on page 637 and Hydraulic  
Clutch on page 627.  
I. Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See Adding  
Washer Fluidunder Windshield Washer Fluid on  
page 636  
.
6-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When you open the hood on the 2.0L L4 engine, this is what you will see:  
6-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter (2.0L Turbo Engine) on  
page 623 or Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
(2.2L Engine) on page 625.  
Engine Oil  
Checking Engine Oil  
It is a good idea to check the engine oil level at each  
fuel fill. In order to get an accurate reading, the oil must  
be warm and the vehicle must be on level ground.  
B. Engine Oil Dipstick. See Checking Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 617.  
C. Engine Cooling Fan. See Cooling System on  
page 628  
.
The engine oil dipstick handle is a yellow loop.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614  
for the location of the engine oil dipstick.  
D. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See When to Add Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 617.  
E. Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir. See Brake  
Fluidunder Brakes on page 637 and Hydraulic  
Clutch on page 627.  
1. Turn off the engine and give the oil several minutes  
to drain back into the oil pan. If this is not done, the  
oil dipstick might not show the actual level.  
F. Engine Compartment Fuse Block on page 6127.  
2. Pull out the dipstick and clean it with a paper towel  
or cloth, then push it back in all the way. Remove it  
again, keeping the tip down, and check the level.  
G. Remote Positive (+) Terminal. See Jump Starting  
on page 642  
H. Remote Negative () Terminal. See Jump Starting  
on page 642  
I. Engine Coolant Surge Tank. See Cooling System  
on page 628  
.
.
.
J. Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See Adding  
Washer Fluidunder Windshield Washer Fluid on  
page 636  
.
6-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When to Add Engine Oil  
If the oil is below the MIN (minimum) mark, add  
at least one quart/liter of the recommended oil.  
This section explains what kind of oil to use.  
For engine oil crankcase capacity, see Capacities  
and Specifications on page 6131.  
2.2L Engine  
2.0L L4 Engine  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for  
the location of the engine oil fill cap.  
Notice: Do not add too much oil. If the engine has  
so much oil that the oil level gets above the upper  
mark that shows the proper operating range, the  
engine could be damaged.  
Add enough oil to put the level somewhere in the proper  
operating range. Push the dipstick all the way back in  
when through.  
6-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Oils meeting these  
What Kind of Engine Oil to Use  
requirements should have  
the starburst symbol on  
the container. This symbol  
indicates that the oil has  
been certified by the  
American Petroleum  
Institute (API).  
For Vehicles With the 2.2L L4 Engine  
Look for three things:  
.
GM6094M  
Use only an oil that meets GM Standard  
GM6094M.  
.
SAE 5W-30  
SAE 5W-30 is best for the vehicle. These numbers  
on an oil container show its viscosity, or thickness.  
Do not use other viscosity oils such as  
SAE 20W-50.  
Notice: Use only engine oil identified as meeting  
GM Standard GM6094M and showing the American  
Petroleum Institute Certified For Gasoline Engines  
starburst symbol. Failure to use the recommended  
oil can result in engine damage not covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
.
American Petroleum Institute (API) starburst  
symbol  
6-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Oils meeting these  
For Vehicles with the 2.0L L4 Engine Only  
requirements should have  
the starburst symbol on  
the container. This symbol  
indicates that the oil has  
been certified by the  
American Petroleum  
Institute (API).  
Look for three things:  
.
GM4718M  
This vehicle's engine requires a special oil meeting  
GM Standard GM4718M, such as Mobil 1® or  
equivalent. Oils meeting this standard may be  
identified as synthetic. However, not all synthetic  
oils will meet this GM standard. Use only an oil  
that meets GM Standard GM4718M.  
Notice: Using oils that do not have the GM4718M  
Standard designation can cause engine damage not  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
This vehicle's engine was filled at the factory with a  
synthetic oil meeting all requirements for this vehicle.  
.
SAE 5W-30  
Substitute Engine Oil: When adding oil to maintain  
engine oil level, oil meeting GM Standard GM4718M  
might not be available. You can add substitute oil  
designated SAE 5W-30 with the starburst symbol at all  
temperatures. Substitute oil not meeting GM Standard  
GM4718M should not be used for an oil change.  
SAE 5W-30 is best for the vehicle. These numbers  
on an oil container show its viscosity, or thickness.  
Do not use other viscosity oils such as  
SAE 20W-50.  
.
American Petroleum Institute (API) starburst  
symbol  
6-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cold Temperature Operation  
Engine Oil Life System  
For Vehicles With the 2.2L L4 Engine  
When to Change Engine Oil  
If in an area of extreme cold, where the temperature  
falls below 20°F (29°C), use either an SAE 5W-30  
synthetic oil or an SAE 0W-30 engine oil. Both provide  
easier cold starting for the engine at extremely low  
temperatures. Always use an oil that meets the required  
specification, GM6094M. See What Kind of Engine Oil  
to Usefor more information.  
This vehicle has the Engine Oil Life System, a computer  
system that indicates when to change the engine oil  
and filter. This is based on engine revolutions and  
engine temperature, and not on mileage. Based on  
driving conditions, the mileage at which an oil change  
is indicated can vary considerably. For the oil life  
system to work properly, the system must be reset  
every time the oil is changed.  
Engine Oil Additives / Engine Oil  
Flushes  
Do not add anything to the oil. The recommended oils  
with the starburst symbol that meet GM standards are  
all that is needed for good performance and engine  
protection.  
When the system has calculated that oil life has been  
diminished, it indicates that an oil change is necessary.  
A CHANGE OIL SOON message comes on. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 440. Change  
the oil as soon as possible within the next 600 miles  
(1 000 km). It is possible that, if driving under the best  
conditions, the oil life system might not indicate that an  
oil change is necessary for over a year. However, the  
engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a  
Engine oil system flushes are not recommended and  
could cause engine damage not covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
6-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
year and at this time the system must be reset. Your  
dealer/retailer has trained service people who will  
perform this work using genuine parts and reset the  
system. It is also important to check the oil regularly  
and keep it at the proper level.  
After changing the engine oil, the system must be reset:  
1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN, with the engine off.  
2. Press the information and reset buttons on the  
Driver Information Center (DIC) at the same time to  
enter the personalization menu. See DIC Vehicle  
Personalization on page 446.  
If the system is ever reset accidentally, the oil must  
be changed at 3,000 miles (5 000 km) since the last  
oil change. Remember to reset the oil life system  
whenever the oil is changed.  
3. Press the information button to scroll through the  
available personalization menu modes until the  
DIC display shows OILLIFE RESET.  
How to Reset the Engine Oil Life  
System  
4. Press and hold the reset button until the DIC  
display shows ACKNOWLEDGED. This will tell  
you the system has been reset.  
The Engine Oil Life System calculates when to  
change your engine oil and filter based on vehicle  
use. Whenever the oil is changed, reset the system  
so it can calculate when the next oil change is required.  
If a situation occurs where the oil is changed prior to a  
CHANGE OIL SOON message being turned on, reset  
the system.  
5. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF.  
If the CHANGE OIL SOON message comes back on  
when the vehicle is started, the engine oil life system  
has not reset. Repeat the reset procedure.  
6-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
What to Do with Used Oil  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
(2.0L Turbo Engine)  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614  
Engine Compartment Overview for the location of the  
engine air cleaner/filter.  
Used engine oil contains certain elements that can be  
unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer.  
Do not let used oil stay on your skin for very long. Clean  
your skin and nails with soap and water, or a good hand  
cleaner. Wash or properly dispose of clothing or rags  
containing used engine oil. See the manufacturer's  
warnings about the use and disposal of oil products.  
When to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
Inspect the air cleaner/filter at the Maintenance II  
intervals and replace it at the first oil change after  
each 50,000 mile (80 000 km) interval. See Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 73 Scheduled Maintenance  
for more information. If you are driving in dusty/dirty  
conditions, inspect the filter at each engine oil change.  
Used oil can be a threat to the environment. If you  
change your own oil, be sure to drain all the oil from the  
filter before disposal. Never dispose of oil by putting it in  
the trash, pouring it on the ground, into sewers, or into  
streams or bodies of water. Recycle it by taking it to a  
place that collects used oil.  
6-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To inspect or replace the engine air cleaner/filter,  
1. Turn off the engine.  
How to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
2. Disconnect the air flow sensor electrical connector.  
3. Loosen the screws on the clamps holding the air  
outlet duct in place. Do not remove the clamps.  
WARNING:  
{
4. Remove the air outlet duct.  
Operating the engine with the air cleaner/filter off  
can cause you or others to be burned. The air  
cleaner not only cleans the air; it helps to stop  
flames if the engine backfires. Use caution when  
working on the engine and do not drive with the  
air cleaner/filter off.  
Notice: If the air cleaner/filter is off, dirt can easily  
get into the engine, which could damage it. Always  
have the air cleaner/filter in place when you are  
driving.  
To inspect the air cleaner/filter remove the filter from the  
vehicle and lightly shake the filter to release loose dust  
and dirt. If the filter remains caked with dirt, a new filter  
is required. Never use compressed air to clean the filter.  
5. To remove the filter cover, unlatch the clamps, then  
pull up on the front and pull out.  
6-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
(2.2L Engine)  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for  
the location of the engine air cleaner/filter.  
When to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
Inspect the air cleaner/filter at the Maintenance II  
intervals and replace it at the first oil change after  
each 50,000 mile (80 000 km) interval. See Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 73 for more information. If you  
are driving in dusty/dirty conditions, inspect the filter at  
each engine oil change.  
6. Remove filter and inspect or replace.  
Wipe all dust from inside of the housing and  
inspect the air cleaner and air outlet duct for  
cracks, cuts, and deterioration. The air outlet  
duct must be replaced if damaged.  
7. Reinstall the filter cover and latch the clamps.  
8. Reattach the air outlet duct and tighten the screws  
on the clamps that hold the duct in place.  
9. Reconnect the air flow sensor electrical connector.  
6-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
WARNING:  
{
Operating the engine with the air cleaner/filter off  
can cause you or others to be burned. The air  
cleaner not only cleans the air; it helps to stop  
flames if the engine backfires. Use caution when  
working on the engine and do not drive with the  
air cleaner/filter off.  
Notice: If the air cleaner/filter is off, dirt can easily  
get into the engine, which could damage it. Always  
have the air cleaner/filter in place when you are  
driving.  
To inspect or replace the filter, remove the screws that  
hold the cover on and lift off the cover. Be sure to  
reinstall the cover tightly.  
To inspect the air cleaner/filter remove the filter from the  
vehicle and lightly shake the filter to release loose dust  
and dirt. If the filter remains caked with dirt, a new filter  
is required. Never use compressed air to clean the filter.  
6-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Transmission Fluid  
Manual Transmission Fluid  
It is not necessary to check the transmission fluid level.  
A transmission fluid leak is the only reason for fluid  
loss. If a leak occurs, take your vehicle to a dealer/  
retailer and have it repaired as soon as possible.  
It is not necessary to check the manual transmission  
fluid level. A transmission fluid leak is the only reason  
for fluid loss. If a leak occurs, take the vehicle to a  
dealer/retailer for service. Have it repaired as soon as  
possible. You may also have the fluid level checked  
by your dealer/retailer when the oil is changed. See  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 711  
for the proper fluid to use.  
Change the fluid and filter at the intervals listed in the  
Maintenance Schedule. See Scheduled Maintenance  
on page 73. Be sure to use the transmission fluid  
listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 711  
.
Hydraulic Clutch  
Notice: Use of the incorrect automatic transmission  
fluid may damage the vehicle, and the damages may  
not be covered by the vehicle's warranty. Always  
use the automatic transmission fluid listed in  
The hydraulic clutch linkage in your vehicle is  
self-adjusting. This system does not have its own  
reservoir. It receives fluid from the brake master  
cylinder reservoir.  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 711.  
See Brakes on page 637 for more information.  
6-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cooling System  
The Cooling System allows the engine to maintain the  
correct working temperature.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can  
start up even when the engine is not running and  
can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools  
away from any underhood electric fan.  
2.2L L4 Engine shown, 2.0L L4 Engine similar  
A. Electric Engine Cooling Fan  
B. Coolant Surge Tank and Pressure Cap  
6-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Coolant  
WARNING:  
{
The cooling system in the vehicle is filled with  
DEX-COOL® engine coolant. This coolant is designed  
to remain in the vehicle for five years or 150,000 miles  
(240 000 km), whichever occurs first.  
Heater and radiator hoses, and other engine  
parts, can be very hot. Do not touch them. If you  
do, you can be burned.  
The following explains the cooling system and how  
to check and add coolant when it is low. If there is  
a problem with engine overheating, see Engine  
Overheating on page 634  
Do not run the engine if there is a leak. If you run  
the engine, it could lose all coolant. That could  
cause an engine fire, and you could be burned.  
Get any leak fixed before you drive the vehicle.  
Notice: Using coolant other than DEX-COOL® can  
cause premature engine, heater core, or radiator  
corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant could  
require changing sooner, at 50 000 km (30,000 miles)  
or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always use DEX-COOL® (silicate-free) coolant  
in the vehicle.  
6-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
Protects against rust and corrosion.  
Will not damage aluminum parts.  
What to Use  
Helps keep the proper engine temperature.  
WARNING:  
{
Notice: If an improper coolant mixture is used,  
the engine could overheat and be badly damaged.  
The repair cost would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze  
and crack the engine, radiator, heater core, and  
other parts.  
Adding only plain water to the cooling system can  
be dangerous. Plain water, or some other liquid  
such as alcohol, can boil before the proper  
coolant mixture will. The vehicle's coolant warning  
system is set for the proper coolant mixture. With  
plain water or the wrong mixture, the engine could  
get too hot but you would not get the overheat  
warning. The engine could catch fire and you or  
others could be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of  
clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL® coolant.  
Notice: If extra inhibitors and/or additives are used  
in the vehicle's cooling system, the vehicle could be  
damaged. Use only the proper mixture of the engine  
coolant listed in this manual for the cooling system.  
See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 711 for more information.  
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and  
DEX-COOL® coolant. If using this mixture, nothing  
else needs to be added. This mixture:  
.
Gives freezing protection down to 34°F (37°C),  
outside temperature.  
.
Gives boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C),  
engine temperature.  
6-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Check to see if coolant is visible in the coolant surge  
tank. If the coolant inside the coolant surge tank is  
boiling, do not do anything else until it cools down.  
If coolant is visible but the coolant level is not at or  
above the COLD FILL mark, add a 50/50 mixture of  
clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL® coolant at the  
coolant surge tank, but be sure the cooling system is  
cool before this is done.  
Checking Coolant  
The vehicle must be on a level surface when checking  
the coolant level.  
The coolant level should be at the COLD FILL line.  
If it is not, you may have a leak in the cooling system.  
The coolant surge tank is located in the engine  
compartment on the driver's side of the vehicle.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614  
for more information on location.  
6-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Add Coolant to the Surge Tank  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling  
system can blow out and burn you badly. They are  
under pressure, and if you turn the surge tank  
pressure cap even a little they can come  
out at high speed. Never turn the cap when the  
cooling system, including the surge tank pressure  
cap, is hot. Wait for the cooling system and surge  
tank pressure cap to cool if you ever have to turn  
the pressure cap.  
You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot  
engine parts. Coolant contains ethylene glycol  
and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough.  
Do not spill coolant on a hot engine.  
Notice: This vehicle has a specific coolant fill  
procedure. Failure to follow this procedure could  
cause the engine to overheat and be severely  
damaged.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can  
start up even when the engine is not running and  
can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools  
away from any underhood electric fan.  
6-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If coolant is needed, add the proper DEX-COOL®  
coolant mixture at the coolant surge tank.  
1. You can remove the coolant surge tank pressure  
cap when the cooling system, including the coolant  
surge tank pressure cap and upper radiator hose,  
is no longer hot. Turn the pressure cap slowly  
counterclockwise about two or two and one-half  
turns. If you hear a hiss, wait for that to stop.  
This will allow any pressure still left to be vented  
out the discharge hose.  
2. Then keep turning the  
pressure cap slowly,  
and remove it.  
3. Fill the coolant surge tank with the proper mixture,  
to the COLD FILL line on the tank. Wait about  
five minutes, then check to see if the level is below  
the COLD FILL line. If the level is below the line,  
add additional coolant to bring the level up to the  
line. Repeat this procedure until the level remains  
constant at the COLD FILL line for at least  
five minutes.  
6-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. With the coolant surge tank pressure cap off,  
start the engine and let it run until you can feel  
the upper radiator hose getting hot. Watch out  
for the engine cooling fan.  
You may decide not to lift the hood when this warning  
appears, but instead get service help right away.  
See Roadside Assistance Program on page 87.  
If you do decide to lift the hood, make sure the vehicle  
is parked on a level surface.  
By this time, the coolant level inside the coolant  
surge tank may be lower. If the level is lower  
than the COLD FILL line, add more of the proper  
mixture to the coolant surge tank until the level  
reaches the COLD FILL line.  
Then check to see if the engine cooling fans are  
running. If the engine is overheating, both fans should  
be running. If they are not, do not continue to run the  
engine and have the vehicle serviced.  
5. Then replace the pressure cap. Be sure the  
pressure cap is hand-tight and fully seated.  
Notice: Engine damage from running the engine  
without coolant is not covered by the warranty.  
See your dealer/retailer, if necessary.  
Notice: If the engine catches fire because of being  
driven with no coolant, your vehicle can be badly  
damaged. The costly repairs would not be covered  
by the vehicle warranty.  
Engine Overheating  
The vehicle has an indicator to warn of engine  
overheating.  
You will find an engine coolant temperature warning  
light on your vehicle's instrument panel. See Engine  
Coolant Temperature Warning Light on page 426 for  
more information.  
6-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If Steam Is Coming From The Engine  
Compartment  
If No Steam Is Coming From The  
Engine Compartment  
If an engine overheat warning is displayed but no  
steam can be seen or heard, the problem may not be  
too serious. Sometimes the engine can get a little too  
hot when the vehicle:  
WARNING:  
{
Steam from an overheated engine can burn you  
badly, even if you just open the hood. Stay away  
from the engine if you see or hear steam coming  
from it. Just turn it off and get everyone away  
from the vehicle until it cools down. Wait until  
there is no sign of steam or coolant before you  
open the hood.  
.
Climbs a long hill on a hot day.  
.
Stops after high-speed driving.  
.
Idles for long periods in traffic.  
.
Tows a trailer.  
If the overheat warning is displayed with no sign of  
steam:  
If you keep driving when your engine is  
overheated, the liquids in it can catch fire. You or  
others could be badly burned. Stop your engine if  
it overheats, and get out of the vehicle until the  
engine is cool.  
1. Turn the air off.  
2. Turn the heater on to the highest temperature and  
to the highest fan speed. Open the windows as  
necessary.  
3. In heavy traffic, let the engine idle in N (Neutral) for  
automatic transmission or NEUTRAL for manual  
transmission , while stopped. If it is safe to do so,  
pull off the road, shift to P (Park) or N (Neutral) and  
let the engine idle.  
6-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the temperature overheat gauge is no longer in  
the overheat zone or an overheat warning no longer  
displays, the vehicle can be driven. Continue to drive  
the vehicle slow for about 10 minutes. Keep a safe  
vehicle distance from the car in front of you. If the  
warning does not come back on, continue to drive  
normally.  
Adding Washer Fluid  
Open the cap with the  
washer symbol on it.  
Add washer fluid until the  
tank is full. See Engine  
Compartment Overview  
on page 614 for  
If the warning continues, pull over, stop, and park the  
vehicle right away.  
reservoir location.  
If there is no sign of steam, idle the engine for  
three minutes while parked. If the warning is still  
displayed, turn off the engine until it cools down.  
Notice:  
.
When using concentrated washer fluid,  
follow the manufacturer's instructions for  
adding water.  
Windshield Washer Fluid  
What to Use  
When you need windshield washer fluid, be sure to  
read the manufacturer's instructions before use. If you  
will be operating your vehicle in an area where the  
temperature may fall below freezing, use a fluid that  
has sufficient protection against freezing.  
.
Do not mix water with ready-to-use washer  
fluid. Water can cause the solution to freeze  
and damage the washer fluid tank and other  
parts of the washer system. Also, water does  
not clean as well as washer fluid.  
.
.
Fill the washer fluid tank only three-quarters  
full when it is very cold. This allows for fluid  
expansion if freezing occurs, which could  
damage the tank if it is completely full.  
Do not use engine coolant (antifreeze) in  
the windshield washer. It can damage the  
vehicle's windshield washer system and  
paint.  
6-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not top off the brake/clutch fluid. Adding fluid does  
not correct a leak. If fluid is added when the brake  
linings are worn, there will be too much fluid when  
new brake linings are installed. Add or remove fluid,  
as necessary, only when work is done on the brake/  
clutch hydraulic system.  
Brakes  
Brake Fluid  
The brake master  
cylinder and, on manual  
transmission vehicles, the  
clutch hydraulic system  
use the same reservoir  
filled with DOT 3 brake  
fluid.  
WARNING:  
{
If too much brake fluid is added, it can spill on  
the engine and burn, if the engine is hot enough.  
You or others could be burned, and the vehicle  
could be damaged. Add brake fluid only when  
work is done on the brake and/or clutch hydraulic  
system.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for  
the location of the reservoir.  
When the brake fluid falls to a low level, the brake  
warning light comes on. See Brake System Warning  
Light on page 423.  
There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in  
the reservoir might go down:  
.
The brake fluid level goes down because of  
normal brake lining wear. When new linings are  
installed, the fluid level goes back up.  
.
A fluid leak in the brake and/or clutch hydraulic  
system can also cause a low fluid level. Have the  
brake and/or clutch hydraulic system fixed, since a  
leak means that sooner or later the brakes and/or  
clutch will not work well.  
6-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice:  
What to Add  
.
Using the wrong fluid can badly damage  
Use only new DOT 3 brake fluid from a sealed  
brake or clutch hydraulic system parts.  
For example, just a few drops of  
container. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 711  
.
mineral-based oil, such as engine oil,  
in the brake or clutch hydraulic system  
can damage brake or clutch hydraulic  
system parts so badly that they will have  
to be replaced. Do not let someone put in  
the wrong kind of fluid.  
Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area  
around the cap before removing it. This helps keep dirt  
from entering the reservoir.  
WARNING:  
{
.
If brake fluid is spilled on the vehicle's  
painted surfaces, the paint finish can be  
damaged. Be careful not to spill brake  
fluid on the vehicle. If you do, wash it off  
immediately. See Washing Your Vehicle on  
With the wrong kind of fluid in the brake or clutch  
hydraulic system, the brakes or clutch might not  
work well. This could cause a crash. Always use  
the proper brake fluid.  
page 6118  
.
6-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Some driving conditions or climates can cause a brake  
squeal when the brakes are first applied or lightly  
applied. This does not mean something is wrong with  
the brakes.  
Brake Wear  
This vehicle has front disc brakes and could have rear  
drum brakes or rear disc brakes.  
Disc brake pads have built-in wear indicators that make  
a high-pitched warning sound when the brake pads are  
worn and new pads are needed. The sound can come  
and go or be heard all the time the vehicle is moving,  
except when applying the brake pedal firmly.  
Properly torqued wheel nuts are necessary to help  
prevent brake pulsation. When tires are rotated, inspect  
brake pads for wear and evenly tighten wheel nuts  
in the proper sequence to torque specifications in  
Capacities and Specifications on page 6131.  
If the vehicle has rear drum brakes, they do not  
have wear indicators, but if a rear brake rubbing  
noise is heard, have the rear brake linings inspected  
immediately. Rear brake drums should be removed and  
inspected each time the tires are removed for rotation  
or changing. When the front brake pads are replaced,  
have the rear brakes inspected, too.  
WARNING:  
{
The brake wear warning sound means that soon  
the brakes will not work well. That could lead to  
an accident. When the brake wear warning sound  
is heard, have the vehicle serviced.  
Brake linings should always be replaced as complete  
axle sets.  
Notice: Continuing to drive with worn-out brake  
pads could result in costly brake repair.  
6-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brake Pedal Travel  
Replacing Brake System Parts  
See your dealer/retailer if the brake pedal does not  
return to normal height, or if there is a rapid increase in  
pedal travel. This could be a sign that brake service  
might be required.  
The braking system on a vehicle is complex. Its many  
parts have to be of top quality and work well together if  
the vehicle is to have really good braking. The vehicle  
was designed and tested with top-quality brake parts.  
When parts of the braking system are replaced for  
example, when the brake linings wear down and new  
ones are installed be sure to get new approved  
replacement parts. If this is not done, the brakes might  
not work properly. For example, if someone puts in  
brake linings that are wrong for the vehicle, the balance  
between the front and rear brakes can change for the  
worse. The braking performance expected can change  
in many other ways if the wrong replacement brake  
parts are installed.  
Brake Adjustment  
Every moderate brake stop, the disc brakes adjust for  
wear. If rarely making moderate or heavier brake stops,  
the brakes might not adjust correctly. Very carefully  
making a few moderate brake stops about every  
1,000 miles (1 600 km) will adjust the brakes properly.  
If the vehicle has rear drum brakes and the brake pedal  
goes down farther than normal, the rear drum brakes  
might need adjustment. Adjust them by backing up and  
firmly applying the brakes a few times.  
6-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Storage  
Battery  
Refer to the replacement number on the original battery  
label when a new battery is needed.  
WARNING:  
{
The battery is in the trunk. Access to the battery is not  
necessary to jump start the vehicle. See Jump Starting  
Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas  
that can explode. You can be badly hurt if you  
are not careful. See Jump Starting on page 642  
for tips on working around a battery without  
getting hurt.  
on page 642  
.
DANGER:  
{
Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories  
contain lead and lead compounds, chemicals  
known to the State of California to cause cancer  
and reproductive harm. Wash hands after  
handling.  
Infrequent Usage: Remove the black, negative () cable  
from the battery to keep the battery from running down.  
Extended Storage: Remove the black, negative ()  
cable from the battery or use a battery trickle charger.  
6-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Ignoring these steps could result in costly  
damage to the vehicle that would not be covered by  
the warranty.  
Jump Starting  
If the vehicle's battery has run down, you may want to  
use another vehicle and some jumper cables to start  
the vehicle. Be sure to use the following steps to do it  
safely.  
Trying to start the vehicle by pushing or pulling it  
will not work, and it could damage the vehicle.  
1. Check the other vehicle. It must have a 12-volt  
battery with a negative ground system.  
WARNING:  
{
Notice: If the other vehicle's system is not a 12-volt  
system with a negative ground, both vehicles can  
be damaged. Only use vehicles with 12-volt systems  
with negative grounds to jump start your vehicle.  
Batteries can hurt you. They can be dangerous  
because:  
.
2. Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper  
cables can reach, but be sure the vehicles are not  
touching each other. If they are, it could cause a  
ground connection you do not want. You would not  
be able to start the vehicle, and the bad grounding  
could damage the electrical systems.  
They contain acid that can burn you.  
.
They contain gas that can explode or ignite.  
.
They contain enough electricity to burn you.  
If you do not follow these steps exactly, some or  
all of these things can hurt you.  
To avoid the possibility of the vehicles rolling, set  
the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved  
in the jump start procedure. Put an automatic  
transmission in P (Park) or a manual transmission  
in N (Neutral) before setting the parking brake.  
6-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If you leave the radio or other accessories  
on during the jump starting procedure, they could  
be damaged. The repairs would not be covered by  
the warranty. Always turn off the radio and other  
accessories when jump starting the vehicle.  
Locate the remote  
positive (+) terminal  
which is located under  
a red tethered cap on  
the engine compartment  
fuse block. Lift the cap to  
access the terminal.  
3. Turn off the ignition on both vehicles. Unplug  
unnecessary accessories plugged into the  
cigarette lighter or the accessory power outlet.  
Turn off the radio and all lamps that are not  
needed. This will avoid sparks and help save  
both batteries. And it could save the radio!  
4. Open the hood on the other vehicle and locate the  
positive (+) and negative () terminal locations on  
that vehicle.  
You will not see the battery of your vehicle under  
the hood. It is located in the trunk. You will not  
need to access your battery for jump starting.  
The vehicle has a remote positive (+) and a  
remote negative () jump starting terminal.  
6-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locate the remote  
negative () ground  
terminal, marked GND (),  
which is located behind  
the engine coolant  
surge tank.  
WARNING:  
{
Using a match near a battery can cause battery  
gas to explode. People have been hurt doing this,  
and some have been blinded. Use a flashlight if  
you need more light.  
Be sure the battery has enough water. You do not  
need to add water to the battery installed in your  
new vehicle. But if a battery has filler caps, be  
sure the right amount of fluid is there. If it is low,  
add water to take care of that first. If you don't,  
explosive gas could be present.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614  
for more information on the location of the  
positive (+) and negative () terminals on  
the vehicle.  
Battery fluid contains acid that can burn you.  
Do not get it on you. If you accidentally get it in  
your eyes or on your skin, flush the place with  
water and get medical help immediately.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric fan can start up even when the engine  
is not running and can injure you. Keep hands,  
clothing and tools away from any underhood  
electric fan.  
6-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Do not let the other end touch metal. Connect it to  
the positive (+) terminal of the good battery. Use a  
remote positive (+) terminal if the vehicle has one.  
WARNING:  
{
8. Now connect the black negative () cable to the  
negative () terminal of the good battery. Use a  
remote negative () terminal if the vehicle has one.  
Fans or other moving engine parts can injure you  
badly. Keep your hands away from moving parts  
once the engine is running.  
Do not let the other end touch anything until the  
next step. The other end of the negative () cable  
does not go to the dead battery. It goes to a  
heavy, unpainted metal engine part or to a remote  
negative () terminal on the vehicle with the dead  
battery.  
5. Check that the jumper cables do not have loose  
or missing insulation. If they do, you could get a  
shock. The vehicles could be damaged too.  
Before you connect the cables, here are some  
basic things you should know. Positive (+) will  
go to positive (+) or to a remote positive (+)  
terminal if the vehicle has one. Negative () will  
go to a heavy, unpainted metal engine part or to a  
remote negative () terminal if the vehicle has one.  
9. Connect the other end of the negative () cable to  
the negative () terminal location on the vehicle  
with the dead battery. Your vehicle has a remote  
negative () terminal marked GND ().  
10. Now start the vehicle with the good battery and run  
the engine for a while.  
Do not connect positive (+) to negative () or you  
will get a short that would damage the battery and  
maybe other parts too. And do not connect the  
negative () cable to the negative () terminal on  
the dead battery because this can cause sparks.  
11. Try to start the vehicle that had the dead battery.  
If it will not start after a few tries, it probably needs  
service.  
6. Connect the red positive (+) cable to the  
positive (+) terminal location on the vehicle with the  
dead battery. Use a remote positive (+) terminal if  
the vehicle has one.  
6-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If the jumper cables are connected or  
removed in the wrong order, electrical shorting  
may occur and damage the vehicle. The repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always connect and remove the jumper cables  
in the correct order, making sure that the cables  
do not touch each other or other metal.  
To disconnect the jumper cables from both vehicles:  
1. Disconnect the black negative () cable from the  
vehicle that had the dead battery.  
2. Disconnect the black negative () cable from the  
vehicle with the good battery.  
3. Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the  
vehicle with the good battery.  
4. Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the other  
vehicle.  
5. Return the positive (+) terminal cover to its original  
position.  
Headlamp Aiming  
The optical headlamp aiming system has been preset at  
the factory and should need no further adjustment  
However, If the vehicle is damaged, the headlamp aim  
may be affected and adjustment may be necessary.  
If oncoming vehicles flash their high beams at you, this  
may also mean the vertical aim needs to be adjusted.  
Jumper Cable Removal  
It is recommended that the vehicle is taken to your  
dealer/retailer for service if the headlamps need to  
be re-aimed. It is possible however, to re-aim the  
headlamps as described.  
A. Heavy, Unpainted Metal Engine Part or Remote  
Negative () Terminal (GND)  
B. Good Battery or Remote Positive (+) and Remote  
Negative () Terminals  
C. Dead Battery or Remote Positive (+) Terminal  
6-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The vehicle should be:  
To adjust the vertical aim on the headlamps:  
.
Placed so the headlamps are 25 ft. (7.6 m) from a  
1. Open the hood. See Hood Release on page 613.  
light colored wall.  
.
On a perfectly level surface which is level all the  
way to the wall.  
.
Placed so it is at a right angle to the wall.  
.
Clear of any snow, ice, or mud on it.  
.
Fully assembled, with the tires properly inflated,  
and all other work stopped while headlamp aiming  
is being done.  
.
Normally loaded with a full tank of fuel, with the  
spare tire in the proper location, and one person or  
160 lbs (75 kg) on the driver seat.  
2. Record the distance from the ground to the aim dot  
Headlamp aiming is done with the vehicle's low-beam  
headlamps. The high-beam headlamps will be correctly  
aimed if the low-beam headlamps are aimed properly.  
on the lowbeam headlamp.  
6-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. At the wall, measure from the ground upward (A) to  
the recorded distance from Step 2 and mark it.  
4. Draw or tape a horizontal line (B) on the wall the  
width of the vehicle at the height of the mark in  
Step 3.  
Notice: Do not cover a headlamp to improve beam  
cut-off when aiming. Covering a headlamp may  
cause excessive heat build-up which may cause  
damage to the headlamp.  
6. Locate the vertical headlamp aiming screws, which  
are under the hood near each headlamp assembly.  
The adjustment screw can be turned with a 6 mm  
socket wrench.  
5. Turn on the low-beam headlamps and place a  
piece of cardboard in front of the headlamp not  
being adjusted. Do not place it directly on the  
headlamp. This allows only the beam of light from  
the headlamp being adjusted to be seen on the flat  
surface.  
7. Turn the vertical aiming screw until the headlamp  
beam is aimed to the horizontal tape line. Turn it  
clockwise or counterclockwise to raise or lower the  
angle of the beam.  
6-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bulb Replacement  
For the proper type of replacement bulbs, see  
Replacement Bulbs on page 655.  
For any bulb changing procedure not listed in this  
section, contact your dealer/retailer.  
Halogen Bulbs  
WARNING:  
{
8. Make sure that the light from the headlamp is  
positioned at the bottom edge of the horizontal  
tape line. The lamp on the left (A) shows the  
correct headlamp aim. The lamp on the right (B)  
shows the incorrect headlamp aim.  
Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and  
can burst if you drop or scratch the bulb. You or  
others could be injured. Be sure to read and  
follow the instructions on the bulb package.  
9. Repeat Steps 6 through 8 for the opposite  
headlamp.  
6-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal,  
Sidemarker, and Parking Lamps  
1. Open the hood. See Hood Release on page 613.  
A. Front Turn Signal/Parking Lamp  
B. Sidemarker  
C. Headlamp  
2. Remove the two bolts from the headlamp  
assembly.  
3. Remove the two fasteners from the fascia.  
Assistance may be needed for Steps 4 and 5.  
6-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Pull the front fascia back.  
Center High-Mounted  
Stoplamp (CHMSL)  
5. Pull the headlamp assembly up at an angle and  
towards the radiator to remove it.  
To replace a CHMSL bulb:  
6. Disconnect the bulb base from the wiring harness  
by lifting the locking tab.  
1. Open the trunk.  
2. Press the tabs to release the bulb assembly.  
7. Disconnect the wiring harness from the bulb  
socket.  
8. Remove the retainer by turning it counterclockwise.  
9. Turn the bulb socket for the headlamp, front turn  
signal, or parking lamp counterclockwise. For the  
sidemarker bulb, use a tool to assist in turning the  
bulb socket.  
10. Pull the old bulb out of the socket.  
11. Install a new bulb.  
12. Reinstall the bulb assembly by reversing Steps 1  
through 9.  
When reinstalling the headlamp assembly, first  
make sure that the wiring harness is in its original  
position. If not, the headlamp assembly will not fit  
correctly.  
Align the two tabs on the bottom of the assembly  
that fit into two slots in the headlamp assembly  
bracket.  
3. Pull the bulb assembly down to access the bulbs.  
6-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Pull the old bulb straight out.  
3. Disconnect the wiring harness by lifting up on the  
tab to release and pull it straight out.  
5. Push the new bulb straight in until it clicks.  
4. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull it  
straight out of the taillamp assembly.  
6. Align the tabs in the bulb assembly with the  
assembly in the trunk lid. Push the bulb assembly  
back into place until it snaps in. You may need to  
use a tool to guide the tabs into the assembly.  
5. Pull the old bulb straight out of the bulb socket.  
6. Push the new bulb straight into the bulb socket  
until it clicks.  
Taillamps and Turn Signal  
Lamps (Coupe)  
7. Push the bulb socket into the taillamp assembly  
and turn it clockwise to lock it into place.  
8. Push the wiring harness straight into the bulb  
socket and push down on the tab.  
9. Reinstall the trunk trim and fastener.  
To replace this bulb:  
1. Open the trunk.  
2. Remove the trunk trim and pull back fastener.  
6-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps  
and Back-up Lamps (Sedan)  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
1. Open the trunk.  
2. Remove the trunk trim and pull back fastener.  
3. Remove the additional fastener.  
4. Remove the outer two screws from the taillamp  
assembly.  
5. Lift up on the tab and pull the wiring harness  
straight out.  
6. Remove the taillamp assembly from the quarter  
panel.  
A. Sidemarker  
B. Stoplamp/Turn Signal/Taillamp  
C. Back-up  
7. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull it  
straight out.  
8. Pull the old bulb straight out of the socket.  
9. Push the new bulb straight into the socket.  
6-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10. Push the new bulb into the taillamp assembly and  
turn it clockwise to lock it into place.  
11. Reinstall the taillamp assembly into the quarter  
panel.  
12. Push the wiring harness straight into the taillamp  
assembly and push the tab down.  
13. Reinstall the outer two screws into the taillamp  
assembly.  
14. Reinstall the trunk trim and the fasteners.  
Back-Up Lamps (Coupe)  
3. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull it  
out of the lamp assembly.  
On vehicles that have a back-up lamp cover, first  
remove it by pressing the tab at the top.  
4. Pull the old bulb straight out of the bulb socket.  
5. Push the new bulb straight into the bulb socket  
until it clicks.  
To replace a back-up lamp bulb:  
1. Open the trunk. See Trunk on page 312.  
6. Push the bulb socket into the lamp assembly and  
turn it clockwise to lock it into place.  
2. Locate the back-up lamp bulb assembly in the  
trunk lid.  
6-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Install the new bulb.  
License Plate Lamp  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
5. Push the bulb straight into the socket and turn  
clockwise to reinstall.  
6. Push and turn the license plate lamp away from  
you through the opening.  
7. Reinstall the two screws holding the license  
plate lamp.  
Replacement Bulbs  
Exterior Lamps  
Back-Up Lamps  
Bulb Number  
921  
Center High-Mounted  
Stoplamp (CHMSL)  
912  
Front Parking/Turn Signal Lamps  
3157KX  
9007 LL  
Halogen Headlamps,  
High/Low-Beam  
1. Remove the two screws holding each of the  
license plate lamps.  
License Plate Lamp and  
Sidemarker  
194  
2. Turn and pull the license plate lamp toward you  
through the opening.  
Stoplamp, Taillamp and  
Turn Signal Lamps  
3057KX  
3. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull the  
bulb straight out of the socket.  
For replacement bulbs not listed here, contact your  
dealer/retailer.  
6-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windshield Wiper Blade  
Replacement  
Windshield wiper blades should be inspected for wear  
or cracking. See Scheduled Maintenance on page 73  
for more information on wiper blade inspection.  
Replacement blades come in different types and are  
removed in different ways. For proper type and length,  
see Maintenance Replacement Parts on page 713  
.
Here is how to remove the wiper blades:  
1. Pull the windshield wiper arm away from the  
windshield.  
2. Push the release lever and slide the wiper  
assembly toward the driver side of the vehicle.  
3. Install a new blade by reversing Steps 1 and 2.  
6-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Your new vehicle comes with high-quality tires  
made by a leading tire manufacturer. If you ever  
have questions about the tire warranty and where  
to obtain service, see the vehicle warranty booklet  
for details. For additional information refer to the  
tire manufacturer.  
.
Underinflated tires pose the same  
danger as overloaded tires. The resulting  
accident could cause serious injury.  
Check all tires frequently to maintain the  
recommended pressure. Tire pressure  
should be checked when your vehicle's  
tires are cold. See Inflation - Tire  
WARNING:  
{
Pressure on page 666  
.
.
.
Poorly maintained and improperly used tires  
are dangerous.  
Overinflated tires are more likely to be  
cut, punctured, or broken by a sudden  
impact such as when you hit a pothole.  
Keep tires at the recommended pressure.  
.
Overloading your vehicle's tires can  
cause overheating as a result of too  
much flexing. You could have an air-out  
and a serious accident. See Loading the  
Worn, old tires can cause accidents.  
If the tire's tread is badly worn, or if your  
vehicle's tires have been damaged,  
replace them.  
Vehicle on page 525  
.
(Continued)  
6-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Low-Profile Performance Tire  
Winter Tires  
If the vehicle has 225/40R18 size tires, they  
are classified as lowprofile performance tires.  
These tires are designed for very responsive  
driving on wet or dry pavement. You may  
also notice more road noise with lowprofile  
performance tires and that they tend to wear  
faster.  
If the vehicle has 225/40R18 size tires, they are  
classified as performance tires. These tires are  
designed for very responsive driving on wet or dry  
pavement. If you expect to drive on snow or ice  
covered roads often, you may want to get winter tires  
for the vehicle. All season tires provide good overall  
performance on most surfaces but they may not  
offer the traction you would like or the same level  
of performance as winter tires on snow or ice  
covered roads.  
The 225/40R18 tire is a high performance  
tire designed for dry traction and handling  
performance which may result in reduced tread  
life of 15,000 miles (24 140 km) or less depending  
on individual driving behavior.  
Winter tires, in general, are designed for increased  
traction on snow and ice covered roads. With winter  
tires, there may be decreased dry road traction,  
increased road noise, and shorter tread life. After  
switching to winter tires, be alert for changes in  
vehicle handling and braking.  
Notice: If the vehicle has lowprofile tires, they  
are more susceptible to damage from road  
hazards or curb impact than standard profile  
tires. Tire and/or wheel assembly damage can  
occur when coming into contact with road  
hazards like, potholes, or sharp edged objects,  
or when sliding into a curb. The vehicle  
See your dealer/retailer for details regarding winter tire  
availability and proper tire selection. Also, see Buying  
New Tires on page 676.  
warranty does not cover this type of damage.  
Keep tires set to the correct inflation pressure  
and, when possible avoid contact with curbs,  
potholes, and other road hazards.  
6-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you choose to use winter tires:  
.
Use tires of the same brand and tread type on all  
four wheel positions.  
.
Use only radial ply tires of the same size, load  
range, and speed rating as the original equipment  
tires.  
Winter tires with the same speed rating as your original  
equipment tires may not be available for H, V, W, Y, and  
ZR speed rated tires. If you choose winter tires with a  
lower speed rating, never exceed the tire's maximum  
speed capability.  
Tire Sidewall Labeling  
Useful information about a tire is molded into its  
sidewall. The examples below show a typical  
passenger vehicle tire and a compact spare tire  
sidewall.  
Passenger (PMetric) Tire Example  
(A) Tire Size: The tire size is a combination of  
letters and numbers used to define a particular  
tire's width, height, aspect ratio, construction  
type and service description. See the Tire Size”  
illustration later in this section for more detail.  
6-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(B) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification): Original equipment tires designed  
to GM's specific tire performance criteria have a  
TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall.  
GM's TPC specifications meet or exceed all  
federal safety guidelines. If your vehicle has  
205/55R16 size tires, they meet the GM TPC  
Spec rating, but the TPC Spec code has not  
been molded onto the tire's sidewall.  
Number (TIN). The TIN shows the manufacturer  
and plant code, tire size, and date the tire was  
manufactured. The TIN is molded onto both sides  
of the tire, although only one side may have the  
date of manufacture.  
(E) Tire Ply Material: The type of cord and  
number of plies in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
(F) Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG): Tire  
manufacturers are required to grade tires based  
on three performance factors: treadwear, traction  
and temperature resistance. For more information  
(C) DOT (Department of Transportation):  
The Department of Transportation (DOT) code  
indicates that the tire is in compliance with the  
U.S. Department of Transportation Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standards.  
see Uniform Tire Quality Grading on page 678  
.
(G) Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit:  
Maximum load that can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to support that load.  
(D) Tire Identification Number (TIN): The letters  
and numbers following DOT (Department of  
Transportation) code is the Tire Identification  
6-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(B) Tire Ply Material: The type of cord and  
number of plies in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
(C) Tire Identification Number (TIN): The letters  
and numbers following the DOT (Department of  
Transportation) code is the Tire Identification  
Number (TIN). The TIN shows the manufacturer  
and plant code, tire size, and date the tire was  
manufactured. The TIN is molded onto both sides  
of the tire, although only one side may have the  
date of manufacture.  
(D) Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit:  
Maximum load that can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to support that load.  
(E) Tire Inflation: The temporary use tire or  
compact spare tire should be inflated to 60 psi  
(420 kPa). For more information on tire pressure  
and inflation see Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
Compact Spare Tire Example  
(A) Temporary Use Only: The compact  
spare tire or temporary use tire has a tread life of  
approximately 3,000 miles (5 000 km) and should  
not be driven at speeds over 65 mph (105 km/h).  
The compact spare tire is for emergency use  
when a regular road tire has lost air and gone  
flat. If your vehicle has a compact spare tire,  
see Compact Spare Tire on page 6114 and  
page 666  
.
(F) Tire Size : A combination of letters and  
numbers define a tire's width, height, aspect  
ratio, construction type and service description.  
The letter T as the first character in the tire size  
means the tire is for temporary use only.  
If a Tire Goes Flat on page 682  
.
6-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(G) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification): Original equipment tires designed  
to GM's specific tire performance criteria have a  
TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall.  
GM's TPC specifications meet or exceed all  
federal safety guidelines.  
(B) Tire Width: The threedigit number indicates  
the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall  
to sidewall.  
(C) Aspect Ratio: A twodigit number that  
indicates the tire heighttowidth measurements.  
For example, if the tire size aspect ratio is 60, as  
shown in item C of the illustration, it would mean  
that the tire's sidewall is 60 percent as high as it  
is wide.  
Tire Size  
The following illustration shows an example of a  
typical passenger vehicle tire size.  
(D) Construction Code: A letter code is used to  
indicate the type of ply construction in the tire.  
The letter R means radial ply construction; the  
letter D means diagonal or bias ply construction;  
and the letter B means beltedbias ply  
construction.  
(E) Rim Diameter: Diameter of the wheel in  
inches.  
(A) Passenger (PMetric) Tire: The United States  
version of a metric tire sizing system. The letter P  
as the first character in the tire size means a  
passenger vehicle tire engineered to standards  
set by the U.S. Tire and Rim Association. A tire  
size without the letter P as the first character is  
certified to European standards.  
(F) Service Description: These characters  
represent the load index and speed rating of the  
tire. The load index represents the load carry  
capacity a tire is certified to carry. The speed  
rating is the maximum speed a tire is certified  
to carry a load.  
6-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cold Tire Pressure: The amount of air pressure  
in a tire, measured in pounds per square inch (psi)  
or kilopascals (kPa) before a tire has built up heat  
from driving. See Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
Tire Terminology and Definitions  
Air Pressure: The amount of air inside the tire  
pressing outward on each square inch of the tire.  
Air pressure is expressed in pounds per square  
inch (psi) or kilopascal (kPa).  
page 666  
.
Curb Weight: The weight of a motor vehicle with  
standard and optional equipment including the  
maximum capacity of fuel, oil, and coolant, but  
without passengers and cargo.  
Accessory Weight: This means the combined  
weight of optional accessories. Some examples of  
optional accessories are, automatic transmission,  
power steering, power brakes, power windows,  
power seats, and air conditioning.  
DOT Markings: A code molded into the sidewall  
of a tire signifying that the tire is in compliance  
with the U.S. Department of Transportation (DOT)  
motor vehicle safety standards. The DOT code  
includes the Tire Identification Number (TIN), an  
alphanumeric designator which can also identify  
the tire manufacturer, production plant, brand, and  
date of production.  
Aspect Ratio: The relationship of a tire's height to  
its width.  
Belt: A rubber coated layer of cords that is  
located between the plies and the tread. Cords  
may be made from steel or other reinforcing  
materials.  
GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight Rating.  
Bead: The tire bead contains steel wires wrapped  
by steel cords that hold the tire onto the rim.  
See Loading the Vehicle on page 525  
.
GAWR FRT: Gross Axle Weight Rating for the  
front axle. See Loading the Vehicle on page 525  
Bias Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire in which the plies  
are laid at alternate angles less than 90 degrees  
to the centerline of the tread.  
.
GAWR RR: Gross Axle Weight Rating for the rear  
axle. See Loading the Vehicle on page 525  
.
6-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Intended Outboard Sidewall: The side of an  
asymmetrical tire, that must always face outward  
when mounted on a vehicle.  
Normal Occupant Weight: The number of  
occupants a vehicle is designed to seat multiplied  
by 150 lbs (68 kg). See Loading the Vehicle on  
page 525  
.
Kilopascal (kPa): The metric unit for air pressure.  
Occupant Distribution: Designated seating  
positions.  
Light Truck (LTMetric) Tire: A tire used on light  
duty trucks and some multipurpose passenger  
vehicles.  
Outward Facing Sidewall: The side of an  
asymmetrical tire that has a particular side  
that faces outward when mounted on a vehicle.  
The side of the tire that contains a whitewall,  
bears white lettering, or bears manufacturer,  
brand, and/or model name molding that is higher  
or deeper than the same moldings on the other  
sidewall of the tire.  
Load Index: An assigned number ranging from  
1 to 279 that corresponds to the load carrying  
capacity of a tire.  
Maximum Inflation Pressure: The maximum  
air pressure to which a cold tire can be inflated.  
The maximum air pressure is molded onto the  
sidewall.  
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire: A tire used on  
passenger cars and some light duty trucks and  
multipurpose vehicles.  
Maximum Load Rating: The load rating for a tire  
at the maximum permissible inflation pressure for  
that tire.  
Recommended Inflation Pressure: Vehicle  
manufacturer's recommended tire inflation  
pressure as shown on the tire placard.  
See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 666  
Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight: The sum of  
curb weight, accessory weight, vehicle capacity  
weight, and production options weight.  
and Loading the Vehicle on page 525  
.
6-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radial Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire in which the  
ply cords that extend to the beads are laid at  
90 degrees to the centerline of the tread.  
UTQGS (Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
Standards): A tire information system that  
provides consumers with ratings for a tire's  
traction, temperature, and treadwear. Ratings  
are determined by tire manufacturers using  
government testing procedures. The ratings are  
molded into the sidewall of the tire. See Uniform  
Rim: A metal support for a tire and upon which  
the tire beads are seated.  
Sidewall: The portion of a tire between the tread  
and the bead.  
Tire Quality Grading on page 678  
.
Speed Rating: An alphanumeric code assigned  
to a tire indicating the maximum speed at which  
a tire can operate.  
Vehicle Capacity Weight: The number of  
designated seating positions multiplied by 150 lbs  
(68 kg) plus the rated cargo load. See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 525  
.
Traction: The friction between the tire and the  
road surface. The amount of grip provided.  
Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire: Load on  
an individual tire due to curb weight, accessory  
weight, occupant weight, and cargo weight.  
Tread: The portion of a tire that comes into  
contact with the road.  
Vehicle Placard: A label permanently attached  
to a vehicle showing the vehicle's capacity  
weight and the original equipment tire size and  
recommended inflation pressure. See Tire and  
Loading Information Labelunder Loading the  
Treadwear Indicators: Narrow bands, sometimes  
called wear bars, that show across the tread  
of a tire when only 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread  
remains. See When It Is Time for New Tires on  
page 675  
.
Vehicle on page 525  
.
6-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information  
label is attached to your vehicle. This label shows  
your vehicle's original equipment tires and the  
correct inflation pressures for your tires when they  
are cold. The recommended cold tire inflation  
pressure, shown on the label, is the minimum  
amount of air pressure needed to support your  
vehicle's maximum load carrying capacity.  
Inflation - Tire Pressure  
Tires need the correct amount of air pressure to  
operate effectively.  
Notice: Do not let anyone tell you that  
underinflation or overinflation is all right.  
It is not. If your tires do not have enough air  
(underinflation), you can get the following:  
.
For additional information regarding how much  
weight your vehicle can carry, and an example  
of the Tire and Loading Information label, see  
Loading the Vehicle on page 525 . How you load  
your vehicle affects vehicle handling and ride  
comfort. Never load your vehicle with more weight  
than it was designed to carry.  
Too much flexing  
.
Too much heat  
.
Tire overloading  
.
Premature or irregular wear  
.
Poor handling  
.
Reduced fuel economy  
When to Check  
If your tires have too much air (overinflation),  
you can get the following:  
Check your tires once a month or more. Do not  
forget to check the compact spare tire, if the  
vehicle has one. It should be at 60 psi (420 kPa).  
For additional information regarding the compact  
.
Unusual wear  
.
Poor handling  
spare tire, seeCompact Spare Tire on page 6114  
.
.
Rough ride  
.
Needless damage from road hazards  
6-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Check  
Tire Pressure Monitor System  
Use a good quality pocket-type gauge to check  
tire pressure. You cannot tell if your tires are  
properly inflated simply by looking at them.  
Radial tires may look properly inflated even  
when they are underinflated. Check the tire's  
inflation pressure when the tires are cold.  
Cold means your vehicle has been sitting for  
at least three hours or driven no more than  
1 mile (1.6 km).  
The vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS). This system uses radio and sensor technology  
to check tire pressure levels. The TPMS sensors  
monitor the air pressure in your vehicle's tires and  
transmit tire pressure readings to a receiver located  
in the vehicle.  
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be  
checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation  
pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer  
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label.  
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size  
indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure  
label, you should determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires.)  
Remove the valve cap from the tire valve stem.  
Press the tire gauge firmly onto the valve to get a  
pressure measurement. If the cold tire inflation  
pressure matches the recommended pressure on  
the Tire and Loading Information label, no further  
adjustment is necessary. If the inflation pressure  
is low, add air until you reach the recommended  
amount.  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been  
equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system  
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when  
one or more of your tires is significantly underinflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale  
illuminates, you should stop and check your tires  
as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper  
pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire  
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.  
Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire  
tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and  
stopping ability.  
If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on  
the metal stem in the center of the tire valve.  
Recheck the tire pressure with the tire gauge.  
Be sure to put the valve caps back on the valve  
stems. They help prevent leaks by keeping out dirt  
and moisture.  
6-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper  
tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to  
maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation  
has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the  
TPMS low tire pressure telltale.  
Federal Communications Commission  
(FCC) and Industry Canada  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 820  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS  
malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is  
not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator  
is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When  
the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will  
flash for approximately one minute and then remain  
continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue  
upon subsequent vehicle startups as long as the  
malfunction exists.  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation  
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS). The TPMS is designed to warn the driver when  
a low tire pressure condition exists. If your vehicle has  
this feature, TPMS sensors are mounted onto each tire  
and wheel assembly, excluding the spare tire and wheel  
assembly, if the vehicle has one. The TPMS sensors  
monitor the air pressure in the vehicle's tires and  
transmit the tire pressure readings to a receiver  
located in the vehicle.  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the  
system may not be able to detect or signal low tire  
pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur  
for a variety of reasons, including the installation of  
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle  
that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.  
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after  
replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle  
to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and  
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.  
When a low tire pressure  
condition is detected, the  
TPMS turns on the low  
tire pressure warning light  
located on the instrument  
panel cluster.  
See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 668 for  
additional information.  
6-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
cold. See Loading the Vehicle on page 525, for an  
example of the Tire and Loading Information label and  
its location on your vehicle. Also see Inflation - Tire  
Pressure on page 666.  
At the same time a message to check the pressure in a  
specific tire appears on the Driver Information Center  
(DIC) display. The low tire pressure warning light and  
the DIC warning message come on at each ignition  
cycle until the tires are inflated to the correct inflation  
pressure. Using the DIC, tire pressure levels can be  
viewed by the driver. For additional information and  
details about the DIC operation and displays see DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 438 and DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 440.  
Your vehicle's TPMS system can warn you about a low  
tire pressure condition but it does not replace normal  
tire maintenance. See Tire Inspection and Rotation on  
page 673 and Tires on page 657.  
Notice: Using nonapproved tire sealants could  
damage the Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)  
sensors. TPMS sensor damage caused by using an  
incorrect tire sealant is not covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Always use the GM approved tire sealant  
available through your dealer/retailer.  
The low tire pressure warning light may come on in cool  
weather when the vehicle is first started, and then turn  
off as you start to drive. This could be an early indicator  
that the air pressure in the tire(s) are getting low and  
need to be inflated to the proper pressure.  
Factory-installed Tire Inflator Kits use a GM approved  
liquid tire sealant. Using non-approved tire sealants  
could damage the TPMS sensors. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit on page 684 for information regarding  
the inflator kit materials and instructions.  
A Tire and Loading Information label shows the size of  
your vehicle's original equipment tires and the correct  
inflation pressure for your vehicle's tires when they are  
6-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
One or more TPMS sensors are missing or  
damaged. The DIC message and the TPMS  
malfunction light should go off when the TPMS  
sensors are installed and the sensor matching  
process is performed successfully. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
TPMS Malfunction Light and Message  
The TPMS will not function properly if one or more of  
the TPMS sensors are missing or inoperable. When the  
system detects a malfunction, the low tire warning light  
flashes for about one minute and then stays on for the  
remainder of the ignition cycle. A DIC warning message  
is also displayed. The low tire warning light and DIC  
warning message come on at each ignition cycle until  
the problem is corrected. Some of the conditions that  
can cause the malfunction light and DIC message to  
come on are:  
Replacement tires or wheels do not match your  
vehicle's original equipment tires or wheels.  
Tires and wheels other than those recommended  
for your vehicle could prevent the TPMS from  
functioning properly. See Buying New Tires on  
page 676  
.
.
One of the road tires has been replaced with  
Operating electronic devices or being near facilities  
using radio wave frequencies similar to the TPMS  
could cause the TPMS sensors to malfunction.  
the spare tire, if the vehicle has one. The spare  
tire does not have a TPMS sensor. The TPMS  
malfunction light and DIC message should go  
off once you reinstall the road tire containing  
the TPMS sensor.  
If the TPMS is not functioning it cannot detect or signal  
a low tire condition. See your dealer/retailer for service  
if the TPMS malfunction light and DIC message comes  
on and stays on.  
.
The TPMS sensor matching process was started  
but not completed or not completed successfully  
after rotating the vehicle's tires. The DIC message  
and TPMS malfunction light should go off once  
the TPMS sensor matching process is performed  
successfully. See TPMS Sensor Matching  
Processlater in this section.  
6-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TPMS Sensor Matching Process  
TPMS Matching Process for Vehicles  
with Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
1. Set the parking brake.  
Each TPMS sensor has a unique identification code.  
Any time you replace one or more of the TPMS sensors  
or rotate the vehicle's tires, the identification codes  
need to be matched to the new tire/wheel location.  
The sensors are matched, to the tire/wheel locations,  
in the following order: driver side front tire, passenger  
side front tire, passenger side rear tire, and driver side  
rear tire using a TPMS diagnostic tool. See your dealer/  
retailer for service.  
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON/RUN with the  
engine off.  
3. Press and hold the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter's lock and unlock buttons, at the same  
time, for about five seconds to start the TPMS  
learn mode. The horn sounds twice indicating  
the TPMS receiver is ready and in learn mode.  
The TPMS sensors can also be matched to each tire/  
wheel position by increasing or decreasing the tire's air  
pressure. When increasing the tire's pressure, do not  
exceed the maximum inflation pressure indicated on the  
tire's sidewall. To decrease the tire's air-pressure use  
the pointed end of the valve cap, a pencil-style air  
pressure gauge, or a key.  
4. Start with the driver side front tire. The driver side  
front turn signal also comes on to indicate that  
corner's sensor is ready to be learned.  
5. Remove the valve cap from the tire's valve stem.  
Activate the TPMS sensor by increasing or  
decreasing the tire's air pressure for about  
eight seconds. The horn chirp, can take up to  
30 seconds to sound. It chirps one time and then  
all the turn signals flash one time to confirm the  
sensor identification code has been matched to  
the tire/wheel position.  
You have two minutes to match each tire and wheel  
position. If it takes longer than two minutes to match  
any tire and wheel position, the matching process  
stops and you need to start over.  
6-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. The passenger side front turn signal comes on to  
indicate that corner sensor is ready to be learned.  
Proceed to the passenger side front tire and repeat  
the procedure in Step 5.  
TPMS Matching Process for Vehicles  
without Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
1. Set the parking brake.  
7. The passenger side rear turn signal comes on to  
indicate that corner sensor is ready to be learned.  
Proceed to the passenger side rear tire and repeat  
the procedure in Step 5.  
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON/RUN with the  
engine off.  
3. Using the Driver Information Center (DIC), press  
the INFO and Set/Reset buttons at the same time  
for about one second. Then press and release the  
INFO button until the TIRE LEARN? message  
displays.  
8. The driver side rear turn signal comes on to  
indicate that corner sensor is ready to be learned.  
Proceed to the driver side rear tire, and repeat the  
procedure in Step 5.  
4. Press and hold the Set/Reset DIC button for  
approximately three seconds to start the TPMS  
learn mode. The horn sounds twice to indicate the  
TPMS receiver is ready and the TIRE LEARN ON  
message displays. The driver side front turn signal  
also comes on to indicate that corner sensor is  
ready to be learned.  
9. After hearing the single horn chirp for the driver  
side rear tire, two additional horn chirps sound to  
indicate the tire learning process is done. Turn the  
ignition switch to LOCK/OFF.  
If no tires are learned after entering the TPMS  
learn mode, or if communication with the receiver  
stops, or if the time limit has expired, turn the  
ignition switch to LOCK/OFF and start over  
beginning with Step 2.  
5. Start with the driver side front tire.  
6. Remove the valve cap from the tire's valve stem.  
Activate the TPMS sensor by increasing or  
decreasing the tire's air pressure for about  
eight seconds. The horn chirp, can take up to  
30 seconds to sound. It chirps one time and then  
all the turn signals flash one time to confirm the  
sensor identification code has been matched to  
the tire/wheel position.  
10. Set all four tires to the recommended air pressure  
level as indicated on the Tire and Loading  
Information label.  
11. Put the valve caps back on the valve stems.  
6-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. The passenger side front turn signal comes on to  
indicate that corner sensor is ready to be learned.  
Proceed to the passenger side front tire and repeat  
the procedure in Step 6.  
Tire Inspection and Rotation  
We recommend that you regularly inspect the  
vehicle's tires, including the spare tire, if the  
vehicle has one, for signs of wear or damage.  
SeeWhen It Is Time for New Tires on page 675  
for more information.  
8. The passenger side rear turn signal comes on to  
indicate that corner sensor is ready to be learned.  
Proceed to the passenger side rear tire and repeat  
the procedure in Step 6.  
Tires should be rotated every 5,000 to 8,000 miles  
(8 000 to 13 000 km). See Scheduled Maintenance  
9. The driver side rear turn signal comes on to  
indicate that corner sensor is ready to be learned.  
Proceed to the driver side rear tire, and repeat the  
procedure in Step 6.  
on page 73  
.
If this vehicle has P225/40R18 size tires, they  
should be rotated every 3,000 miles (5 000 km).  
10. After hearing the single horn chirp for the driver  
side rear tire, two additional horn chirps sound  
to indicate the tire learning process is done.  
The LEARN COMPLETE message displays  
if all four tire positions are learned. Turn the  
ignition switch to LOCK/OFF.  
The purpose of a regular tire rotation is to achieve  
a uniform wear for all tires on the vehicle. This will  
ensure that the vehicle continues to perform most  
like it did when the tires were new.  
Any time you notice unusual wear, rotate the tires  
as soon as possible and check wheel alignment.  
Also check for damaged tires or wheels.  
If no tires are learned after entering the TPMS  
learn mode, or if communication with the receiver  
stops, or if the time limit has expired, the TIRE  
LEARN? message displays on the DIC. Turn  
the ignition switch to LOCK/OFF and start over  
beginning with Step 2.  
SeeWhen It Is Time for New Tires on page 675  
and Wheel Replacement on page 680  
.
11. Set all four tires to the recommended air pressure  
level as indicated on the Tire and Loading  
Information label.  
12. Put the valve caps back on the valve stems.  
6-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has the Tire Pressure Monitor  
System (TPMS), reset the TPMS sensors after  
rotating the tires. See Tire Pressure Monitor  
Operation on page 668  
.
Make certain that all wheel nuts are properly  
tightened. See Wheel Nut Torqueunder  
Capacities and Specifications on page 6131  
.
WARNING:  
{
When rotating the vehicle's tires, always use the  
correct rotation pattern shown here.  
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to  
which it is fastened, can make wheel nuts  
become loose after time. The wheel could  
come off and cause an accident. When you  
change a wheel, remove any rust or dirt  
from places where the wheel attaches to  
the vehicle. In an emergency, you can use  
a cloth or a paper towel to do this; but be  
sure to use a scraper or wire brush later,  
if needed, to get all the rust or dirt off.  
Do not include the compact spare tire, if the  
vehicle has one, in the tire rotation.  
After the tires have been rotated, adjust the front  
and rear inflation pressures as shown on the Tire  
and Loading Information label. See Inflation - Tire  
Pressure on page 666 and Loading the Vehicle on  
page 525  
.
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 692  
.
6-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When It Is Time for New Tires  
Various factors, such as maintenance, temperatures,  
driving speeds, vehicle loading, and road conditions  
influence when you need new tires.  
You need new tires if any of the following statements  
are true:  
.
You can see the indicators at three or more places  
around the tire.  
.
You can see cord or fabric showing through the  
tire's rubber.  
One way to tell when it is  
time for new tires is to  
check the treadwear  
indicators, which will  
appear when your tires  
have only 1/16 inch  
(1.6 mm) or less of  
.
The tread or sidewall is cracked, cut, or snagged  
deep enough to show cord or fabric.  
.
The tire has a bump, bulge, or split.  
.
The tire has a puncture, cut, or other damage that  
cannot be repaired well because of the size or  
location of the damage.  
tread remaining.  
The rubber in tires degrades over time, even if they  
are not being used. This is also true for the spare tire,  
if your vehicle has one. Multiple conditions affect how  
fast this aging takes place, including temperatures,  
loading conditions, and inflation pressure maintenance.  
With proper care and maintenance tires will typically  
wear out before they degrade due to age. If you are  
unsure about the need to replace your tires as they get  
older, consult the tire manufacturer for more information.  
6-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GM recommends replacing tires in sets of four.  
This is because uniform tread depth on all tires  
will help keep your vehicle performing most like it  
did when the tires were new. Replacing less  
than a full set of tires can affect the braking  
and handling performance of your vehicle.  
See Tire Inspection and Rotation on page 673  
for information on proper tire rotation.  
Buying New Tires  
GM has developed and matched specific tires for  
your vehicle. The original equipment tires installed  
on your vehicle, when it was new, were designed  
to meet General Motors Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification (TPC Spec) system rating. If you  
need replacement tires, GM strongly recommends  
that you get tires with the same TPC Spec rating.  
This way, your vehicle will continue to have tires  
that are designed to give the same performance  
and vehicle safety, during normal use, as the  
original tires.  
WARNING:  
{
Mixing tires could cause you to lose control  
while driving. If you mix tires of different  
sizes, brands, or types (radial and  
GM's exclusive TPC Spec system considers over  
a dozen critical specifications that impact the  
overall performance of your vehicle, including  
brake system performance, ride and handling,  
traction control, and tire pressure monitoring  
performance. GM's TPC Spec number is molded  
onto the tire's sidewall near the tire size. If the  
tires have an allseason tread design, the TPC  
Spec number will be followed by an MS for  
mud and snow. See Tire Sidewall Labeling on  
page 659 for additional information.  
bias-belted tires), the vehicle may not  
handle properly, and you could have a crash.  
Using tires of different sizes, brands, or types  
may also cause damage to your vehicle.  
Be sure to use the correct size, brand, and  
type of tires on all wheels. It is all right to  
drive with your compact spare temporarily,  
as it was developed for use on your vehicle.  
See Compact Spare Tire on page 6114  
.
6-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicles that have a tire pressure monitoring  
system could give an inaccurate lowpressure  
warning if nonTPC Spec rated tires are installed  
on your vehicle. NonTPC Spec rated tires may  
give a lowpressure warning that is higher or lower  
than the proper warning level you would get with  
TPC Spec rated tires. See Tire Pressure Monitor  
WARNING:  
{
If you use bias-ply tires on the vehicle, the  
wheel rim flanges could develop cracks after  
many miles of driving. A tire and/or wheel  
could fail suddenly, causing a crash. Use  
only radial-ply tires with the wheels on the  
vehicle.  
System on page 667  
.
Your vehicle's original equipment tires are listed  
on the Tire and Loading Information Label.  
See Loading the Vehicle on page 525 , for  
more information about the Tire and Loading  
Information Label and its location on your vehicle.  
If you must replace your vehicle's tires with those  
that do not have a TPC Spec number, make sure  
they are the same size, load range, speed rating,  
and construction type (radial and biasbelted tires)  
as your vehicle's original tires.  
6-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Different Size Tires and Wheels  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
If you add wheels or tires that are a different size than  
your original equipment wheels and tires, this may  
affect the way your vehicle performs, including its  
braking, ride and handling characteristics, stability,  
and resistance to rollover . Additionally, if your vehicle  
has electronic systems such as, antilock brakes,  
traction control, and electronic stability control, the  
performance of these systems can be affected.  
Quality grades can be found where applicable  
on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and  
maximum section width. For example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA  
Temperature A  
The following information relates to the system  
developed by the United States National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA),  
which grades tires by treadwear, traction, and  
temperature performance. This applies only to  
vehicles sold in the United States. The grades are  
molded on the sidewalls of most passenger car  
tires. The Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG)  
system does not apply to deep tread, winter-type  
snow tires, space-saver, or temporary use spare  
tires, tires with nominal rim diameters of  
WARNING:  
{
If you add different sized wheels, your vehicle  
may not provide an acceptable level of  
performance and safety if tires not recommended  
for those wheels are selected. You may increase  
the chance that you will crash and suffer serious  
injury. Only use GM specific wheel and tire  
systems developed for your vehicle, and have  
them properly installed by a GM certified  
technician.  
10 to 12 inches (25 to 30 cm), or to some  
limited-production tires.  
See Buying New Tires on page 676 and Accessories  
and Modifications on page 64 for additional  
information.  
6-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
While the tires available on General Motors  
passenger cars and light trucks may vary with  
respect to these grades, they must also conform  
to federal safety requirements and additional  
General Motors Tire Performance Criteria (TPC)  
standards.  
depends upon the actual conditions of their use,  
however, and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits, service  
practices and differences in road characteristics  
and climate.  
Traction AA, A, B, C  
All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform to Federal  
Safety Requirements In Addition To These  
Grades.  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest,  
are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent  
the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as  
measured under controlled conditions on  
specified government test surfaces of asphalt  
and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance. Warning: The traction grade  
assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead  
braking traction tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak  
traction characteristics.  
Treadwear  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating  
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested  
under controlled conditions on a specified  
government test course. For example, a tire  
graded 150 would wear one and a half (1½) times  
as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires  
6-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Temperature A, B, C  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B,  
and C, representing the tire's resistance to the  
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate  
heat when tested under controlled conditions  
on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
Sustained high temperature can cause the  
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce  
tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to  
sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to  
a level of performance which all passenger car  
tires must meet under the Federal Motor Safety  
Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent  
higher levels of performance on the laboratory  
test wheel than the minimum required by law.  
Warning: The temperature grade for this tire is  
established for a tire that is properly inflated and  
not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation,  
or excessive loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause heat buildup and possible  
tire failure.  
The tires and wheels on your vehicle were aligned and  
balanced carefully at the factory to give you the longest  
tire life and best overall performance. Adjustments  
to wheel alignment and tire balancing will not be  
necessary on a regular basis. However, if you notice  
unusual tire wear or your vehicle pulling to one side  
or the other, the alignment might need to be checked.  
If you notice your vehicle vibrating when driving on  
a smooth road, the tires and wheels might need to  
be rebalanced. See your dealer/retailer for proper  
diagnosis.  
Wheel Replacement  
Replace any wheel that is bent, cracked, or badly  
rusted or corroded. If wheel nuts keep coming loose,  
the wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel nuts should be  
replaced. If the wheel leaks air, replace it (except some  
aluminum wheels, which can sometimes be repaired).  
See your dealer/retailer if any of these conditions exist.  
Your dealer/retailer will know the kind of wheel  
you need.  
6-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Each new wheel should have the same load-carrying  
capacity, diameter, width, offset, and be mounted the  
same way as the one it replaces.  
Notice: The wrong wheel can also cause problems  
with bearing life, brake cooling, speedometer or  
odometer calibration, headlamp aim, bumper height,  
vehicle ground clearance, and tire or tire chain  
clearance to the body and chassis.  
If you need to replace any of your wheels, wheel bolts,  
wheel nuts, or Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)  
sensors, replace them only with new GM original  
equipment parts. This way, you will be sure to have  
the right wheel, wheel bolts, wheel nuts, and TPMS  
sensors for your vehicle.  
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 692 for more  
information.  
Used Replacement Wheels  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Putting a used wheel on the vehicle is dangerous.  
You cannot know how it has been used or how  
far it has been driven. It could fail suddenly and  
cause a crash. If you have to replace a wheel,  
use a new GM original equipment wheel.  
Using the wrong replacement wheels, wheel bolts,  
or wheel nuts on your vehicle can be dangerous.  
It could affect the braking and handling of your  
vehicle, make your tires lose air and make you  
lose control. You could have a collision in which  
you or others could be injured. Always use the  
correct wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel nuts for  
replacement.  
6-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If your vehicle has a tire size other than  
P195/65R15, P205/55R16, P205/50R17 or 225/40R18  
size tires, use tire chains only where legal and only  
when you must. Use only SAE Class Stype chains  
that are the proper size for your tires. Install them  
on the front tires and tighten them as tightly as  
possible with the ends securely fastened. Drive  
slowly and follow the chain manufacturer's  
instructions. If you can hear the chains contacting  
your vehicle, stop and retighten them. If the contact  
continues, slow down until it stops. Driving too fast  
or spinning the wheels with chains on will damage  
your vehicle.  
Tire Chains  
WARNING:  
{
If your vehicle has P195/65R15, P205/55R16,  
P205/50R17, or 225/40R18 size tires, do not  
use tire chains. They can damage your vehicle  
because there is not enough clearance.  
Tire chains used on a vehicle without the proper  
amount of clearance can cause damage to the  
brakes, suspension, or other vehicle parts.  
The area damaged by the tire chains could  
cause you to lose control of your vehicle and  
you or others may be injured in a crash.  
If a Tire Goes Flat  
It is unusual for a tire to blowout while you are driving,  
especially if you maintain the tires properly. See Tires  
on page 657. If air goes out of a tire, It is much more  
likely to leak out slowly. But if you should ever have a  
blowout, here are a few tips about what to expect and  
what to do:  
Use another type of traction device only if its  
manufacturer recommends it for use on your  
vehicle and tire size combination, and road  
conditions. Follow that manufacturer's  
instructions. To help avoid damage to your  
vehicle, drive slowly, readjust, or remove the  
device if it is contacting your vehicle, and do  
not spin your vehicle's wheels.  
If a front tire fails, the flat tire will create a drag that  
pulls the vehicle toward that side. Take your foot off the  
accelerator pedal and grip the steering wheel firmly.  
Steer to maintain lane position, and then gently brake  
to a stop well out of the traffic lane.  
If you do find traction devices that will fit, install  
them on the front tires.  
6-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A rear blowout, particularly on a curve, acts much like a  
skid and may require the same correction you would  
use in a skid. In any rear blowout, remove your foot  
from the accelerator pedal. Get the vehicle under  
control by steering the way you want the vehicle to go.  
It may be very bumpy and noisy, but you can still steer.  
Gently brake to a stop, well off the road if possible.  
WARNING:  
{
Lifting a vehicle and getting under it to do  
maintenance or repairs is dangerous without  
the appropriate safety equipment and training.  
If a jack is provided with the vehicle, it is designed  
only for changing a flat tire. If it is used for  
anything else, you or others could be badly  
injured or killed if the vehicle slips off the jack.  
If a jack is provided with the vehicle, only use it  
for changing a flat tire.  
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire and wheel damage  
by driving slowly to a level place and stopping.  
1. Turn on the hazard warning flashers. See Hazard  
Warning Flashers on page 43.  
2. Park the vehicle. Set the parking brake firmly and  
put the shift lever in P (Park).  
3. Turn off the engine.  
4. Inspect the flat tire.  
This vehicle may come with a jack and spare tire or a  
tire sealant and compressor kit. To use the jack and  
spare tire, see Changing a Flat Tire on page 692  
.
To use the tire sealant and compressor kit, see Tire  
Sealant and Compressor Kit on page 684.  
6-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
WARNING:  
WARNING:  
{
{
Storing the tire sealant and compressor kit or  
other equipment in the passenger compartment of  
the vehicle could cause injury. In a sudden stop or  
collision, loose equipment could strike someone.  
Store the tire sealant and compressor kit in its  
original location.  
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed area with poor  
ventilation is dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust contains  
Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen  
or smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and  
even death. Never run the engine in an enclosed  
area that has no fresh air ventilation. For more  
information, see Engine Exhaust on page 335.  
If this vehicle has a tire sealant and compressor kit,  
there may not be a spare tire, tire changing equipment,  
and on some vehicles there may not be a place to store  
a tire.  
The tire sealant and compressor can be used to  
temporarily seal punctures up to ¼ inch (6 mm) in the  
tread area of the tire. It can also be used to inflate an  
under inflated tire.  
WARNING:  
{
Over-inflating a tire could cause the tire to rupture  
and you or others could be injured. Be sure to  
read and follow the tire sealant and compressor  
kit instructions and inflate the tire to its  
recommended pressure. Do not exceed the  
recommended pressure.  
If the tire has been separated from the wheel, has  
damaged sidewalls, or has a large puncture, the tire  
is too severely damaged for the tire sealant and  
compressor kit to be effective. See Roadside  
Assistance Program on page 87.  
Read and follow all of the tire sealant and compressor  
kit instructions.  
6-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The kit includes:  
Tire Sealant  
Read and follow the safe handling instructions on the  
label adhered to the sealant canister.  
Check the tire sealant expiration date on the sealant  
canister. The sealant canister should be replaced before  
its expiration date. Replacement sealant canisters are  
available at your local dealer/retailer. See Removal and  
Installation of the Sealant Canisterfollowing.  
There is only enough sealant to seal one tire. After  
usage, the sealant canister and sealant/air hose  
assembly must be replaced. See Removal and  
Installation of the Sealant Canisterfollowing.  
A. Air Compressor  
B. Tire Sealant Canister  
C. Power Plug  
E. Pressure Gauge  
F. Air Only Hose (Black)  
G. Sealant/Air Hose (Clear)  
D. On/Off Button  
6-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Always do a safety check first. See If a Tire Goes Flat  
on page 682. Do not remove any objects that have  
penetrated the tire.  
Using the Tire Sealant and Compressor  
Kit to Temporarily Seal and Inflate a  
Punctured Tire  
1. Remove the tire sealant and compressor kit  
from its storage location. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit Storage on page 691.  
Make sure the on/off button (D) is in the  
off (O) position.  
2. Unwrap the sealant/air hose (G) and the power  
plug (C).  
3. Place the kit on the ground.  
Make sure the tire valve stem is positioned close to  
the ground so the hose will reach it.  
4. Remove the valve stem cap from the flat tire by  
turning it counterclockwise.  
5. Attach the sealant/air hose (G) onto the tire valve  
stem. Turn it clockwise until it is tight.  
When using the tire sealant and compressor kit  
during cold temperatures, warm the kit in a heated  
environment for 5 minutes. This will help to inflate  
the tire faster.  
6-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Plug the power plug (C) into the accessory power  
outlet in the vehicle. Unplug all items from other  
accessory power outlets. See Accessory Power  
Outlet(s) on page 412.  
9. Inflate the tire to the recommended inflation  
pressure using the pressure gauge (E).  
The recommended inflation pressure can be  
found on the Tire and Loading Information label.  
See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 666.  
If the vehicle has an accessory power outlet, do  
not use the cigarette lighter.  
The pressure gauge (E) may read higher than  
the actual tire pressure while the compressor  
is on. Turn the compressor off to get an accurate  
pressure reading. The compressor may be turned  
on/off until the correct pressure is reached.  
If the vehicle only has a cigarette lighter, use the  
cigarette lighter.  
Do not pinch the power plug cord in the door or  
window.  
Notice: If the recommended pressure cannot be  
reached after approximately 25 minutes, the vehicle  
should not be driven farther. The tire is too severely  
damaged and the tire sealant and compressor kit  
cannot inflate the tire. Remove the power plug  
from the accessory power outlet and unscrew the  
inflating hose from the tire valve. See Roadside  
Assistance Program on page 87.  
7. Start the vehicle. The vehicle must be running  
while using the air compressor.  
8. Press the on/off (D) button to turn the tire sealant  
and compressor kit on.  
The compressor will inject sealant and air into  
the tire.  
The pressure gauge (E) will initially show a  
high pressure while the compressor pushes the  
sealant into the tire. Once the sealant is completely  
dispersed into the tire, the pressure will quickly  
drop and start to rise again as the tire inflates  
with air only.  
10. Press the on/off button (D) to turn the tire sealant  
and compressor kit off.  
The tire is not sealed and will continue to leak  
air until the vehicle is driven and the sealant is  
distributed in the tire, therefore, Steps 11 through  
17 must be done immediately after Step 10.  
Be careful while handling the tire sealant and  
compressor kit as it could be warm after usage.  
6-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11. Unplug the power plug (C) from the accessory  
power outlet in the vehicle.  
18. Stop at a safe location and check the tire pressure.  
Refer to Steps 1 through 11 under Using the Tire  
Sealant and Compressor Kit without Sealant to  
Inflate a Tire (Not Punctured).”  
12. Turn the sealant/air hose (G) counterclockwise to  
remove it from the tire valve stem.  
If the tire pressure has fallen more than 10 psi  
(68 kPa) below the recommended inflation  
pressure, stop driving the vehicle. The tire is too  
severely damaged and the tire sealant cannot seal  
the tire. See Roadside Assistance Program on  
13. Replace the tire valve stem cap.  
14. Replace the sealant/air hose (G), and the power  
plug (C) back in their original location.  
15. If the flat tire was  
able to inflate to the  
recommended inflation  
pressure, remove the  
maximum speed label  
from the sealant  
page 87  
.
If the tire pressure has not dropped more than  
10 psi (68 kPa) from the recommended inflation  
pressure, inflate the tire to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
canister (B) and place  
it in a highly visible  
location.  
19. Wipe off any sealant from the wheel, tire or  
vehicle.  
20. Dispose of the used sealant canister (B) and  
sealant/air hose (G) assembly at a local dealer/  
retailer or in accordance with local state codes  
and practices.  
The label is a reminder not to exceed 55 mph  
(90 km/h) until the damaged tire is repaired or  
replaced.  
21. Replace it with a new canister available from your  
dealer/retailer.  
22. After temporarily sealing a tire using the tire  
sealant and compressor kit, take the vehicle to  
an authorized dealer/retailer within a 100 miles  
(161 km) of driving to have the tire repaired or  
replaced.  
16. Return the equipment to its original storage  
location in the vehicle.  
17. Immediately drive the vehicle 5 miles (8 km) to  
distribute the sealant in the tire.  
6-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Pull the air only hose (F) from the sealant  
canister (B).  
Using the Tire Sealant and Compressor  
Kit without Sealant to Inflate a Tire  
(Not Punctured)  
4. Remove the power plug (C) from the air  
compressor (A).  
To use the air compressor to inflate a tire with air only  
and not sealant:  
5. Place the kit on the ground.  
Make sure the tire valve stem is positioned close to  
the ground so the hose will reach it.  
6. Remove the tire valve stem cap by turning it  
counterclockwise.  
7. Attach the air only hose (F) onto the tire valve stem  
and press the lever down to secure it.  
8. Plug the power plug (C) into the accessory power  
outlet in the vehicle. Unplug all items from other  
accessory power outlets. See Accessory Power  
Outlet(s) on page 412.  
If the vehicle has an accessory power outlet, do  
not use the cigarette lighter.  
If the vehicle only has a cigarette lighter, use the  
cigarette lighter.  
Do not pinch the power plug cord in the door or  
window.  
Always do a safety check first. See If a Tire Goes Flat  
on page 682  
.
9. Start the vehicle. The vehicle must be running  
while using the air compressor.  
1. Remove the tire sealant and compressor kit  
from its storage location. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit Storage on page 691.  
10. Press the on/off (D) button to turn the  
compressor on.  
2. Unlock the air only hose (F) from the sealant  
canister (B) by pulling up on the lever.  
The compressor will inflate the tire with air only.  
6-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11. Inflate the tire to the recommended inflation  
pressure using the pressure gauge (E).  
Removal and Installation of the Sealant  
Canister  
The recommended inflation pressure can be  
found on the Tire and Loading Information label.  
See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 666.  
To remove the sealant canister:  
The pressure gauge (E) may read higher than the  
actual tire pressure while the compressor is on.  
Turn the compressor off to get an accurate  
reading. The compressor may be turned on/off  
until the correct pressure is reached.  
12. Press the on/off button (D) to turn the tire sealant  
and compressor kit off.  
Be careful while handling the tire sealant and  
compressor kit as it could be warm after usage.  
13. Unplug the power plug (C) from the accessory  
power outlet in the vehicle.  
14. Disconnect the air only hose (F) from the tire valve  
stem, by turning it counterclockwise, and replace  
the tire valve stem cap.  
1. Unlock the air only hose (F) from the sealant  
canister (B) by pulling up on the lever.  
15. Replace the air only hose (F) and the power  
plug (C) back in its original location.  
2. Pull the air only hose (F) from the sealant  
canister (B).  
16. Place the equipment in the original storage location  
in the vehicle.  
3. Unwrap the sealant/air hose (G) from the  
compressor (A).  
6-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To install a new sealant canister:  
1. Align the sealant/air hose (G) with the slot in the air  
compressor.  
2. Push the sealant canister (B) down and turn it  
clockwise.  
3. Wrap the sealant/air hose (G) around the air  
compressor channel to stow it in its original  
location.  
4. Push the air compressor inflator hose (F) onto the  
sealant canister inlet and push the lever down.  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
Storage  
The tire sealant and compressor kit is located in the  
trunk.  
1. Open the trunk. See Trunk on page 312.  
4. Turn the sealant canister (B) so the inflator filling  
hose is aligned with the slot in the compressor.  
2. Lift the trunk liner.  
5. Lift the sealant canister (B) from the compressor  
and replace with a new sealant canister. See your  
dealer/retailer for more information.  
6-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Changing a tire can be dangerous. The vehicle  
can slip off the jack and roll over or fall on you or  
other people. You and they could be badly injured  
or even killed. Find a level place to change your  
tire. To help prevent the vehicle from moving:  
1. Set the parking brake firmly.  
2. Put an automatic transmission shift lever in  
P (Park), or shift a manual transmission to  
1 (First) or R (Reverse).  
3. Turn off the engine and do not restart while  
the vehicle is raised.  
3. Remove the retainer that holds the tire sealant and  
compressor kit.  
4. Do not allow passengers to remain in the  
vehicle.  
4. Remove the kit from the foam container.  
To be even more certain the vehicle will not move,  
you should put blocks at the front and rear of the  
tire farthest away from the one being changed.  
That would be the tire on the other side, at the  
opposite end of the vehicle.  
To store the tire sealant and compressor kit, reverse  
the steps.  
Changing a Flat Tire  
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire and wheel damage  
by driving slowly to a level place. Turn on the hazard  
warning flashers. See Hazard Warning Flashers on  
page 43  
.
6-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the vehicle has a flat tire (B), use the following  
example as a guide to assist you in the placement of  
wheel blocks (A).  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools  
The equipment you will need is located in the trunk.  
Base Models  
1. Open the trunk. See Trunk on page 312.  
A. Wheel Block  
B. Flat Tire  
2. Lift the trunk liner to access the spare tire and  
tools.  
The following information explains how to use the jack  
and change a tire.  
6-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Cover  
B. Retainer  
C. Spare Tire  
D. Wing Nut  
E. Jack and Wheel Wrench  
F. Bolt  
6-94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Remove the retainer (B) that holds down the spare  
tire. See Compact Spare Tire on page 6114 for  
more information.  
Uplevel Models  
1. Open the trunk. See Trunk on page 312.  
4. Remove the spare tire (C) by gently pulling it up  
and out of the trunk.  
5. Remove the wing nut (D) that holds the jack and  
remove the jack and wheel wrench (E).  
2. Lift the trunk liner to access the spare tire and  
tools.  
6-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Retainer  
B. Jack and Wheel Wrench  
C. Spare Tire  
D. Foam Support  
E. Bolt  
3. Remove the retainer (A) that holds down the jack,  
wheel wrench (B) and spare tire (C).  
4. Remove the spare tire by gently pulling it up and  
out of the trunk.  
The tools you will be using include the jack (A) and  
wheel wrench (B).  
6-96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
You will need to turn the plastic wheel nut  
counterclockwise to loosen the wheel wrench  
from the jack.  
Press the button and then pull on the end of the wheel  
wrench to extend the handle.  
6-97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. If necessary, use the flat end of the wheel wrench  
to pry along the edge of the wheel cover until it  
comes off.  
Removing the Flat Tire and  
Installing the Spare Tire  
(All Models Except SS)  
Store the wheel cover in the trunk until the flat tire  
is repaired or replaced.  
1. Do a safety check before proceeding.  
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 692.  
4. Use the wheel wrench to loosen all the wheel nuts.  
Do not remove them yet.  
Notice: Make sure that the jack lift head is in the  
correct position or you may damage your vehicle.  
The repairs would not be covered by your warranty.  
2. If your vehicle has plastic wheel covers, use the  
wheel wrench to loosen the plastic wheel nut caps.  
Once the plastic wheel nut caps have been  
loosened with the wheel wrench, you can finish  
loosening them with your fingers. The plastic nut  
caps do not come off.  
6-98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is  
dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you  
could be badly injured or killed. Never get under a  
vehicle when it is supported only by a jack.  
WARNING:  
{
Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly  
positioned can damage the vehicle and even  
make the vehicle fall. To help avoid personal  
injury and vehicle damage, be sure to fit the jack  
lift head into the proper location before raising the  
vehicle.  
5. Position the jack lift head at the jack location  
nearest the flat tire. The front location is about  
8 inches (20 cm) behind the front wheel opening.  
The rear location is about 4 inches (10 cm) in front  
of the rear wheel opening.  
6. Raise the jack head until it fits firmly in the  
vehicle's frame, where the notch is located,  
nearest the flat tire.  
8. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
clockwise. Raise the vehicle far enough off the  
ground so there is enough room for the compact  
spare tire to fit under the vehicle.  
7. Put the compact spare tire near the flat tire.  
6-99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9. Remove all of the  
10. Remove any rust or dirt  
from the wheel bolts,  
mounting surfaces,  
wheel nuts and flat tire.  
and spare wheel.  
11. Place the compact spare tire on the  
wheel-mounting surface.  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it  
is fastened, can make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come off and cause  
an accident. When changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches  
to the vehicle. In an emergency, use a cloth or  
a paper towel to do this; but be sure to use a  
scraper or wire brush later, if needed, to get all  
the rust or dirt off. See Changing a Flat Tire on  
Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts because  
the nuts might come loose. The vehicle's wheel  
could fall off, causing a crash.  
12. Reinstall the wheel nuts with the rounded end of  
the nuts toward the wheel. Tighten each nut by  
hand until the wheel is held against the hub.  
13. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
counterclockwise. Lower the jack completely.  
page 692  
.
6-100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Wheel nuts that are improperly or incorrectly  
tightened can cause the wheels to become  
loose or come off. The wheel nuts should be  
tightened with a torque wrench to the proper  
torque specification after replacing. Follow the  
torque specification supplied by the aftermarket  
manufacturer when using accessory locking wheel  
nuts. See Capacities and Specifications on  
page 6131 for original equipment wheel nut  
torque specifications.  
4-Wheel Nuts  
5-Wheel Nuts  
14. Tighten the wheel nuts firmly in a crisscross  
sequence, as shown.  
Notice: Improperly tightened wheel nuts can  
lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage.  
To avoid expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten  
the wheel nuts in the proper sequence and to the  
proper torque specification. See Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6131 for the wheel nut  
torque specification.  
Notice: Wheel covers will not fit on your vehicle's  
compact spare. If you try to put a wheel cover on  
the compact spare, the cover or the spare could be  
damaged.  
6-101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing  
the Spare Tire (SS Model)  
The SS Model has larger performance brakes than the  
base model. The compact spare tire will not clear the  
front brakes.  
Do not use the compact spare tire in the event of a front  
flat tire.  
You must use the rear tire to replace the front flat tire.  
To change the rear road tire:  
Rear Tire Changing Procedure  
1. Do a safety check before proceeding.  
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 692  
for more information.  
2. If your vehicle has plastic wheel covers, use the  
wheel wrench to loosen the plastic wheel nut caps.  
Once the plastic wheel nut caps have been  
loosened with the wheel wrench, you can finish  
loosening them with your fingers. The plastic nut  
caps do not come off.  
6-102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. If necessary, use the flat end of the wheel wrench  
to pry along the edge of the rear wheel cover until  
it comes off.  
Store the wheel cover in the trunk until the flat tire  
is repaired or replaced.  
4. Use the wheel wrench to loosen all the rear wheel  
nuts. Do not remove them yet.  
Notice: Make sure that the jack lift head is in the  
correct position or you may damage your vehicle.  
The repairs would not be covered by your warranty.  
5. Position the jack lift head at the rear jack location  
nearest the rear tire. The rear location is about  
4 inches (10 cm) in front of the rear wheel opening.  
6-103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Raise the jack head until it fits firmly in the  
vehicle's frame, where the notch is located,  
nearest the flat tire.  
8. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
clockwise. Raise the vehicle far enough off the  
ground so there is enough room for the compact  
spare tire to fit under the vehicle.  
7. Put the compact spare tire near the rear tire.  
9. Remove all of the  
wheel nuts.  
WARNING:  
{
Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is  
dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you  
could be badly injured or killed. Never get under a  
vehicle when it is supported only by a jack.  
WARNING:  
{
Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly  
positioned can damage the vehicle and even  
make the vehicle fall. To help avoid personal  
injury and vehicle damage, be sure to fit the jack  
lift head into the proper location before raising the  
vehicle.  
6-104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11. Remove any rust or dirt  
from the wheel bolts,  
mounting surfaces,  
WARNING:  
{
and spare wheel.  
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it  
is fastened, can make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come off and cause  
an accident. When changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches  
to the vehicle. In an emergency, use a cloth or  
a paper towel to do this; but be sure to use a  
scraper or wire brush later, if needed, to get all  
the rust or dirt off. See Changing a Flat Tire on  
Reinstall the wheel nuts with the rounded end of  
the nuts toward the wheel. Tighten each nut by  
hand until the wheel is held against the hub.  
page 692  
.
12. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
counterclockwise. Lower the jack completely.  
10. Place the compact spare tire on the  
wheel-mounting surface.  
WARNING:  
{
Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts because  
the nuts might come loose. The vehicle's wheel  
could fall off, causing a crash.  
6-105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13. Tighten the wheel nuts  
firmly in a crisscross  
WARNING:  
{
sequence, as shown.  
Wheel nuts that are improperly or incorrectly  
tightened can cause the wheels to become  
loose or come off. The wheel nuts should be  
tightened with a torque wrench to the proper  
torque specification after replacing. Follow the  
torque specification supplied by the aftermarket  
manufacturer when using accessory locking  
wheel nuts. See Capacities and Specifications on  
page 6131 for original equipment wheel nut  
torque specifications.  
5-Wheel Nuts  
Notice: Wheel covers will not fit on your vehicle's  
compact spare. If you try to put a wheel cover on  
the compact spare, the cover or the spare could be  
damaged.  
Notice: Improperly tightened wheel nuts can  
lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage.  
To avoid expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten  
the wheel nuts in the proper sequence and to the  
proper torque specification. See Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6131 for the wheel nut  
torque specification.  
6-106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To change the front flat tire:  
Front Flat Tire Changing Procedure:  
1. Perform a rear tire change by removing the rear  
tire and installing the compact spare tire in the rear  
wheel location. The rear road tire will be used to  
replace the front flat tire. See Rear Tire Changing  
Procedure in this section.  
2. Do a safety check before proceeding.  
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 692.  
3. If your vehicle has plastic wheel covers, use the  
wheel wrench to loosen the plastic wheel nut caps.  
Once the plastic wheel nut caps have been  
loosened with the wheel wrench, you can finish  
loosening them with your fingers. The plastic nut  
caps do not come off.  
6-107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. If necessary, use the flat end of the wheel wrench  
to pry along the edge of the wheel cover until it  
comes off.  
Notice: Make sure that the jack lift head is in the  
correct position or you may damage your vehicle.  
The repairs would not be covered by your warranty.  
Store the wheel cover in the trunk until the flat tire  
is repaired or replaced.  
7. Raise the jack head until it fits firmly in the  
vehicle's frame, where the notch is located,  
nearest the flat tire.  
5. Use the wheel wrench to loosen all the wheel nuts  
on the flat tire. Do not remove them yet.  
8. Put the tire near the flat tire.  
WARNING:  
{
Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is  
dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you  
could be badly injured or killed. Never get under  
a vehicle when it is supported only by a jack.  
6. Position the jack lift head at the jack location  
nearest the flat tire. The front location is about  
8 inches (20 cm) behind the front wheel opening.  
6-108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11. Remove any rust or dirt  
from the wheel bolts,  
mounting surfaces,  
WARNING:  
{
and spare wheel.  
Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly  
positioned can damage the vehicle and even  
make the vehicle fall. To help avoid personal  
injury and vehicle damage, be sure to fit the jack  
lift head into the proper location before raising the  
vehicle.  
9. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
clockwise. Raise the vehicle far enough off the  
ground so there is enough room for the compact  
spare tire to fit under the vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
10. Remove all of the  
wheel nuts.  
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it  
is fastened, can make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come off and cause  
an accident. When changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches  
to the vehicle. In an emergency, use a cloth or  
a paper towel to do this; but be sure to use a  
scraper or wire brush later, if needed, to get all  
the rust or dirt off. See Changing a Flat Tire on  
page 692  
.
6-109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12. Place the tire on the wheel-mounting surface.  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Wheel nuts that are improperly or incorrectly  
tightened can cause the wheels to become  
loose or come off. The wheel nuts should be  
tightened with a torque wrench to the proper  
torque specification after replacing. Follow the  
torque specification supplied by the aftermarket  
manufacturer when using accessory locking wheel  
nuts. See Capacities and Specifications on  
page 6131 for original equipment wheel nut  
torque specifications.  
Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts because  
the nuts might come loose. The vehicle's wheel  
could fall off, causing a crash.  
13. Reinstall the wheel nuts with the rounded end of  
the nuts toward the wheel. Tighten each nut by  
hand until the wheel is held against the hub.  
14. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
counterclockwise. Lower the jack completely.  
Notice: Improperly tightened wheel nuts can  
lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage.  
To avoid expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten  
the wheel nuts in the proper sequence and to the  
proper torque specification. See Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6131 for the wheel nut  
torque specification.  
6-110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
15. Tighten the wheel nuts  
firmly in a crisscross  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and  
Tools  
sequence, as shown.  
WARNING:  
{
Storing a jack, a tire, or other equipment in the  
passenger compartment of the vehicle could  
cause injury. In a sudden stop or collision, loose  
equipment could strike someone. Store all these  
in the proper place.  
5-Wheel Nuts  
Notice: Wheel covers will not fit on your vehicle's  
compact spare. If you try to put a wheel cover on  
the compact spare, the cover or the spare could be  
damaged.  
6-111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Cover  
B. Retainer  
C. Jack and Wheel Wrench  
D. Stow Bolt Extension Rod  
E. Flat Tire  
F. Bolt  
Base Model  
6-112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Cover  
B. Retainer  
C. Jack and Wheel Wrench  
D. Stow Bolt Extension Rod  
E. Flat Tire  
F. Foam Support  
G. Bolt  
To store a flat tire and tools:  
1. Remove the stow bolt extension rod and sleeve  
from the jack.  
2. Screw the stow bolt extension rod and the sleeve  
into the existing spare tire hold-down bolt.  
3. If your vehicle has aluminum wheels, first remove  
the center cap with your hand or the wheel wrench.  
4. Place the flat tire face down into the spare tire tub.  
5. Re-attach the wheel wrench to the jack.  
6. Place the jack into the center of the flat tire, being  
careful not to scratch the inside of the wheel.  
7. Remove the plastic sleeve from the stow bolt  
extension rod. Secure the jack and road wheel  
using the larger plastic retainer.  
8. If used in the vehicle, place the smaller jack  
retainer nut in a safe place until you are ready to  
store the compact spare tire in the trunk again.  
Uplevel Model  
6-113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To store the compact spare tire and tools, follow  
the previous procedure without using the stow bolt  
extension rod and see Removing the Spare Tire and  
Tools on page 693 and follow the removal procedure,  
in reverse, for the proper jack storage instructions for  
this vehicle.  
After installing the compact spare on the vehicle, if the  
vehicle has one, stop as soon as possible and make  
sure the spare tire is correctly inflated. The compact  
spare is made to perform well at speeds up to 65 mph  
(105 km/h) for distances up to 3,000 miles (5 000 km),  
so you can finish your trip and have the full-size tire  
repaired or replaced at your convenience. Of course, it  
is best to replace the spare with a full-size tire as soon  
as possible. The spare tire will last longer and be in  
good shape in case it is needed again.  
The compact spare tire is for temporary use only.  
Replace the compact spare with a full-size tire as soon  
as possible.  
Notice: When the compact spare is installed, do not  
take the vehicle through an automatic car wash with  
guide rails. The compact spare can get caught on  
the rails which can damage the tire, wheel and other  
parts of the vehicle.  
Compact Spare Tire  
WARNING:  
{
Do not use the compact spare on other vehicles.  
Driving with more than one compact spare tire at  
a time could result in loss of braking and handling.  
This could lead to a crash and you or others could  
be injured. Use only one compact spare tire at  
a time.  
And do not mix the compact spare tire or wheel with  
other wheels or tires. They will not fit. Keep the spare  
tire and its wheel together.  
Notice: Tire chains will not fit the compact spare.  
Using them can damage the vehicle and can  
damage the chains too. Do not use tire chains  
on the compact spare.  
This vehicle may have a compact spare tire.  
Although the compact spare tire was fully inflated  
when the vehicle was new, it can lose air after a time.  
Check the inflation pressure regularly. It should be  
60 psi (420 kPa).  
6-114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
surfaces for which they were not intended. Use glass  
cleaner only on glass. Remove any accidental  
over-spray from other surfaces immediately. To prevent  
over-spray, apply cleaner directly to the cleaning cloth.  
Appearance Care  
Interior Cleaning  
The vehicle's interior will continue to look its best if  
it is cleaned often. Although not always visible, dust  
and dirt can accumulate on the upholstery. Dirt can  
damage carpet, fabric, leather, and plastic surfaces.  
Regular vacuuming is recommended to remove  
particles from the upholstery. It is important to keep  
the upholstery from becoming and remaining heavily  
soiled. Soils should be removed as quickly as possible.  
The vehicle's interior may experience extremes of heat  
that could cause stains to set rapidly.  
Notice: Using abrasive cleaners when cleaning  
glass surfaces on the vehicle, could scratch the  
glass and/or cause damage to the rear window  
defogger. When cleaning the glass on the vehicle,  
use only a soft cloth and glass cleaner.  
Many cleaners contain solvents that may become  
concentrated in the vehicle's breathing space.  
Before using cleaners, read and adhere to all safety  
instructions on the label. While cleaning the vehicle's  
interior, maintain adequate ventilation by opening the  
vehicle's doors and windows.  
Lighter colored interiors may require more frequent  
cleaning. Use care because newspapers and garments  
that transfer color to home furnishings may also transfer  
color to the vehicle's interior.  
Dust may be removed from small buttons and knobs  
using a small brush with soft bristles.  
Products that remove odors from the vehicle's  
upholstery and clean the vehicle's glass can be  
obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
When cleaning the vehicle's interior, only use cleaners  
specifically designed for the surfaces being cleaned.  
Permanent damage may result from using cleaners on  
6-115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not clean the vehicle using:  
Fabric/Carpet  
.
A knife or any other sharp object to remove a soil  
Use a vacuum cleaner with a soft brush attachment  
frequently to remove dust and loose dirt. A canister  
vacuum with a beater bar in the nozzle may only be  
used on floor carpet and carpeted floor mats. For any  
soil, always try to remove it first with plain water or club  
soda. Before cleaning, gently remove as much of the  
soil as possible using one of the following techniques:  
from any interior surface.  
.
A stiff brush. It can cause damage to the vehicle's  
interior surfaces.  
.
Heavy pressure or aggressive rubbing with a  
cleaning cloth. Use of heavy pressure can damage  
the interior and does not improve the effectiveness  
of soil removal.  
.
For liquids: gently blot the remaining soil with a  
paper towel. Allow the soil to absorb into the paper  
towel until no more can be removed.  
.
Laundry detergents or dishwashing soaps with  
degreasers can leave residue that streaks and  
attracts dirt. For liquid cleaners, about 20 drops  
per gallon (3.78 L) of water is a good guide.  
Use only mild, neutral-pH soaps.  
.
For solid dry soils: remove as much as possible  
and then vacuum.  
To clean:  
.
Too much cleaner that saturates the upholstery.  
1. Saturate a lint-free, clean white cloth with water or  
club soda.  
.
Organic solvents such as naptha, alcohol, etc. that  
can damage the vehicle's interior.  
2. Wring the cloth to remove excess moisture.  
3. Start on the outside edge of the soil and gently rub  
toward the center. Continue cleaning, using a clean  
area of the cloth each time it becomes soiled.  
4. Continue to gently rub the soiled area until the  
cleaning cloth remains clean.  
5. If the soil is not completely removed, use a mild  
soap solution and repeat the cleaning process that  
was used with plain water.  
6-116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If any of the soil remains, a commercial fabric cleaner  
or spot lifter may be necessary. When a commercial  
upholstery cleaner or spot lifter is to be used, test a  
small hidden area for colorfastness first. If the locally  
cleaned area gives any impression that a ring formation  
may result, clean the entire surface.  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other  
Plastic Surfaces  
A soft cloth dampened with water may be used to  
remove dust. If a more thorough cleaning is necessary,  
a clean soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution  
can be used to gently remove dust and dirt. Never  
use spot lifters or removers on plastic surfaces.  
Many commercial cleaners and coatings that are  
sold to preserve and protect soft plastic surfaces may  
permanently change the appearance and feel of the  
interior and are not recommended. Do not use silicone  
or wax-based products, or those containing organic  
solvents to clean the vehicle's interior because they  
can alter the appearance by increasing the gloss in  
a non-uniform manner.  
After the cleaning process has been completed, a paper  
towel can be used to blot excess moisture from the  
fabric or carpet.  
Leather  
A soft cloth dampened with water can be used to  
remove dust. If a more thorough cleaning is necessary,  
a soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution can  
be used. Allow the leather to dry naturally. Do not use  
heat to dry. Never use steam to clean leather. Never  
use spot lifters or spot removers on leather. Many  
commercial leather cleaners and coatings that are  
sold to preserve and protect leather may permanently  
change the appearance and feel of the leather and are  
not recommended. Do not use silicone or wax-based  
products, or those containing organic solvents to clean  
the vehicle's interior because they can alter the  
appearance by increasing the gloss in a non-uniform  
manner. Never use shoe polish on leather.  
Some commercial products may increase gloss on the  
instrument panel. The increase in gloss may cause  
annoying reflections in the windshield and even make  
it difficult to see through the windshield under certain  
conditions.  
6-117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Care of Safety Belts  
Washing Your Vehicle  
Keep belts clean and dry.  
The best way to preserve the vehicle's finish is to keep  
it clean by washing it often.  
Notice: Certain cleaners contain chemicals that can  
damage the emblems or nameplates on the vehicle.  
Check the cleaning product label. If it states that it  
should not be used on plastic parts, do not use it on  
the vehicle or damage may occur and it would not  
be covered by the warranty.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not bleach or dye safety belts. It may severely  
weaken them. In a crash, they might not be able  
to provide adequate protection. Clean safety belts  
only with mild soap and lukewarm water.  
Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight. Use a car  
washing soap. Do not use cleaning agents that are  
petroleum based or that contain acid or abrasives,  
as they can damage the paint, metal or plastic on the  
vehicle. Approved cleaning products can be obtained  
from your dealer/retailer. Follow all manufacturers'  
directions regarding correct product usage, necessary  
safety precautions and appropriate disposal of any  
vehicle care product.  
Weatherstrips  
Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last  
longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak. Apply  
silicone grease with a clean cloth. During very cold,  
damp weather frequent application may be required.  
See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 711  
.
6-118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rinse the vehicle well, before washing and after to  
remove all cleaning agents completely. If they are  
allowed to dry on the surface, they could stain.  
Finish Care  
Occasional waxing or mild polishing of the vehicle by  
hand may be necessary to remove residue from the  
paint finish. Approved cleaning products can be  
obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
Dry the finish with a soft, clean chamois or an all-cotton  
towel to avoid surface scratches and water spotting.  
High pressure car washes may cause water to enter the  
vehicle. Avoid using high pressure washes closer than  
12 inches (30 cm) to the surface of the vehicle. Use of  
power washers exceeding 1,200 psi (8 274 kPa) can  
result in damage or removal of paint and decals.  
If the vehicle has a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish, the  
clearcoat gives more depth and gloss to the colored  
basecoat. Always use waxes and polishes that are  
non-abrasive and made for a basecoat/clearcoat paint  
finish.  
Notice: Machine compounding or aggressive  
polishing on a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish  
may damage it. Use only non-abrasive waxes and  
polishes that are made for a basecoat/clearcoat  
paint finish on the vehicle.  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses  
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a soft cloth and a  
car washing soap to clean exterior lamps and lenses.  
Follow instructions under Washing Your Vehicle on  
page 6118  
.
Foreign materials such as calcium chloride and other  
salts, ice melting agents, road oil and tar, tree sap, bird  
droppings, chemicals from industrial chimneys, etc., can  
damage the vehicle's finish if they remain on painted  
surfaces. Wash the vehicle as soon as possible.  
6-119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If necessary, use non-abrasive cleaners that are  
marked safe for painted surfaces to remove foreign  
matter.  
Windshield and Wiper Blades  
Clean the outside of the windshield with glass cleaner.  
Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper  
towel soaked with windshield washer fluid or a mild  
detergent. Wash the windshield thoroughly when  
cleaning the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap, and a  
buildup of vehicle wash/wax treatments may cause  
wiper streaking. Replace the wiper blades if they are  
worn or damaged.  
Exterior painted surfaces are subject to aging, weather  
and chemical fallout that can take their toll over a period  
of years. To help keep the paint finish looking new, keep  
the vehicle garaged or covered whenever possible.  
Protecting Exterior Bright Metal Parts  
Bright metal parts should be cleaned regularly to keep  
their luster. Washing with water is all that is usually  
needed. However, chrome polish may be used on  
chrome or stainless steel trim, if necessary.  
Wipers can be damaged by:  
.
Extreme dusty conditions  
.
Sand and salt  
Use special care with aluminum trim. To avoid  
damaging protective trim, never use auto or chrome  
polish, steam or caustic soap to clean aluminum.  
A coating of wax, rubbed to high polish, is  
recommended for all bright metal parts.  
.
Heat and sun  
.
Snow and ice, without proper removal  
6-120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The surface of these wheels is similar to the painted  
surface of the vehicle. Do not use strong soaps,  
chemicals, abrasive polishes, abrasive cleaners,  
cleaners with acid, or abrasive cleaning brushes  
on them because they could damage the surface.  
Do not use chrome polish on aluminum wheels.  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels  
and Trim  
The vehicle may have either aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels.  
Keep the wheels clean using a soft clean cloth with mild  
soap and water. Rinse with clean water. After rinsing  
thoroughly, dry with a soft clean towel. A wax may then  
be applied.  
Notice: Using chrome polish on aluminum wheels  
could damage the wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Use chrome polish  
on chrome wheels only.  
Notice: Chrome wheels and other chrome trim  
may be damaged if the vehicle is not washed  
after driving on roads that have been sprayed  
with magnesium, calcium or sodium chloride.  
These chlorides are used on roads for conditions  
such as ice and dust. Always wash the vehicle's  
chrome with soap and water after exposure.  
Use chrome polish only on chrome-plated wheels, but  
avoid any painted surface of the wheel, and buff off  
immediately after application.  
Notice: Driving the vehicle through an automatic  
car wash that has silicone carbide tire cleaning  
brushes, could damage the aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Never drive a  
vehicle that has aluminum or chrome-plated wheels  
through an automatic car wash that uses silicone  
carbide tire cleaning brushes.  
Notice: Using strong soaps, chemicals, abrasive  
polishes, cleaners, brushes, or cleaners that contain  
acid on aluminum or chrome-plated wheels, could  
damage the surface of the wheel(s). The repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Use only approved cleaners on aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels.  
6-121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires  
Finish Damage  
To clean the tires, use a stiff brush with tire cleaner.  
Any stone chips, fractures or deep scratches in the  
finish should be repaired right away. Bare metal will  
corrode quickly and may develop into major repair  
expense.  
Notice: Using petroleum-based tire dressing  
products on the vehicle may damage the paint finish  
and/or tires. When applying a tire dressing, always  
wipe off any overspray from all painted surfaces on  
the vehicle.  
Minor chips and scratches can be repaired with  
touch-up materials available from your dealer/retailer.  
Larger areas of finish damage can be corrected in your  
dealer's/retailer's body and paint shop.  
Sheet Metal Damage  
If the vehicle is damaged and requires sheet metal  
repair or replacement, make sure the body repair shop  
applies anti-corrosion material to parts repaired or  
replaced to restore corrosion protection.  
Underbody Maintenance  
Chemicals used for ice and snow removal and dust  
control can collect on the underbody. If these are  
not removed, corrosion and rust can develop on the  
underbody parts such as fuel lines, frame, floor pan,  
and exhaust system even though they have corrosion  
protection.  
Original manufacturer replacement parts will provide  
the corrosion protection while maintaining the vehicle  
warranty.  
At least every spring, flush these materials from the  
underbody with plain water. Clean any areas where  
mud and debris can collect. Dirt packed in close areas  
of the frame should be loosened before being flushed.  
Your dealer/retailer or an underbody car washing  
system can do this.  
6-122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chemical Paint Spotting  
Vehicle Identification  
Some weather and atmospheric conditions can create a  
chemical fallout. Airborne pollutants can fall upon and  
attack painted surfaces on the vehicle. This damage  
can take two forms: blotchy, ring-shaped discolorations,  
and small, irregular dark spots etched into the paint  
surface.  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
Although no defect in the paint job causes this, we will  
repair, at no charge to the owner, the surfaces of new  
vehicles damaged by this fallout condition within  
12 months or 12,000 miles (20 000 km) of purchase,  
whichever occurs first.  
This legal identifier is in the front corner of the  
instrument panel, on the driver side. It can be seen  
through the windshield from outside. The VIN also  
appears on the Vehicle Certification and Service  
Parts labels and certificates of title and registration.  
Engine Identification  
The eighth character in the VIN is the engine code.  
This code identifies the vehicle's engine, specifications,  
and replacement parts. See Engine Specifications”  
under Capacities and Specifications on page 6131  
for the vehicle's engine code.  
6-123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting  
to add anything electrical to the vehicle, see Servicing  
Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 272 and  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on  
Service Parts Identification Label  
This label, in the trunk, on the driver side near the spare  
tire cover, has the following information:  
.
page 273  
.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
.
Model designation  
Headlamp Wiring  
.
Paint information  
The headlamp wiring is protected by fuses. Should the  
headlamps fail to function, have the headlamp system  
checked right away.  
.
Production options and special equipment  
Do not remove this label from the vehicle.  
Electrical System  
Windshield Wiper Fuses  
The windshield wiper motor is protected by a circuit  
breaker and a fuse. If the motor overheats due to heavy  
snow, etc., the wiper will stop until the motor cools.  
If the overload is caused by some electrical problem,  
have it fixed.  
Add-On Electrical Equipment  
Notice: Do not add anything electrical to the  
vehicle unless you check with your dealer/retailer  
first. Some electrical equipment can damage the  
vehicle and the damage would not be covered by  
the vehicle's warranty. Some add-on electrical  
equipment can keep other components from  
working as they should.  
Power Windows and Other Power  
Options  
Fuses in the fuse block protect the power windows.  
When the current load is too heavy, the fuse opens  
protecting the circuit until the problem is fixed.  
Add-on equipment can drain the vehicle battery, even if  
the vehicle is not operating.  
6-124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers  
Floor Console Fuse Block  
The wiring circuits in the vehicle are protected from  
short circuits by a combination of fuses, circuit breakers  
and fusible thermal links. This greatly reduces the  
chance of damage caused by electrical problems.  
Look at the silver-colored band inside the fuse. If the  
band is broken or melted, replace the fuse. Be sure you  
replace a bad fuse with a new one of the identical size  
and rating.  
If you ever have a problem on the road and do not  
have a spare fuse, you can borrowone that has  
the same amperage. Just pick some feature of the  
vehicle that you can get along without like the  
radio or cigarette lighter and use its fuse if it is the  
correct amperage. Replace it as soon as you can.  
There are two fuse blocks in the vehicle: the floor  
console fuse block and the engine compartment  
fuse block.  
There is one additional fuse located in the back of the  
vehicle near the battery.  
The floor console fuse block is located on the  
passenger side of the floor console behind the forward  
panel. The panel has three clips. Pull the panel to  
disconnect the three clips, and access the fuses.  
Use the fuse puller to remove fuses.  
6-125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
Usage  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Fuse Puller  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Amplifier  
Cluster  
Ignition Switch, PASS-Key® III+  
Stoplamp  
Heating, Ventilation, Air Conditioning,  
PASS-Key® III+  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
Empty  
Spare  
Airbag  
Spare  
Windshield Wiper  
Climate Control System, Ignition  
Window Retained Accessory Power  
Empty  
Electric Power Steering, Steering  
Wheel Control  
19  
20  
Sunroof  
6-126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block  
Fuses  
21  
Usage  
Spare  
The engine compartment fuse block is located on the  
driver side of the vehicle. Lift off the cover to check  
the fuses. See Engine Compartment Overview on  
page 614 for more information on location.  
22  
Empty  
23  
Audio System  
24  
XM Radio, OnStar™  
Notice: Spilling liquid on any electrical components  
on the vehicle may damage it. Always keep the  
covers on any electrical component.  
Engine Control Module,  
Transmission Control Module  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
Door Locks  
Interior Lights  
Steering Wheel Control Illumination  
Power Windows  
Relays  
30  
Usage  
Climate Control System  
Empty  
31  
32  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
6-127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
SPARES  
Usage  
Spares  
ABS  
Antilock Brake System  
Blank  
Blank  
Blank  
Blank  
REAR DEFOG  
COOL FAN2  
CRNK  
Rear Defogger  
Engine Cooling Fan High Speed  
Starter  
COOL FAN 1  
BCM3  
Engine Cooling Fan Low Speed  
Body Control Module 3  
Body Control Module 2  
Fog Lamps  
BCM2  
FOG LAMP  
HORN  
Horn  
RT HI BEAM  
Passenger Side High Beam Lamp  
6-128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
LT HI BEAM  
RT LO BEAM  
LT LO BEAM  
DRL  
Usage  
Driver Side High Beam Lamp  
Passenger Side Low Beam Lamp  
Driver Side Low Beam Lamp  
Daytime Running Lamps  
Fuel Pump  
Fuses  
A/C CLTCH  
CHMSL  
Usage  
Air Conditioning Clutch  
Center High Mount Stop Lamp  
Antilock Brake System 2  
Blank  
ABS2  
Blank  
FUEL PUMP  
EXH  
ECM/TRANS  
BCK UP  
Engine Control Module, Transmission  
Back-Up Lamps  
Exhaust Emissions  
Engine Valve Solenoid  
Injectors  
ENG VLV SOL  
INJ  
TRUNK/ HTD  
SEATS  
Trunk, Heated Seats  
Blank  
Blank  
AIR SOL  
Blank  
AIR Solenoid  
Blank  
Blank  
Blank  
SDM  
Sensing Diagnostic Module (Airbags)  
Antilock Brake System 3  
Auxiliary Power Outlet  
Mirrors  
Powertrain Control Module/Engine  
Control Module  
PCM/ECM  
ABS3  
EPS  
Electric Power Steering  
AIR Pump  
OUTLET  
MIR  
AIR PUMP  
PRK LAMP  
WPR  
Parking Lamps  
Windshield Wiper  
Ignition  
DLC  
Data Link Connector  
Canister Vent  
CNSTR VENT  
IP IGN  
6-129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relays  
Usage  
Relays  
WPR ON/OFF  
COOL FAN 1  
PWR/TRN  
Usage  
Windshield Wiper On/Off  
Engine Cooling Fan 1  
Powertrain  
REAR DEFOG  
Rear Defogger  
AIR SOL  
(TURBO:  
COOL FAN 2)  
AIR Solenoid (L61)/Engine Cooling  
Fan 2 (LNF)  
AIR PUMP  
A/C CLTCH  
CHMSL  
AIR Pump  
WPR HI/LO  
CRNK  
Windshield Wiper High/Low Speed  
Starter  
Air Conditioning Clutch  
Center High Mount Stop Lamp  
Run, Crank  
COOL FAN 2  
(TURBO:  
COOL FANS)  
Engine Cooling Fan (L61, LE5)/  
Engine Cooling Fans (LNF)  
RUN/CRNK  
Misc.  
Usage  
FUEL PUMP  
Fuel Pump  
PLR  
Fuse Puller  
6-130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Capacities and Specifications  
The following approximate capacities are given in metric and English conversions. Please refer to Recommended  
Fluids and Lubricants on page 711 for more information.  
Capacities  
Application  
Metric  
English  
For the air conditioning system refrigerant charge  
amount, see the refrigerant caution label located  
under the hood. See your dealer/retailer for more  
information.  
Air Conditioning Refrigerant R134a  
Cooling System  
2.0L L4 Engine  
8.7 L  
7.0 L  
9.2 qt  
7.4 qt  
2.2L L4 Engine  
Engine Oil with Filter  
2.0L L4 Engine  
4.7 L  
4.7 L  
5.0 qt  
5.0 qt  
2.2L L4 Engine  
Fuel Tank  
2.0L L4 Engine  
50.0 L  
51.1 L  
49.2 L  
13.2 gal  
13.5 gal  
13.0 gal  
2.2L L4 Engine (with NU6 emissions)  
2.2L L4 Engine (without NU6 emissions)  
6-131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Capacities  
Application  
Metric  
English  
Transmission Fluid  
Automatic Transmission (Bottom Pan Removal)  
6.6 L  
1.9 L  
7.0 qt  
2.0 qt  
Manual Transmission, 2.0L L4 Engine  
(Complete Drain and Refill)  
Manual Transmission, 2.2L L4 Engine  
(Complete Drain and Refill)  
1.6 L  
1.7 qt  
Wheel Nut Torque  
140 Y  
100 lb ft  
All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level, as recommended in this manual.  
Engine Specifications  
Engine  
2.0L L4 Engine  
VIN Code  
Transmission  
Spark Plug Gap  
X
Manual  
0.89 mm (0.035 in)  
Automatic  
Manual  
2.2L L4 Engine  
5
1.01 mm (0.040 in)  
6-132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7 Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Engine Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Maintenance Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8  
7-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The maintenance schedule is for vehicles that:  
Maintenance Schedule  
.
carry passengers and cargo within recommended  
limits on the Tire and Loading Information label.  
See Loading the Vehicle on page 525.  
Introduction  
Notice: Maintenance intervals, checks, inspections,  
recommended fluids, and lubricants are necessary  
to keep this vehicle in good working condition.  
Damage caused by failure to follow scheduled  
maintenance might not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
.
are driven on reasonable road surfaces within legal  
driving limits.  
.
use the recommended fuel. See Gasoline Octane  
on page 67  
.
Proper vehicle maintenance helps to keep the vehicle in  
good working condition, improves fuel economy, and  
reduces vehicle emissions for better air quality.  
WARNING:  
{
Performing maintenance work on a vehicle can be  
dangerous. In trying to do some jobs, you can be  
seriously injured. Do your own maintenance work  
only if you have the required know-how and the  
proper tools and equipment for the job. If you  
have any doubt, see your dealer/retailer to have a  
qualified technician do the work. See Doing Your  
Own Service Work on page 65.  
Because of all the different ways people use vehicles,  
maintenance needs vary. The vehicle might need more  
frequent checks and services. Please read the  
information under Scheduled Maintenance. To keep the  
vehicle in good condition, see your dealer/retailer.  
At your General Motors dealer/retailer, you can be  
certain that you will receive the highest level of service  
available. Your dealer/retailer has specially trained  
service technicians, uses genuine GM replacement  
parts, as well as, up to date tools and equipment to  
ensure fast and accurate diagnostics.  
7-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The proper replacement parts, fluids, and lubricants to  
use are listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  
on page 711 and Maintenance Replacement Parts on  
page 713. We recommend the use of genuine parts  
from your dealer/retailer.  
engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a  
year and the oil life system must be reset. Your dealer/  
retailer has trained service technicians who will perform  
this work and reset the system. If the engine oil life  
system is reset accidentally, service the vehicle within  
5 000 km/3,000 miles since the last service. Reset the  
oil life system whenever the oil is changed. See Engine  
Oil Life System on page 621.  
Rotation of New Tires  
To maintain ride, handling, and performance of the  
vehicle, it is important that the first rotation service for  
new tires be performed when they have 8 000 to  
13 000 km (5,000 to 8,000 miles). See Tire Inspection  
and Rotation on page 673.  
When the Change Oil Soon message displays,  
certain services, checks, and inspections are required.  
The services described for Maintenance I should be  
performed at every engine oil change. The services  
described for Maintenance II should be  
Scheduled Maintenance  
performed when:  
.
Maintenance I was performed the last time  
When the Change Oil Soon Message  
Displays  
the engine oil was changed.  
.
It has been 10 months or more since the  
Change engine oil and filter. See Engine Oil on  
page 617. An Emission Control Service.  
Change Oil Soon message has displayed or  
since the last service.  
When the Change Oil Soon message displays, service  
is required for the vehicle as soon as possible, within  
the next 1 000 km/600 miles. If driving under the best  
conditions, the engine oil life system might not indicate  
the need for vehicle service for more than a year. The  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance I  
Maintenance II  
.
.
Change engine oil and filter. See Engine Oil on  
Perform all services described in Maintenance I.  
page 617. An Emission Control Service.  
.
Steering and suspension inspection. Visual  
.
Engine coolant level check. See Engine Coolant  
inspection for damaged, loose, or missing parts or  
on page 629  
.
signs of wear.  
.
.
.
.
.
.
Windshield washer fluid level check. See  
Windshield Washer Fluid on page 636.  
Engine cooling system inspection. Visual  
inspection of hoses, pipes, fittings, and clamps and  
replacement, if needed.  
Tire inflation check. See Inflation - Tire Pressure  
.
on page 666  
.
Windshield wiper blade inspection for wear,  
cracking, or contamination and windshield and  
wiper blade cleaning, if contaminated. See  
Windshield and Wiper Blades on page 6120  
Tire wear inspection. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 673.  
.
Rotate tires. See Tire Inspection and Rotation on  
Worn or damaged wiper blade replacement.  
page 673  
.
See Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement on  
page 656  
.
Fluids visual leak check (or every 12 months,  
whichever occurs first). A leak in any system must  
be repaired and the fluid level checked.  
.
Body hinges and latches, key lock cylinders, and  
trunk lid hinges and latches lubrication. See  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 711. More frequent lubrication may be  
required when vehicle is exposed to a corrosive  
environment. Applying silicone grease on  
weatherstrips with a clean cloth makes them last  
longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak.  
.
.
Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles driven  
in dusty conditions only). See Engine Air Cleaner/  
Filter (2.0L Turbo Engine) on page 623 or Engine  
Air Cleaner/Filter (2.2L Engine) on page 625.  
Brake system inspection (or every 12 months,  
whichever occurs first).  
7-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
Restraint system component check. See Checking  
the Restraint Systems on page 274.  
Once a Year  
.
Starter switch check. See Owner Checks and  
Engine air cleaner filter inspection. See Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter (2.0L Turbo Engine) on page 623  
or Engine Air Cleaner/Filter (2.2L Engine) on  
Services on page 78.  
.
.
Parking brake and automatic transmission P (Park)  
mechanism check. See Owner Checks and  
Services on page 78.  
page 625  
.
.
Passenger compartment air filter replacement  
(or every 12 months, whichever occurs first).  
More frequent replacement may be required if  
vehicle is driven regularly under dusty conditions.  
Automatic transmission shiftlock control system  
check. See Owner Checks and Services on  
page 78  
.
.
.
Ignition transmission lock check. See Owner  
Checks and Services on page 78.  
Additional Required Services  
At Each Fuel Stop  
Engine cooling system and pressure cap pressure  
check. Radiator and air conditioning condenser  
outside cleaning. See Cooling System on  
.
Engine oil level check. See Engine Oil on  
page 617  
Engine coolant level check. See Engine Coolant  
on page 629  
.
page 628  
.
.
.
.
.
Exhaust system and nearby heat shields  
inspection for loose or damaged components.  
.
Windshield washer fluid level check. See  
Throttle system inspection for interference, binding  
or for damaged or missing parts. Replace parts as  
needed. Replace any components that have high  
effort or excessive wear. Do not lubricate  
Windshield Washer Fluid on page 636.  
Once a Month  
.
Tire inflation check. See Inflation - Tire Pressure  
on page 666  
accelerator or cruise control cables.  
.
.
If the vehicle has a Tire Sealant and Compressor  
Kit, check the sealant expiration date printed on  
the instruction label of the kit. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit on page 684.  
.
Tire wear inspection. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 673.  
7-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
40 000 km/25,000 Miles  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
160 000 km/100,000 Miles  
.
.
Fuel system inspection for damage or leaks.  
Spark plug replacement. An Emission Control  
Service.  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
80 000 km/50,000 Miles  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
240 000 km/150,000 Miles  
.
Engine air cleaner filter replacement.  
.
See Engine Air Cleaner/Filter (2.0L Turbo Engine)  
on page 623 or Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
(2.2L Engine) on page 625.  
Engine cooling system drain, flush, and refill,  
cooling system and cap pressure check, and  
cleaning of outside of radiator and air conditioning  
condenser (or every 5 years, whichever occurs  
first). See Engine Coolant on page 629. An  
Emission Control Service.  
.
Automatic transmission fluid change (severe  
service only) for vehicles mainly driven in heavy  
city traffic in hot weather, in hilly or mountainous  
terrain, when frequently towing a trailer, or used for  
taxi, police, or delivery service. See Automatic  
Transmission Fluid on page 627.  
.
Engine accessory drive belt inspection for fraying,  
excessive cracks, or obvious damage and  
replacement, if needed. An Emission Control  
Service.  
7-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Service  
Maintenance I Maintenance II  
Change engine oil and filter. Reset oil life system.  
Engine coolant level check.  
Windshield washer fluid level check.  
Tire inflation pressures check.  
Tire wear inspection.  
Rotate tires.  
Fluids visual leak check.  
Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles driven in dusty conditions only).  
Brake system inspection.  
Steering and suspension inspection.  
Engine cooling system inspection.  
Windshield wiper blades inspection.  
Body components lubrication.  
Restraint system components check.  
Passenger compartment air filter replacement.  
Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles not driven in dusty conditions).  
7-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. For automatic transmission vehicles, try to start the  
engine in each gear. The starter should work only  
in P (Park) or N (Neutral). If the starter works in any  
other position, your vehicle needs service.  
Owner Checks and Services  
Starter Switch Check  
For manual transmission vehicles, put the shift  
lever in Neutral, push the clutch pedal down  
halfway, and try to start the engine. The starter  
should work only when the clutch pedal is pushed  
down all the way to the floor. If the starter works  
when the clutch pedal is not pushed all the way  
down, your vehicle needs service.  
WARNING:  
{
When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle  
could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or  
others could be injured.  
1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough  
room around the vehicle.  
2. Firmly apply both the parking brake and the regular  
brake. See Parking Brake on page 331.  
Do not use the accelerator pedal, and be ready to  
turn off the engine immediately if it starts.  
7-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock  
Control System Check  
Ignition Transmission Lock Check  
While parked, and with the parking brake set, try to turn  
the ignition to LOCK/OFF in each shift lever position.  
.
For automatic transmission vehicles, the ignition  
WARNING:  
{
should turn to LOCK/OFF only when the shift lever  
is in P (Park). The ignition key should come out  
only in LOCK/OFF.  
When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle  
could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or  
others could be injured.  
.
For manual transmission vehicles, the ignition key  
should come out only in LOCK/OFF.  
Turn the steering wheel to the left and to the right.  
It should only lock when turned to the right.  
1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough  
room around the vehicle. It should be parked on a  
level surface.  
Contact your dealer/retailer if service is required.  
2. Firmly apply the parking brake. See Parking Brake  
on page 331  
.
Be ready to apply the regular brake immediately if  
the vehicle begins to move.  
3. With the engine off, turn the ignition to ON/RUN,  
but do not start the engine. Without applying the  
regular brake, try to move the shift lever out of  
P (Park) with normal effort. If the shift lever  
moves out of P (Park), contact your dealer/retailer  
for service.  
7-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Park on a fairly steep hill, with the vehicle facing  
downhill. Keeping your foot on the regular brake, set  
the parking brake.  
Parking Brake and Automatic  
Transmission P (Park) Mechanism  
Check  
.
To check the parking brake's holding ability:  
With the engine running and the transmission in  
N (Neutral), slowly remove foot pressure from the  
regular brake pedal. Do this until the vehicle is held  
by the parking brake only.  
WARNING:  
{
When you are doing this check, the vehicle could  
begin to move. You or others could be injured and  
property could be damaged. Make sure there is  
room in front of the vehicle in case it begins to  
roll. Be ready to apply the regular brake at once  
should the vehicle begin to move.  
.
To check the P (Park) mechanism's holding ability:  
With the engine running, shift to P (Park). Then  
release the parking brake followed by the regular  
brake.  
Contact your dealer/retailer if service is required.  
7-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants  
Fluids and lubricants identified below by name, part  
number, or specification can be obtained from your  
dealer/retailer.  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable  
Engine Cooling water and use only DEX-COOL®  
System  
Coolant. See Engine Coolant on  
page 629  
.
DOT 3 Hydraulic Brake Fluid  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377967,  
in Canada 89021320).  
Hydraulic Brake  
System  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Engine oil which meets GM Standard  
GM6094M and displays the American  
Petroleum Institute (API) Certified for  
Gasoline Engines starburst symbol.  
To determine the proper viscosity for  
your vehicle's engine, see Engine Oil  
DOT 3 Hydraulic Brake Fluid  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377967,  
in Canada 89021320).  
Hydraulic Clutch  
System  
Engine Oil  
(2.2L L4 engine)  
Windshield  
Washer  
Optikleen® Washer Solvent.  
on page 617  
.
Chassis Lubricant  
The engine requires a special engine  
oil meeting GM Standard GM4718M.  
Oils meeting this standard can be  
identified with the American  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377985,  
in Canada 88901242) or lubricant  
meeting requirements of NLGI #2,  
Category LB or GCLB.  
Parking Brake  
Cable Guides  
Petroleum Institute (API) Certified for  
Gasoline Engines starburst symbol.  
Manual  
Transmission  
(2.2L L4 engine)  
DEXRON®-VI Automatic  
Transmission Fluid.  
Engine Oil  
(2.0L L4 engine) However, not all synthetic API oils  
with the starburst symbol will meet  
this GM standard. Look for and use  
only an oil that meets GM Standard  
GM4718M. For the proper viscosity,  
see Engine Oil on page 617.  
Manual  
Manual Transmission Fluid  
Transmission (GM Part No. U.S. 88862472,  
(2.0L L4 engine) in Canada 88862473).  
7-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
DEXRON®-VI Automatic  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Automatic  
Transmission Transmission Fluid.  
Hood Latch  
Assembly,  
Secondary  
Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346293,  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346241,  
in Canada 10953474).  
Key Lock  
Cylinders  
Latch, Pivots, in Canada 992723) or lubricant  
Spring Anchor, meeting requirements of NLGI #2,  
and  
Release Pawl  
Category LB or GC-LB.  
Chassis Lubricant  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377985,  
Manual  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346241,  
in Canada 10953474).  
Transmission in Canada 88901242) or lubricant  
Shift Linkage  
Hood and  
Door Hinges  
meeting requirements of NLGI #2,  
Category LB or GC-LB.  
Weatherstrip Lubricant  
Chassis Lubricant  
(GM Part No. U.S. 3634770,  
in Canada 10953518) or  
Dielectric Silicone Grease  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12345579,  
in Canada 992887).  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377985,  
in Canada 88901242) or lubricant  
meeting requirements of NLGI #2,  
Category LB or GC-LB.  
Chassis  
Lubrication  
Weatherstrip  
Conditioning  
7-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Replacement Parts  
Replacement parts identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
Maintenance Replacement Parts  
Part  
GM Part Number  
ACDelco Part Number  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
2.0L L4 Engine  
15909459  
22731072  
12605566  
52493319  
A3099C  
A3054C  
PF457G  
CF125  
2.2L L4 Engine  
Engine Oil Filter  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter  
Spark Plugs  
2.0L L4 Engine  
12620540  
12625058  
41-108  
41-103  
2.2L L4 Engine  
Wiper Blades  
Driver Side 22 in (56 cm)  
Passenger Side 17 in (43 cm)  
15243233  
15243232  
7-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Drive Belt Routing  
Dotted line shows routing for vehicles without air  
conditioning.  
7-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record  
After the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and the  
type of services performed in the boxes provided. Retain all maintenance receipts.  
Maintenance Record  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
Serviced By  
Services Performed  
7-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Services Performed  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
7-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Services Performed  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
7-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Services Performed  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
7-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 8 Customer Assistance Information  
Customer Assistance and Information . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Reporting Safety Defects to the United States  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Customer Assistance for Text Telephone (TTY)  
Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Reporting Safety Defects to the Canadian  
Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Customer Assistance Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Scheduling Service Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11  
Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors . . . 8-16  
Service Publications Ordering Information . . . . . 8-16  
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19  
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19  
Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Radio Frequency Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
8-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STEP TWO: If after contacting a member of dealership  
management, it appears your concern cannot be  
resolved by the dealership without further help, in the  
U.S., call the Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center  
at 1-800-222-1020. In Canada, call General Motors  
of Canada Customer Communication Centre at  
Customer Assistance and  
Information  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure  
1-800-263-3777 (English), or 1-800-263-7854 (French).  
Your satisfaction and goodwill are important to your  
dealer and to Chevrolet. Normally, any concerns with  
the sales transaction or the operation of the vehicle  
will be resolved by the dealer's sales or service  
departments. Sometimes, however, despite the best  
intentions of all concerned, misunderstandings can  
occur. If your concern has not been resolved to your  
satisfaction, the following steps should be taken:  
We encourage you to call the toll-free number in order  
to give your inquiry prompt attention. Have the following  
information available to give the Customer Assistance  
Representative:  
.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). This is  
available from the vehicle registration or title, or  
the plate at the top left of the instrument panel and  
visible through the windshield.  
STEP ONE: Discuss your concern with a member  
of dealership management. Normally, concerns can  
be quickly resolved at that level. If the matter has  
already been reviewed with the sales, service, or parts  
manager, contact the owner of the dealership or the  
general manager.  
.
Dealership name and location.  
.
Vehicle delivery date and present mileage.  
When contacting Chevrolet, remember that your  
concern will likely be resolved at a dealer's facility.  
That is why we suggest following Step One first.  
8-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STEP THREE U.S. Owners: Both General Motors  
and your dealer are committed to making sure you are  
completely satisfied with your new vehicle. However,  
if you continue to remain unsatisfied after following the  
procedure outlined in Steps One and Two, you can file  
with the Better Business Bureau (BBB) Auto Line  
Program to enforce your rights.  
You may contact the BBB Auto Line Program using the  
toll-free telephone number or write them at the following  
address:  
BBB Auto Line Program  
Council of Better Business Bureaus, Inc.  
4200 Wilson Boulevard  
Suite 800  
The BBB Auto Line Program is an out of court program  
administered by the Council of Better Business Bureaus  
to settle automotive disputes regarding vehicle repairs  
or the interpretation of the New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty. Although you may be required to resort to this  
informal dispute resolution program prior to filing a court  
action, use of the program is free of charge and your  
case will generally be heard within 40 days. If you do  
not agree with the decision given in your case, you may  
reject it and proceed with any other venue for relief  
available to you.  
Arlington, VA 22203-1838  
Telephone: 1-800-955-5100  
dr.bbb.org/goauto  
This program is available in all 50 states and the  
District of Columbia. Eligibility is limited by vehicle age,  
mileage, and other factors. General Motors reserves the  
right to change eligibility limitations and/or discontinue  
its participation in this program.  
8-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STEP THREE Canadian Owners: In the event that  
you do not feel your concerns have been addressed  
after following the procedure outlined in Steps 1 and 2,  
General Motors of Canada Limited wants you to be  
aware of its participation in a no-charge Mediation/  
Arbitration Program. General Motors of Canada  
Limited has committed to binding arbitration of owner  
disputes involving factory-related vehicle service  
claims. The program provides for the review of the  
facts involved by an impartial third party arbiter, and  
may include an informal hearing before the arbiter.  
The program is designed so that the entire dispute  
settlement process, from the time you file your  
complaint to the final decision, should be completed  
in about 70 days. We believe our impartial program  
offers advantages over courts in most jurisdictions  
because it is informal, quick, and free of charge.  
For further information concerning eligibility in the  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP), call  
toll-free 1-800-207-0685, or call the General Motors  
Customer Communication Centre, 1-800-263-3777  
(English), 1-800-263-7854 (French), or write to:  
The Mediation/Arbitration Program  
c/o Customer Communication Centre  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Mail Code: CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
Your inquiry should be accompanied by the Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN).  
8-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
My GM Canada (Canada) www.gm.ca  
Online Owner Center  
My GM Canada is a password-protected section of  
www.gm.ca where you can save information on GM  
vehicles, get personalized offers, and use handy tools  
and forms with greater ease.  
Online Owner Center (U.S.) —  
www.gmownercenter.com/chevrolet  
Information and services customized for your specific  
vehicle all in one convenient place.  
Here are a few of the valuable tools and services you  
will have access to:  
.
Digital owner manual, warranty information,  
.
and more  
My Showroom: Find and save information on  
vehicles and current offers in your area.  
.
Online service and maintenance records  
.
My Dealers/Retailers: Save details such as  
address and phone number for each of your  
preferred GM dealers/retailers.  
.
Find Chevrolet dealers for service nationwide  
.
Exclusive privileges and offers  
.
Recall notices for your specific vehicle  
OnStar® and GM Cardmember Services Earnings  
summaries  
.
My Driveway: Access quick links to parts and  
.
service estimates, check trade-in values,  
or schedule a service appointment by adding  
the vehicles you own to your driveway profile.  
Other Helpful Links:  
.
My Preferences: Manage your profile and use tools  
and forms with greater ease.  
Chevrolet www.chevrolet.com  
Chevrolet Merchandise www.chevymall.com  
Help Center www.chevrolet.com/helpcenter  
To sign up, visit the My GM Canada section within  
www.gm.ca.  
.
FAQ  
.
Contact Us  
8-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
From Puerto Rico:  
Customer Assistance for Text  
Telephone (TTY) Users  
1-800-496-9992 (English)  
1-800-496-9993 (Spanish)  
To assist customers who are deaf, hard of hearing,  
or speech-impaired and who use Text Telephones  
(TTYs), Chevrolet has TTY equipment available at  
its Customer Assistance Center. Any TTY user in the  
U.S. can communicate with Chevrolet by dialing:  
1-800-833-CHEV (2438). (TTY users in Canada can  
dial 1-800-263-3830.)  
From U.S. Virgin Islands:  
1-800-496-9994  
Canada Customer Assistance  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Customer Communication Centre, CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
gmcanada.com  
Customer Assistance Offices  
Chevrolet encourages customers to call the toll-free  
number for assistance. However, if a customer wishes  
to write or e-mail Chevrolet, the letter should be  
addressed to:  
1-800-263-3777 (English)  
1-800-263-7854 (French)  
1-800-263-3830 (For Text Telephone  
devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-268-6800  
United States Customer Assistance  
Chevrolet Motor Division  
Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center  
P.O. Box 33170  
Overseas Customer Assistance  
Please contact the local General Motors Business Unit.  
Detroit, MI 48232-5170  
Chevrolet.com  
1-800-222-1020  
1-800-833-2438 (For Text Telephone  
devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-CHEV-USA (243-8872)  
8-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The offer is available for a very limited period of time  
from the date of vehicle purchase/lease. For more  
details, or to determine your vehicle's eligibility, visit  
gmmobility.com or call the GM Mobility Assistance  
Center at 1-800-323-9935. Text telephone (TTY) users,  
call 1-800-833-9935.  
Mexico, Central America and Caribbean  
Islands/Countries (Except Puerto Rico  
and U.S. Virgin Islands) Customer  
Assistance  
General Motors de Mexico, S. de R.L. de C.V.  
Customer Assistance Center  
Paseo de la Reforma # 2740  
Col. Lomas de Bezares  
General Motors of Canada also has a Mobility Program.  
Call 1-800-GM-DRIVE (463-7483) for details. TTY users  
call 1-800-263-3830.  
C.P. 11910, Mexico, D.F.  
Roadside Assistance Program  
01-800-508-0000  
Long Distance: 011-52-53 29 0 800  
For U.S. purchased vehicles, call 1800CHEVUSA  
(18002438872); (Text telephone (TTY):  
18888892438).  
GM Mobility Reimbursement  
Program  
For Canadian purchased vehicles, call 1-800-268-6800.  
Service is available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year.  
This program, available to qualified applicants,  
can reimburse you up to $1,000 of the cost of  
eligible aftermarket adaptive equipment required  
for your vehicle, such as hand controls or a  
wheelchair/scooter lift.  
8-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chevrolet and General Motors of Canada Limited  
reserve the right to limit services or payment to an  
owner or driver if they decide the claims are made too  
often, or the same type of claim is made many times.  
Calling for Assistance  
When calling Roadside Assistance, have the following  
information ready:  
.
Your name, home address, and home telephone  
Services Provided  
number  
.
.
Emergency Fuel Delivery: Delivery of enough  
Telephone number of your location  
fuel for the vehicle to get to the nearest service  
station.  
.
Location of the vehicle  
.
Model, year, color, and license plate number of the  
.
LockOut Service: Service is provided to unlock  
vehicle  
the vehicle if you are locked out. A remote unlock  
may be available if you have OnStar®. For security  
reasons, the driver must present identification  
before this service is given.  
.
Odometer reading, Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN), and delivery date of the vehicle  
.
Description of the problem  
.
Emergency Tow From a Public Road or  
Coverage  
Services are provided up to 5 years/100,000 miles  
(160 000 km), whichever comes first.  
Highway: Tow to the nearest Chevrolet dealer for  
warranty service, or if the vehicle was in a crash  
and cannot be driven. Assistance is also given  
when the vehicle is stuck in the sand, mud,  
or snow.  
In the U.S., anyone driving the vehicle is covered.  
In Canada, a person driving the vehicle without  
permission from the owner is not covered.  
.
Flat Tire Change: Service is provided to change  
a flat tire with the spare tire. The spare tire,  
if equipped, must be in good condition and  
properly inflated. It is the owner's responsibility  
for the repair or replacement of the tire if it is not  
covered by the warranty.  
Roadside Assistance is not a part of the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty. Chevrolet and General Motors of  
Canada Limited reserve the right to make any changes  
or discontinue the Roadside Assistance program at any  
time without notification.  
.
Battery Jump Start: Service is provided to jump  
start a dead battery.  
8-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Trip Interruption Benefits and Assistance: Must  
be over 250 km from where your trip was started to  
qualify. General Motors of Canada Limited requires  
pre-authorization, original detailed receipts, and a  
copy of the repair orders. Once authorization has  
been received, the Roadside Assistance advisor  
will help you make arrangements and explain how  
to receive payment.  
Services Not Included in Roadside  
Assistance  
.
.
.
Impound towing caused by violation of any laws.  
Legal fines.  
Mounting, dismounting or changing of snow tires,  
chains, or other traction devices.  
.
.
Towing or services for vehicles driven on a  
non-public road or highway.  
Alternative Service: If assistance cannot be  
provided right away, the Roadside Assistance  
advisor may give you permission to get local  
emergency road service. You will receive payment,  
up to $100, after sending the original receipt to  
Roadside Assistance. Mechanical failures may be  
covered, however any cost for parts and labor for  
repairs not covered by the warranty are the owner  
responsibility.  
Services Specific to Canadian  
Purchased Vehicles  
.
Fuel delivery: Reimbursement is approximately  
$5 Canadian. Diesel fuel delivery may be  
restricted. Propane and other fuels are not  
provided through this service.  
.
Lock-Out Service: Vehicle registration is  
required.  
.
Trip Routing Service: Detailed maps of North  
America are provided when requested either  
with the most direct route or the most scenic  
route. There is a limit of six requests per year.  
Additional travel information is also available.  
Allow three weeks for delivery.  
8-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Several courtesy transportation options are available to  
assist in reducing your inconvenience when warranty  
repairs are required.  
Scheduling Service Appointments  
When your vehicle requires warranty service, contact  
your dealer/retailer and request an appointment.  
By scheduling a service appointment and advising your  
service consultant of your transportation needs, your  
dealer/retailer can help minimize your inconvenience.  
Courtesy Transportation is not a part of the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty. A separate booklet entitled Warranty  
and Owner Assistance Informationfurnished with each  
new vehicle provides detailed warranty coverage  
information.  
If your vehicle cannot be scheduled into the service  
department immediately, keep driving it until it can  
be scheduled for service, unless, of course, the  
problem is safety-related. If it is, please call your  
dealership/retailer, let them know this, and ask for  
instructions.  
Transportation Options  
Warranty service can generally be completed while  
you wait. However, if you are unable to wait, GM  
helps to minimize your inconvenience by providing  
several transportation options. Depending on the  
circumstances, your dealer can offer you one of the  
following:  
If the dealer/retailer requests you to bring the vehicle for  
service, you are urged to do so as early in the work day  
as possible to allow for the same day repair.  
Shuttle Service  
Courtesy Transportation Program  
Shuttle service is the preferred means of offering  
Courtesy Transportation. Dealers may provide you  
with shuttle service to get you to your destination  
with minimal interruption of your daily schedule.  
This includes oneway or round trip shuttle service  
within reasonable time and distance parameters of  
the dealer's area.  
To enhance your ownership experience, we and our  
participating dealers are proud to offer Courtesy  
Transportation, a customer support program for vehicles  
with the New Vehicle Limited Warranty (Base Warranty  
Coverage period in Canada) and extended powertrain,  
and hybrid specific warranty in both the U.S. and  
Canada.  
8-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
usage charges and may also be responsible for taxes,  
levies, usage fees, excessive mileage, or rental usage  
beyond the completion of the repair.  
Public Transportation or Fuel  
Reimbursement  
If your vehicle requires overnight warranty repairs, and  
public transportation is used instead of the dealer's  
shuttle service, the expense must be supported by  
original receipts and can only be up to the maximum  
amount allowed by GM for shuttle service. In addition,  
for U.S. customers, should you arrange transportation  
through a friend or relative, limited reimbursement for  
reasonable fuel expenses may be available. Claim  
amounts should reflect actual costs and be supported  
by original receipts. See your dealer for information  
regarding the allowance amounts for reimbursement of  
fuel or other transportation costs.  
It may not be possible to provide a like-vehicle as a  
courtesy rental.  
Additional Program Information  
All program options, such as shuttle service, may not  
be available at every dealer. Please contact your dealer  
for specific information about availability. All Courtesy  
Transportation arrangements will be administered by  
appropriate dealer personnel.  
General Motors reserves the right to unilaterally modify,  
change or discontinue Courtesy Transportation at any  
time and to resolve all questions of claim eligibility  
pursuant to the terms and conditions described herein  
at its sole discretion.  
Courtesy Rental Vehicle  
Your dealer may arrange to provide you with a  
courtesy rental vehicle or reimburse you for a  
rental vehicle that you obtain if your vehicle is kept  
for an overnight warranty repair. Rental reimbursement  
will be limited and must be supported by original  
receipts. This requires that you sign and complete a  
rental agreement and meet state/provincial, local, and  
rental vehicle provider requirements. Requirements vary  
and may include minimum age requirements, insurance  
coverage, credit card, etc. You are responsible for fuel  
Collision Damage Repair  
If your vehicle is involved in a collision and it is  
damaged, have the damage repaired by a qualified  
technician using the proper equipment and quality  
replacement parts. Poorly performed collision repairs  
diminish your vehicle's resale value, and safety  
performance can be compromised in subsequent  
collisions.  
8-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any vehicle  
failure related to such parts are not covered by that  
warranty.  
Collision Parts  
Genuine GM Collision parts are new parts made with  
the same materials and construction methods as the  
parts with which your vehicle was originally built.  
Genuine GM Collision parts are your best choice to  
ensure that your vehicle's designed appearance,  
durability, and safety are preserved. The use of  
Genuine GM parts can help maintain your GM New  
Vehicle Warranty.  
Repair Facility  
We recommend that you choose a collision repair  
facility that meets your needs before you ever need  
collision repairs. Your dealer/retailer may have a  
collision repair center with GM-trained technicians and  
state of the art equipment, or be able to recommend a  
collision repair center that has GM-trained technicians  
and comparable equipment.  
Recycled original equipment parts may also be used for  
repair. These parts are typically removed from vehicles  
that were total losses in prior crashes. In most cases,  
the parts being recycled are from undamaged sections  
of the vehicle. A recycled original equipment GM part,  
may be an acceptable choice to maintain your vehicle's  
originally designed appearance and safety performance,  
however, the history of these parts is not known. Such  
parts are not covered by your GM New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty, and any related failures are not covered by  
that warranty.  
Insuring Your Vehicle  
Protect your investment in your GM vehicle with  
comprehensive and collision insurance coverage.  
There are significant differences in the quality of  
coverage afforded by various insurance policy terms.  
Many insurance policies provide reduced protection to  
your GM vehicle by limiting compensation for damage  
repairs by using aftermarket collision parts. Some  
insurance companies will not specify aftermarket  
collision parts. When purchasing insurance, we  
recommend that you assure your vehicle will be  
repaired with GM original equipment collision parts.  
If such insurance coverage is not available from your  
current insurance carrier, consider switching to another  
insurance carrier.  
Aftermarket collision parts are also available. These are  
made by companies other than GM and may not have  
been tested for your vehicle. As a result, these parts  
may fit poorly, exhibit premature durability/corrosion  
problems, and may not perform properly in subsequent  
collisions. Aftermarket parts are not covered by your  
8-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
If your vehicle cannot be driven, know where the  
towing service will be taking it. Get a card from the  
tow truck operator or write down the driver's name,  
the service's name, and the phone number.  
If your vehicle is leased, the leasing company may  
require you to have insurance that assures repairs with  
Genuine GM Original Equipment Manufacturer (OEM)  
parts or Genuine Manufacturer replacement parts. Read  
your lease carefully, as you may be charged at the end  
of your lease for poor quality repairs.  
Remove any valuables from your vehicle before  
it is towed away. Make sure this includes your  
insurance information and registration if you keep  
these items in your vehicle.  
If a Crash Occurs  
Here is what to do if you are involved in a crash.  
Gather the important information you will need from  
the other driver. Things like name, address, phone  
number, driver's license number, vehicle license  
plate, vehicle make, model and model year,  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), insurance  
company and policy number, and a general  
description of the damage to the other vehicle.  
.
Check to make sure that you are all right. If you  
are uninjured, make sure that no one else in your  
vehicle, or the other vehicle, is injured.  
.
If there has been an injury, call emergency  
services for help. Do not leave the scene of a  
crash until all matters have been taken care of.  
Move your vehicle only if its position puts you in  
danger or you are instructed to move it by a police  
officer.  
.
If possible, call your insurance company from the  
scene of the crash. They will walk you through the  
information they will need. If they ask for a police  
report, phone or go to the police department  
headquarters the next day and you can get a  
copy of the report for a nominal fee. In some  
states/provinces with no faultinsurance laws, a  
report may not be necessary. This is especially  
true if there are no injuries and both vehicles are  
driveable.  
.
Give only the necessary and requested information  
to police and other parties involved in the crash.  
Do not discuss your personal condition, mental  
frame of mind, or anything unrelated to the crash.  
This will help guard against post-crash legal action.  
.
If you need roadside assistance, call GM Roadside  
Assistance. See Roadside Assistance Program on  
page 87 for more information.  
8-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Choose a reputable collision repair facility for your  
vehicle. Whether you select a dealer/retailer or a  
private collision repair facility to fix the damage,  
make sure you are comfortable with them.  
Remember, you will have to feel comfortable with  
their work for a long time.  
Insurance pays the bill for the repair, but you must  
live with the repair. Depending on your policy limits,  
your insurance company may initially value the repair  
using aftermarket parts. Discuss this with your repair  
professional, and insist on Genuine GM parts.  
Remember if your vehicle is leased you may be  
obligated to have the vehicle repaired with Genuine  
GM parts, even if your insurance coverage does not  
pay the full cost.  
.
Once you have an estimate, read it carefully and  
make sure you understand what work will be  
performed on your vehicle. If you have a question,  
ask for an explanation. Reputable shops welcome  
this opportunity.  
If another party's insurance company is paying for  
the repairs, you are not obligated to accept a repair  
valuation based on that insurance company's collision  
policy repair limits, as you have no contractual limits  
with that company. In such cases, you can have control  
of the repair and parts choices as long as cost stays  
within reasonable limits.  
Managing the Vehicle Damage Repair  
Process  
In the event that your vehicle requires damage repairs,  
GM recommends that you take an active role in its  
repair. If you have a pre-determined repair facility of  
choice, take your vehicle there, or have it towed there.  
Specify to the facility that any required replacement  
collision parts be original equipment parts, either new  
Genuine GM parts or recycled original GM parts.  
Remember, recycled parts will not be covered by your  
GM vehicle warranty.  
8-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle  
Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236  
(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
United States Government  
http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:  
Administrator, NHTSA  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which  
could cause a crash or could cause injury or  
death, you should immediately inform the National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in  
addition to notifying General Motors.  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, S.E.  
Washington, D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other information about motor  
vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open  
an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect  
exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall  
and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot  
become involved in individual problems between  
you, your dealer, or General Motors.  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
Canadian Government  
If you live in Canada, and you believe that your  
vehicle has a safety defect, notify Transport Canada  
immediately, in addition to notifying General Motors of  
Canada Limited. Call them at 1-800-333-0510 or  
write to:  
Transport Canada  
Road Safety Branch  
2780 Sheffield Road  
Ottawa, Ontario K1B 3V9  
8-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reporting Safety Defects to General  
Motors  
Service Publications Ordering  
Information  
In addition to notifying NHTSA (or Transport Canada) in  
a situation like this, please notify General Motors.  
Service Manuals  
Service Manuals have the diagnosis and repair  
information on engines, transmission, axle suspension,  
brakes, electrical, steering, body, etc.  
Call 1-800-222-1020, or write:  
Chevrolet Motor Division  
Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center  
P.O. Box 33170  
Service Bulletins  
Detroit, MI 48232-5170  
Service Bulletins give additional technical service  
information needed to knowledgeably service  
General Motors cars and trucks. Each bulletin  
contains instructions to assist in the diagnosis and  
service of your vehicle.  
In Canada, call 1-800-263-3777 (English) or  
1-800-263-7854 (French), or write:  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Customer Communication Centre, CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
8-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-551-4123  
Monday-Friday 8:00 AM - 6:00 PM  
Eastern Time  
Owner Information  
Owner publications are written specifically for owners  
and intended to provide basic operational information  
about the vehicle. The owner manual includes the  
Maintenance Schedule for all models.  
For Credit Card Orders Only  
(VISA-MasterCard-Discover), visit Helm, Inc. on the  
World Wide Web at: helminc.com  
In-Portfolio: Includes a Portfolio, Owner Manual, and  
Warranty Booklet.  
Or you can write to:  
RETAIL SELL PRICE: $35.00 (U.S.) plus processing fee  
Without Portfolio: Owner Manual only.  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
RETAIL SELL PRICE: $25.00 (U.S.) plus processing fee  
Prices are subject to change without notice and without  
incurring obligation. Allow ample time for delivery.  
Current and Past Model Order Forms  
Technical Service Bulletins and Manuals are available  
for current and past model GM vehicles. To request an  
order form, specify year and model name of the vehicle.  
Note to Canadian Customers: All listed prices are  
quoted in U.S. funds. Canadian residents are to make  
checks payable in U.S. funds.  
8-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Event Data Recorders  
Vehicle Data Recording and  
Privacy  
This vehicle has an Event Data Recorder (EDR).  
The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain  
crash or near crash-like situations, such as an airbag  
deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will  
assist in understanding how a vehicle's systems  
performed. The EDR is designed to record data related  
to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short  
period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in  
this vehicle is designed to record such data as:  
Your GM vehicle has a number of sophisticated  
computers that record information about the vehicles  
performance and how it is driven. For example, your  
vehicle uses computer modules to monitor and control  
engine and transmission performance, to monitor the  
conditions for airbag deployment and deploy airbags in  
a crash and, if so equipped, to provide antilock braking  
to help the driver control the vehicle. These modules  
may store data to help your dealer/retailer technician  
service your vehicle. Some modules may also store  
data about how you operate the vehicle, such as rate of  
fuel consumption or average speed. These modules  
may also retain the owners personal preferences, such  
as radio pre-sets, seat positions, and temperature  
settings.  
.
How various systems in your vehicle were  
operating  
.
Whether or not the driver and passenger safety  
belts were buckled/fastened  
.
How far, if at all, the driver was pressing the  
accelerator and/or brake pedal  
.
How fast the vehicle was traveling  
This data can help provide a better understanding of the  
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.  
8-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important: EDR data is recorded by your vehicle only if  
a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data is recorded  
by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no  
personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash  
location) is recorded. However, other parties, such as  
law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the  
type of personally identifying data routinely acquired  
during a crash investigation.  
Data that GM collects or receives may also be used for  
GM research needs or may be made available to others  
for research purposes, where a need is shown and the  
data is not tied to a specific vehicle or vehicle owner.  
OnStar®  
If the vehicle has OnStar and you subscribe to the  
OnStar services, please refer to the OnStar Terms and  
Conditions for information on data collection and use.  
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment  
is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is  
needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other  
parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special  
equipment, can read the information if they have access  
to the vehicle or the EDR.  
Navigation System  
If your vehicle has a navigation system, use of the  
system may result in the storage of destinations,  
addresses, telephone numbers, and other trip  
information. Refer to the navigation system operating  
manual for information on stored data and for deletion  
instructions.  
GM will not access this data or share it with others  
except: with the consent of the vehicle owner or, if the  
vehicle is leased, with the consent of the lessee; in  
response to an official request of police or similar  
government office; as part of GM's defense of litigation  
through the discovery process; or, as required by law.  
8-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Frequency  
Radio Frequency Statement  
Identification (RFID)  
This vehicle has systems that operate on a radio  
frequency that comply with Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
with RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
RFID technology is used in some vehicles for functions  
such as tire pressure monitoring and ignition system  
security, as well as in connection with conveniences  
such as key fobs for remote door locking/unlocking and  
starting, and in-vehicle transmitters for garage door  
openers. RFID technology in GM vehicles does not use  
or record personal information or link with any other GM  
system containing personal information.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
1. The device may not cause interference.  
2. The device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation of the device.  
Changes or modifications to any of these systems by  
other than an authorized service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
8-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Antenna  
A
Fixed Mast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-86  
Antenna, XMSatellite Radio Antenna System . . . 4-86  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-4  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Appearance Care  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . .6-121  
Care of Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-123  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-116  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-122  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Interior Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-115  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-122  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-122  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-122  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-120  
Ashtray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Assistance Program, Roadside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4  
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Accessory Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-124  
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-8  
Adjustments  
Headlamp Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7  
Air Cleaner/Filter, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23, 6-25  
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Air Filter, Passenger Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17  
Airbag  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73  
Airbag System  
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62, 2-67  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 2-72  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59  
What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . 2-60  
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-58  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56  
Airbags  
Passenger Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22  
Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53  
i - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-85  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84  
XMSatellite Radio Antenna System . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-86  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55  
Automatic Door Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Automatic Transmission  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37  
Antilock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3  
Braking in Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-5  
Break-In, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-55  
Back-Up Lamps - Ambulance Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) . . . . . . . . 6-51  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker,  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26  
B
Back-Up Lamps - Ambulance Body  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-41  
Electric Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Run-Down Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Belt Routing, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73  
Boost Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Brake  
and Parking Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-50  
License Plate Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-55  
Taillamps and Turn Signal Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52  
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps and  
Back-up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-76  
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
i - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Restraints (cont.)  
Securing a Child Restraint in a  
C
California  
Rear Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47  
Securing a Child Restraint in the  
Perchlorate Materials Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7  
Canadian Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii  
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-131  
Carbon Monoxide  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22  
Care of  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
CD, MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66  
Center Console Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) . . . . . . . . . 6-51  
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Check  
Engine Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-123  
Child Restraints  
Right Front Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50  
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37  
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-125  
Cleaning  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . .6-121  
Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-116  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-115  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-122  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-122  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-120  
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
i - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13  
Clock, Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Clutch, Hydraulic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11  
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-114  
Competitive Driving, Racing or Other . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Compressor Kit, Tire Sealant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Coolant  
D
Damage Repair, Collision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11  
Data Recorders, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2  
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Differential, Limited-Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Disc, MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66  
Display  
Reconfigurable Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5  
Dome Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Door  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29  
Engine Temperature Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-6  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Customer Information  
Automatic Door Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8  
Power Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Programmable Automatic Door Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Driver  
Seat Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
DIC Operation and Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
DIC Vehicle Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Driver Storage Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Service Publications Ordering Information . . . . . . . . 8-16  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2  
i - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Electronic Immobilizer Operation  
At Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Before a Long Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Drunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
In Rain and on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20  
PASS-Key® III+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Electronic Stability Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6  
Electronic Stability Control Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Engine  
Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23, 6-25  
Check and Service Engine Soon Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29  
Coolant Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17  
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34  
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Engine Oil  
Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Active Light . . . . . 5-12  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Indicator/  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Entry/Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Extender, Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30  
E
Easy Entry Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8  
EDR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Electrical Equipment, Add-On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-124  
Electrical System  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-127  
Floor Console Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-125  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-125  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-124  
Power Windows and Other Power Options . . . . . .6-124  
Windshield Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-124  
Electronic Immobilizer  
PASS-Key® III+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
i - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuel (cont.)  
F
Gasoline Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Fuel Economy  
Driving for Better . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20  
Fuses  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-127  
Floor Console Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-125  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-125  
Windshield Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-124  
Filter  
Engine Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23, 6-25  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-122  
Fixed Mast Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-86  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5  
Flashers, Hazard Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Flat Tire, Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-92  
Flat Tire, Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-111  
Fluid  
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Windshield Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-36  
Fog Lamps  
G
Gasoline  
Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Gauges  
Boost . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-6  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9  
i - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15  
Hydraulic Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
H
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-124  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9  
Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker,  
I
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21  
Indicator/Warning LIghts  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Infants and Young Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-66  
Instrument Panel  
Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Instrument Panel Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Integrated Trailer Brake Control  
System (ITBC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-33, 5-39  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-2  
and Parking Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-50  
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Range Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7  
Wiper Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4  
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Height Adjuster, Driver Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3  
Highbeam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
Hood  
J
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-42  
K
Keyless Entry  
Remote (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3  
Checking Things Under . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13  
i - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights (cont.)  
L
Highbeam On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Up-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Limited-Slip Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Loading Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25  
Locks  
Automatic Door Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8  
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Programmable Automatic Door Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Lumbar  
Labeling, Tire Sidewall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-59  
Lamps  
Back-Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54  
Daytime Running (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
License Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-55  
Malfunction Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Mirror Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Taillamps and Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24  
LATCH System for Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Lighting  
Entry/Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9  
Airbag Readiness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Brake System Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Engine Coolant Temperature Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Active . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Manual Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
i - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
N
Maintenance Schedule  
Navigation System, Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19  
Net, Convenience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Maintenance Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15  
Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Manual Lumbar Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3  
Manual Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-2  
Manual Transmission  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Manual Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Message  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Mirror Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Mirrors  
Manual Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Outside Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Outside Manual Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Outside Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Outside Remote Control Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66  
O
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Off-Road  
Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Oil  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Older Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5  
OnStar, Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19  
OnStar® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Outlets  
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Outside  
Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Manual Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Remote Control Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-8  
Owners, Canadian . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii  
i - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19  
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19  
Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Program  
Courtesy Transportation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Programmable Automatic Door Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Proposition 65 Warning, California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5  
P
Paint, Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-122  
Park  
Shifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32  
Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Parking  
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Parking Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62, 2-67  
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Perchlorate Materials Requirements, California . . . . . .6-5  
Phone  
R
Racing or Other Competitive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55  
Radios  
Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-85  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84  
Range Adjustment, Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Reconfigurable Performance Display (RPD) . . . . . . . 4-33  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73  
Power  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-124  
Retained Accessory (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Pregnancy, Using Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30  
i - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Reimbursement Program, GM Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-98, 6-102  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-55  
Replacement Parts  
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Restraint System Check  
S
Safety Belts  
Care of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24  
Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Safety Belts Are for Everyone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30  
Safety Defects Reporting  
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Safety Warnings and Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-3  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Sealant Kit, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Seats  
Driver Seat Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Easy Entry Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Manual Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Split Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Securing a Child Restraint  
Checking the Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74  
Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-75  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Ride Control Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6  
Electronic Stability (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Roof  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40  
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Rear Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47  
Right Front Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50  
i - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Security  
Steering Wheel Controls, Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84  
Steering Wheel, Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Storage Areas  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of the Vehicle . . . 6-6  
Doing Your Own Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Engine Soon Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-124  
Publications Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-122  
Shifting  
Center Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Driver Storage Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Storing the Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . 6-91  
Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40  
T
Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32  
Signals, Turn and Lane-Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
Spare Tire  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Taillamps  
Turn Signal Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52  
Turn Signal, Stoplamps and Back-up Lamps . . . . . . 6-53  
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
Compact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Installing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-98, 6-102  
Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-111  
Specifications and Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-131  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20  
Split Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9  
Start Vehicle, Remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Time, Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
i - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-57  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels,  
Tires (cont.)  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-80  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-75  
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-58  
Towing  
Recreational Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Towing a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-33, 5-39  
Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Traction  
Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9  
Limited-Slip Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Traction System  
Enhanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Transmission  
Fluid, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Fluid, Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Transmission Operation, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26  
Transmission Operation, Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Transportation Program, Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-121  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-76  
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Changing a Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-92  
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-122  
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-66  
Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Installing the Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-98, 6-102  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-67  
Removing the Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-98, 6-102  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84, 6-91  
Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-59  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . 6-111  
Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-63  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-80  
U
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Up-Shift Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
i - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels  
V
Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-80  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-80  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-75  
Where to Put the Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Windshield  
Vehicle  
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25  
Parking Your . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Running While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Vehicle Identification  
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-36  
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-56  
Wiper Blades, Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-120  
Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-124  
Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22  
Winter Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-58  
Wiper Activated Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10  
Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-123  
Service Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-124  
Vehicle Personalization  
DIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
Ventilation Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
W
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Warnings  
X
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Hazard Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Safety and Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
XM Radio Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-72  
XMSatellite Radio  
Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-86  
i - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Belkin Computer Hardware F1DE083 User Manual
Bionaire Fan BSF1731 User Manual
Black Decker Blender BL2350P User Manual
Black Decker Convection Oven CTO6301 User Manual
Blaupunkt Car Stereo System Bahamas MP34 User Manual
Briggs Stratton Pressure Washer 20363 User Manual
Brother All in One Printer MFC9465CDN User Manual
Cadco Food Warmer WT 40S User Manual
Casio Cordless Telephone DT X5 Series User Manual
Cisco Systems Conference Phone CP8831DCK9 User Manual